]> code.delx.au - gnu-emacs/blob - src/xterm.c
* lisp.h (lispstpcpy): Rename from lispstrcpy, and act like stpcpy.
[gnu-emacs] / src / xterm.c
1 /* X Communication module for terminals which understand the X protocol.
2
3 Copyright (C) 1989, 1993-2014 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
4
5 This file is part of GNU Emacs.
6
7 GNU Emacs is free software: you can redistribute it and/or modify
8 it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by
9 the Free Software Foundation, either version 3 of the License, or
10 (at your option) any later version.
11
12 GNU Emacs is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
13 but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
14 MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the
15 GNU General Public License for more details.
16
17 You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License
18 along with GNU Emacs. If not, see <http://www.gnu.org/licenses/>. */
19
20 /* New display code by Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>. */
21 /* Xt features made by Fred Pierresteguy. */
22
23 #include <config.h>
24 #include <stdio.h>
25
26 #include "lisp.h"
27 #include "blockinput.h"
28 #include "syssignal.h"
29
30 /* This may include sys/types.h, and that somehow loses
31 if this is not done before the other system files. */
32 #include "xterm.h"
33 #include <X11/cursorfont.h>
34
35 /* If we have Xfixes extension, use it for pointer blanking. */
36 #ifdef HAVE_XFIXES
37 #include <X11/extensions/Xfixes.h>
38 #endif
39
40 /* Using Xft implies that XRender is available. */
41 #ifdef HAVE_XFT
42 #include <X11/extensions/Xrender.h>
43 #endif
44
45 /* Load sys/types.h if not already loaded.
46 In some systems loading it twice is suicidal. */
47 #ifndef makedev
48 #include <sys/types.h>
49 #endif /* makedev */
50
51 #include <sys/ioctl.h>
52
53 #include "systime.h"
54
55 #include <fcntl.h>
56 #include <errno.h>
57 #include <sys/stat.h>
58 /* Caused redefinition of DBL_DIG on Netbsd; seems not to be needed. */
59 /* #include <sys/param.h> */
60
61 #include "charset.h"
62 #include "character.h"
63 #include "coding.h"
64 #include "frame.h"
65 #include "dispextern.h"
66 #include "fontset.h"
67 #include "termhooks.h"
68 #include "termopts.h"
69 #include "termchar.h"
70 #include "emacs-icon.h"
71 #include "disptab.h"
72 #include "buffer.h"
73 #include "window.h"
74 #include "keyboard.h"
75 #include "intervals.h"
76 #include "process.h"
77 #include "atimer.h"
78 #include "keymap.h"
79 #include "font.h"
80 #include "xsettings.h"
81 #include "xgselect.h"
82 #include "sysselect.h"
83 #include "menu.h"
84
85 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
86 #include <X11/Shell.h>
87 #endif
88
89 #include <unistd.h>
90
91 #ifdef USE_GTK
92 #include "gtkutil.h"
93 #ifdef HAVE_GTK3
94 #include <X11/Xproto.h>
95 #endif
96 #endif
97
98 #if defined (USE_LUCID) || defined (USE_MOTIF)
99 #include "../lwlib/xlwmenu.h"
100 #endif
101
102 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
103 #if !defined (NO_EDITRES)
104 #define HACK_EDITRES
105 extern void _XEditResCheckMessages (Widget, XtPointer, XEvent *, Boolean *);
106 #endif /* not NO_EDITRES */
107
108 /* Include toolkit specific headers for the scroll bar widget. */
109
110 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
111 #if defined USE_MOTIF
112 #include <Xm/Xm.h> /* For LESSTIF_VERSION */
113 #include <Xm/ScrollBar.h>
114 #else /* !USE_MOTIF i.e. use Xaw */
115
116 #ifdef HAVE_XAW3D
117 #include <X11/Xaw3d/Simple.h>
118 #include <X11/Xaw3d/Scrollbar.h>
119 #include <X11/Xaw3d/ThreeD.h>
120 #else /* !HAVE_XAW3D */
121 #include <X11/Xaw/Simple.h>
122 #include <X11/Xaw/Scrollbar.h>
123 #endif /* !HAVE_XAW3D */
124 #ifndef XtNpickTop
125 #define XtNpickTop "pickTop"
126 #endif /* !XtNpickTop */
127 #endif /* !USE_MOTIF */
128 #endif /* USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
129
130 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
131
132 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
133 #include "widget.h"
134 #ifndef XtNinitialState
135 #define XtNinitialState "initialState"
136 #endif
137 #endif
138
139 #include "bitmaps/gray.xbm"
140
141 #ifdef HAVE_XKB
142 #include <X11/XKBlib.h>
143 #endif
144
145 /* Default to using XIM if available. */
146 #ifdef USE_XIM
147 bool use_xim = true;
148 #else
149 bool use_xim = false; /* configure --without-xim */
150 #endif
151
152 /* Non-zero means that a HELP_EVENT has been generated since Emacs
153 start. */
154
155 static bool any_help_event_p;
156
157 /* This is a chain of structures for all the X displays currently in
158 use. */
159
160 struct x_display_info *x_display_list;
161
162 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
163
164 /* The application context for Xt use. */
165 XtAppContext Xt_app_con;
166 static String Xt_default_resources[] = {0};
167
168 /* Non-zero means user is interacting with a toolkit scroll bar. */
169 static bool toolkit_scroll_bar_interaction;
170
171 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
172
173 /* Non-zero timeout value means ignore next mouse click if it arrives
174 before that timeout elapses (i.e. as part of the same sequence of
175 events resulting from clicking on a frame to select it). */
176
177 static Time ignore_next_mouse_click_timeout;
178
179 /* Used locally within XTread_socket. */
180
181 static int x_noop_count;
182
183 static Lisp_Object Qalt, Qhyper, Qmeta, Qsuper, Qmodifier_value;
184
185 static Lisp_Object Qvendor_specific_keysyms;
186 static Lisp_Object Qlatin_1;
187
188 #ifdef USE_GTK
189 /* The name of the Emacs icon file. */
190 static Lisp_Object xg_default_icon_file;
191
192 /* Used in gtkutil.c. */
193 Lisp_Object Qx_gtk_map_stock;
194 #endif
195
196 /* Some functions take this as char *, not const char *. */
197 static char emacs_class[] = EMACS_CLASS;
198
199 enum xembed_info
200 {
201 XEMBED_MAPPED = 1 << 0
202 };
203
204 enum xembed_message
205 {
206 XEMBED_EMBEDDED_NOTIFY = 0,
207 XEMBED_WINDOW_ACTIVATE = 1,
208 XEMBED_WINDOW_DEACTIVATE = 2,
209 XEMBED_REQUEST_FOCUS = 3,
210 XEMBED_FOCUS_IN = 4,
211 XEMBED_FOCUS_OUT = 5,
212 XEMBED_FOCUS_NEXT = 6,
213 XEMBED_FOCUS_PREV = 7,
214
215 XEMBED_MODALITY_ON = 10,
216 XEMBED_MODALITY_OFF = 11,
217 XEMBED_REGISTER_ACCELERATOR = 12,
218 XEMBED_UNREGISTER_ACCELERATOR = 13,
219 XEMBED_ACTIVATE_ACCELERATOR = 14
220 };
221
222 static bool x_alloc_nearest_color_1 (Display *, Colormap, XColor *);
223 static void x_set_window_size_1 (struct frame *, int, int, int, bool);
224 static void x_raise_frame (struct frame *);
225 static void x_lower_frame (struct frame *);
226 static const XColor *x_color_cells (Display *, int *);
227 static int x_io_error_quitter (Display *);
228 static struct terminal *x_create_terminal (struct x_display_info *);
229 static void x_update_end (struct frame *);
230 static void XTframe_up_to_date (struct frame *);
231 static void x_clear_frame (struct frame *);
232 static _Noreturn void x_ins_del_lines (struct frame *, int, int);
233 static void frame_highlight (struct frame *);
234 static void frame_unhighlight (struct frame *);
235 static void x_new_focus_frame (struct x_display_info *, struct frame *);
236 static void x_focus_changed (int, int, struct x_display_info *,
237 struct frame *, struct input_event *);
238 static void XTframe_rehighlight (struct frame *);
239 static void x_frame_rehighlight (struct x_display_info *);
240 static void x_draw_hollow_cursor (struct window *, struct glyph_row *);
241 static void x_draw_bar_cursor (struct window *, struct glyph_row *, int,
242 enum text_cursor_kinds);
243
244 static void x_clip_to_row (struct window *, struct glyph_row *,
245 enum glyph_row_area, GC);
246 static void x_flush (struct frame *f);
247 static void x_update_begin (struct frame *);
248 static void x_update_window_begin (struct window *);
249 static struct scroll_bar *x_window_to_scroll_bar (Display *, Window, int);
250 static void x_scroll_bar_report_motion (struct frame **, Lisp_Object *,
251 enum scroll_bar_part *,
252 Lisp_Object *, Lisp_Object *,
253 Time *);
254 static void x_horizontal_scroll_bar_report_motion (struct frame **, Lisp_Object *,
255 enum scroll_bar_part *,
256 Lisp_Object *, Lisp_Object *,
257 Time *);
258 static int x_handle_net_wm_state (struct frame *, const XPropertyEvent *);
259 static void x_check_fullscreen (struct frame *);
260 static void x_check_expected_move (struct frame *, int, int);
261 static void x_sync_with_move (struct frame *, int, int, int);
262 static int handle_one_xevent (struct x_display_info *,
263 const XEvent *, int *,
264 struct input_event *);
265 #if ! (defined USE_X_TOOLKIT || defined USE_MOTIF)
266 static int x_dispatch_event (XEvent *, Display *);
267 #endif
268 /* Don't declare this _Noreturn because we want no
269 interference with debugging failing X calls. */
270 static void x_connection_closed (Display *, const char *);
271 static void x_wm_set_window_state (struct frame *, int);
272 static void x_wm_set_icon_pixmap (struct frame *, ptrdiff_t);
273 static void x_initialize (void);
274
275 static int get_current_wm_state (struct frame *, Window, int *, int *);
276
277 /* Flush display of frame F. */
278
279 static void
280 x_flush (struct frame *f)
281 {
282 eassert (f && FRAME_X_P (f));
283 /* Don't call XFlush when it is not safe to redisplay; the X
284 connection may be broken. */
285 if (!NILP (Vinhibit_redisplay))
286 return;
287
288 block_input ();
289 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
290 unblock_input ();
291 }
292
293
294 /* Remove calls to XFlush by defining XFlush to an empty replacement.
295 Calls to XFlush should be unnecessary because the X output buffer
296 is flushed automatically as needed by calls to XPending,
297 XNextEvent, or XWindowEvent according to the XFlush man page.
298 XTread_socket calls XPending. Removing XFlush improves
299 performance. */
300
301 #define XFlush(DISPLAY) (void) 0
302
303 \f
304 /***********************************************************************
305 Debugging
306 ***********************************************************************/
307
308 #if 0
309
310 /* This is a function useful for recording debugging information about
311 the sequence of occurrences in this file. */
312
313 struct record
314 {
315 char *locus;
316 int type;
317 };
318
319 struct record event_record[100];
320
321 int event_record_index;
322
323 void
324 record_event (char *locus, int type)
325 {
326 if (event_record_index == ARRAYELTS (event_record))
327 event_record_index = 0;
328
329 event_record[event_record_index].locus = locus;
330 event_record[event_record_index].type = type;
331 event_record_index++;
332 }
333
334 #endif /* 0 */
335
336
337 \f
338 /* Return the struct x_display_info corresponding to DPY. */
339
340 struct x_display_info *
341 x_display_info_for_display (Display *dpy)
342 {
343 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
344
345 for (dpyinfo = x_display_list; dpyinfo; dpyinfo = dpyinfo->next)
346 if (dpyinfo->display == dpy)
347 return dpyinfo;
348
349 return 0;
350 }
351
352 static Window
353 x_find_topmost_parent (struct frame *f)
354 {
355 struct x_output *x = f->output_data.x;
356 Window win = None, wi = x->parent_desc;
357 Display *dpy = FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f);
358
359 while (wi != FRAME_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->root_window)
360 {
361 Window root;
362 Window *children;
363 unsigned int nchildren;
364
365 win = wi;
366 if (XQueryTree (dpy, win, &root, &wi, &children, &nchildren))
367 XFree (children);
368 else
369 break;
370 }
371
372 return win;
373 }
374
375 #define OPAQUE 0xffffffff
376
377 void
378 x_set_frame_alpha (struct frame *f)
379 {
380 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
381 Display *dpy = FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f);
382 Window win = FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f);
383 double alpha = 1.0;
384 double alpha_min = 1.0;
385 unsigned long opac;
386 Window parent;
387
388 if (dpyinfo->x_highlight_frame == f)
389 alpha = f->alpha[0];
390 else
391 alpha = f->alpha[1];
392
393 if (FLOATP (Vframe_alpha_lower_limit))
394 alpha_min = XFLOAT_DATA (Vframe_alpha_lower_limit);
395 else if (INTEGERP (Vframe_alpha_lower_limit))
396 alpha_min = (XINT (Vframe_alpha_lower_limit)) / 100.0;
397
398 if (alpha < 0.0)
399 return;
400 else if (alpha > 1.0)
401 alpha = 1.0;
402 else if (0.0 <= alpha && alpha < alpha_min && alpha_min <= 1.0)
403 alpha = alpha_min;
404
405 opac = alpha * OPAQUE;
406
407 x_catch_errors (dpy);
408
409 /* If there is a parent from the window manager, put the property there
410 also, to work around broken window managers that fail to do that.
411 Do this unconditionally as this function is called on reparent when
412 alpha has not changed on the frame. */
413
414 parent = x_find_topmost_parent (f);
415 if (parent != None)
416 XChangeProperty (dpy, parent, dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_window_opacity,
417 XA_CARDINAL, 32, PropModeReplace,
418 (unsigned char *) &opac, 1);
419
420 /* return unless necessary */
421 {
422 unsigned char *data;
423 Atom actual;
424 int rc, format;
425 unsigned long n, left;
426
427 rc = XGetWindowProperty (dpy, win, dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_window_opacity,
428 0, 1, False, XA_CARDINAL,
429 &actual, &format, &n, &left,
430 &data);
431
432 if (rc == Success && actual != None)
433 {
434 unsigned long value = *(unsigned long *)data;
435 XFree (data);
436 if (value == opac)
437 {
438 x_uncatch_errors ();
439 return;
440 }
441 }
442 }
443
444 XChangeProperty (dpy, win, dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_window_opacity,
445 XA_CARDINAL, 32, PropModeReplace,
446 (unsigned char *) &opac, 1);
447 x_uncatch_errors ();
448 }
449
450 /***********************************************************************
451 Starting and ending an update
452 ***********************************************************************/
453
454 /* Start an update of frame F. This function is installed as a hook
455 for update_begin, i.e. it is called when update_begin is called.
456 This function is called prior to calls to x_update_window_begin for
457 each window being updated. Currently, there is nothing to do here
458 because all interesting stuff is done on a window basis. */
459
460 static void
461 x_update_begin (struct frame *f)
462 {
463 /* Nothing to do. */
464 }
465
466
467 /* Start update of window W. */
468
469 static void
470 x_update_window_begin (struct window *w)
471 {
472 struct frame *f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (w));
473 Mouse_HLInfo *hlinfo = MOUSE_HL_INFO (f);
474
475 w->output_cursor = w->cursor;
476
477 block_input ();
478
479 if (f == hlinfo->mouse_face_mouse_frame)
480 {
481 /* Don't do highlighting for mouse motion during the update. */
482 hlinfo->mouse_face_defer = 1;
483
484 /* If F needs to be redrawn, simply forget about any prior mouse
485 highlighting. */
486 if (FRAME_GARBAGED_P (f))
487 hlinfo->mouse_face_window = Qnil;
488 }
489
490 unblock_input ();
491 }
492
493
494 /* Draw a vertical window border from (x,y0) to (x,y1) */
495
496 static void
497 x_draw_vertical_window_border (struct window *w, int x, int y0, int y1)
498 {
499 struct frame *f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (w));
500 struct face *face;
501
502 face = FACE_FROM_ID (f, VERTICAL_BORDER_FACE_ID);
503 if (face)
504 XSetForeground (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), f->output_data.x->normal_gc,
505 face->foreground);
506
507 XDrawLine (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
508 f->output_data.x->normal_gc, x, y0, x, y1);
509 }
510
511 /* Draw a window divider from (x0,y0) to (x1,y1) */
512
513 static void
514 x_draw_window_divider (struct window *w, int x0, int x1, int y0, int y1)
515 {
516 struct frame *f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (w));
517 struct face *face = FACE_FROM_ID (f, WINDOW_DIVIDER_FACE_ID);
518 struct face *face_first = FACE_FROM_ID (f, WINDOW_DIVIDER_FIRST_PIXEL_FACE_ID);
519 struct face *face_last = FACE_FROM_ID (f, WINDOW_DIVIDER_LAST_PIXEL_FACE_ID);
520 unsigned long color = face ? face->foreground : FRAME_FOREGROUND_PIXEL (f);
521 unsigned long color_first = (face_first
522 ? face_first->foreground
523 : FRAME_FOREGROUND_PIXEL (f));
524 unsigned long color_last = (face_last
525 ? face_last->foreground
526 : FRAME_FOREGROUND_PIXEL (f));
527 Display *display = FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f);
528 Window window = FRAME_X_WINDOW (f);
529
530 if (y1 - y0 > x1 - x0 && x1 - x0 > 2)
531 /* Vertical. */
532 {
533 XSetForeground (display, f->output_data.x->normal_gc, color_first);
534 XFillRectangle (display, window, f->output_data.x->normal_gc,
535 x0, y0, 1, y1 - y0);
536 XSetForeground (display, f->output_data.x->normal_gc, color);
537 XFillRectangle (display, window, f->output_data.x->normal_gc,
538 x0 + 1, y0, x1 - x0 - 2, y1 - y0);
539 XSetForeground (display, f->output_data.x->normal_gc, color_last);
540 XFillRectangle (display, window, f->output_data.x->normal_gc,
541 x1 - 1, y0, 1, y1 - y0);
542 }
543 else if (x1 - x0 > y1 - y0 && y1 - y0 > 3)
544 /* Horizontal. */
545 {
546 XSetForeground (display, f->output_data.x->normal_gc, color_first);
547 XFillRectangle (display, window, f->output_data.x->normal_gc,
548 x0, y0, x1 - x0, 1);
549 XSetForeground (display, f->output_data.x->normal_gc, color);
550 XFillRectangle (display, window, f->output_data.x->normal_gc,
551 x0, y0 + 1, x1 - x0, y1 - y0 - 2);
552 XSetForeground (display, f->output_data.x->normal_gc, color_last);
553 XFillRectangle (display, window, f->output_data.x->normal_gc,
554 x0, y1 - 1, x1 - x0, 1);
555 }
556 else
557 {
558 XSetForeground (display, f->output_data.x->normal_gc, color);
559 XFillRectangle (display, window, f->output_data.x->normal_gc,
560 x0, y0, x1 - x0, y1 - y0);
561 }
562 }
563
564 /* End update of window W.
565
566 Draw vertical borders between horizontally adjacent windows, and
567 display W's cursor if CURSOR_ON_P is non-zero.
568
569 MOUSE_FACE_OVERWRITTEN_P non-zero means that some row containing
570 glyphs in mouse-face were overwritten. In that case we have to
571 make sure that the mouse-highlight is properly redrawn.
572
573 W may be a menu bar pseudo-window in case we don't have X toolkit
574 support. Such windows don't have a cursor, so don't display it
575 here. */
576
577 static void
578 x_update_window_end (struct window *w, bool cursor_on_p,
579 bool mouse_face_overwritten_p)
580 {
581 if (!w->pseudo_window_p)
582 {
583 block_input ();
584
585 if (cursor_on_p)
586 display_and_set_cursor (w, 1,
587 w->output_cursor.hpos, w->output_cursor.vpos,
588 w->output_cursor.x, w->output_cursor.y);
589
590 if (draw_window_fringes (w, 1))
591 {
592 if (WINDOW_RIGHT_DIVIDER_WIDTH (w))
593 x_draw_right_divider (w);
594 else
595 x_draw_vertical_border (w);
596 }
597
598 unblock_input ();
599 }
600
601 /* If a row with mouse-face was overwritten, arrange for
602 XTframe_up_to_date to redisplay the mouse highlight. */
603 if (mouse_face_overwritten_p)
604 {
605 Mouse_HLInfo *hlinfo = MOUSE_HL_INFO (XFRAME (w->frame));
606
607 hlinfo->mouse_face_beg_row = hlinfo->mouse_face_beg_col = -1;
608 hlinfo->mouse_face_end_row = hlinfo->mouse_face_end_col = -1;
609 hlinfo->mouse_face_window = Qnil;
610 }
611 }
612
613
614 /* End update of frame F. This function is installed as a hook in
615 update_end. */
616
617 static void
618 x_update_end (struct frame *f)
619 {
620 /* Mouse highlight may be displayed again. */
621 MOUSE_HL_INFO (f)->mouse_face_defer = 0;
622
623 #ifndef XFlush
624 block_input ();
625 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
626 unblock_input ();
627 #endif
628 }
629
630
631 /* This function is called from various places in xdisp.c
632 whenever a complete update has been performed. */
633
634 static void
635 XTframe_up_to_date (struct frame *f)
636 {
637 if (FRAME_X_P (f))
638 FRAME_MOUSE_UPDATE (f);
639 }
640
641
642 /* Clear under internal border if any (GTK has its own version). */
643 #ifndef USE_GTK
644 void
645 x_clear_under_internal_border (struct frame *f)
646 {
647 if (FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f) > 0)
648 {
649 Display *display = FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f);
650 Window window = FRAME_X_WINDOW (f);
651 int border = FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f);
652 int width = FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f);
653 int height = FRAME_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f);
654 int margin = FRAME_TOP_MARGIN_HEIGHT (f);
655
656 block_input ();
657 x_clear_area (display, window, 0, 0, border, height);
658 x_clear_area (display, window, 0, margin, width, border);
659 x_clear_area (display, window, width - border, 0, border, height);
660 x_clear_area (display, window, 0, height - border, width, border);
661 unblock_input ();
662 }
663 }
664 #endif
665
666 /* Draw truncation mark bitmaps, continuation mark bitmaps, overlay
667 arrow bitmaps, or clear the fringes if no bitmaps are required
668 before DESIRED_ROW is made current. This function is called from
669 update_window_line only if it is known that there are differences
670 between bitmaps to be drawn between current row and DESIRED_ROW. */
671
672 static void
673 x_after_update_window_line (struct window *w, struct glyph_row *desired_row)
674 {
675 eassert (w);
676
677 if (!desired_row->mode_line_p && !w->pseudo_window_p)
678 desired_row->redraw_fringe_bitmaps_p = 1;
679
680 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
681 /* When a window has disappeared, make sure that no rest of
682 full-width rows stays visible in the internal border. Could
683 check here if updated window is the leftmost/rightmost window,
684 but I guess it's not worth doing since vertically split windows
685 are almost never used, internal border is rarely set, and the
686 overhead is very small. */
687 {
688 struct frame *f;
689 int width, height;
690
691 if (windows_or_buffers_changed
692 && desired_row->full_width_p
693 && (f = XFRAME (w->frame),
694 width = FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f),
695 width != 0)
696 && (height = desired_row->visible_height,
697 height > 0))
698 {
699 int y = WINDOW_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_Y (w, max (0, desired_row->y));
700
701 block_input ();
702 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
703 0, y, width, height);
704 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
705 FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f) - width,
706 y, width, height);
707 unblock_input ();
708 }
709 }
710 #endif
711 }
712
713 static void
714 x_draw_fringe_bitmap (struct window *w, struct glyph_row *row, struct draw_fringe_bitmap_params *p)
715 {
716 struct frame *f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (w));
717 Display *display = FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f);
718 Window window = FRAME_X_WINDOW (f);
719 GC gc = f->output_data.x->normal_gc;
720 struct face *face = p->face;
721
722 /* Must clip because of partially visible lines. */
723 x_clip_to_row (w, row, ANY_AREA, gc);
724
725 if (p->bx >= 0 && !p->overlay_p)
726 {
727 /* In case the same realized face is used for fringes and
728 for something displayed in the text (e.g. face `region' on
729 mono-displays, the fill style may have been changed to
730 FillSolid in x_draw_glyph_string_background. */
731 if (face->stipple)
732 XSetFillStyle (display, face->gc, FillOpaqueStippled);
733 else
734 XSetForeground (display, face->gc, face->background);
735
736 XFillRectangle (display, window, face->gc,
737 p->bx, p->by, p->nx, p->ny);
738
739 if (!face->stipple)
740 XSetForeground (display, face->gc, face->foreground);
741 }
742
743 if (p->which)
744 {
745 char *bits;
746 Pixmap pixmap, clipmask = (Pixmap) 0;
747 int depth = DefaultDepthOfScreen (FRAME_X_SCREEN (f));
748 XGCValues gcv;
749
750 if (p->wd > 8)
751 bits = (char *) (p->bits + p->dh);
752 else
753 bits = (char *) p->bits + p->dh;
754
755 /* Draw the bitmap. I believe these small pixmaps can be cached
756 by the server. */
757 pixmap = XCreatePixmapFromBitmapData (display, window, bits, p->wd, p->h,
758 (p->cursor_p
759 ? (p->overlay_p ? face->background
760 : f->output_data.x->cursor_pixel)
761 : face->foreground),
762 face->background, depth);
763
764 if (p->overlay_p)
765 {
766 clipmask = XCreatePixmapFromBitmapData (display,
767 FRAME_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->root_window,
768 bits, p->wd, p->h,
769 1, 0, 1);
770 gcv.clip_mask = clipmask;
771 gcv.clip_x_origin = p->x;
772 gcv.clip_y_origin = p->y;
773 XChangeGC (display, gc, GCClipMask | GCClipXOrigin | GCClipYOrigin, &gcv);
774 }
775
776 XCopyArea (display, pixmap, window, gc, 0, 0,
777 p->wd, p->h, p->x, p->y);
778 XFreePixmap (display, pixmap);
779
780 if (p->overlay_p)
781 {
782 gcv.clip_mask = (Pixmap) 0;
783 XChangeGC (display, gc, GCClipMask, &gcv);
784 XFreePixmap (display, clipmask);
785 }
786 }
787
788 XSetClipMask (display, gc, None);
789 }
790
791 /***********************************************************************
792 Glyph display
793 ***********************************************************************/
794
795
796
797 static void x_set_glyph_string_clipping (struct glyph_string *);
798 static void x_set_glyph_string_gc (struct glyph_string *);
799 static void x_draw_glyph_string_foreground (struct glyph_string *);
800 static void x_draw_composite_glyph_string_foreground (struct glyph_string *);
801 static void x_draw_glyph_string_box (struct glyph_string *);
802 static void x_draw_glyph_string (struct glyph_string *);
803 static _Noreturn void x_delete_glyphs (struct frame *, int);
804 static void x_compute_glyph_string_overhangs (struct glyph_string *);
805 static void x_set_cursor_gc (struct glyph_string *);
806 static void x_set_mode_line_face_gc (struct glyph_string *);
807 static void x_set_mouse_face_gc (struct glyph_string *);
808 static bool x_alloc_lighter_color (struct frame *, Display *, Colormap,
809 unsigned long *, double, int);
810 static void x_setup_relief_color (struct frame *, struct relief *,
811 double, int, unsigned long);
812 static void x_setup_relief_colors (struct glyph_string *);
813 static void x_draw_image_glyph_string (struct glyph_string *);
814 static void x_draw_image_relief (struct glyph_string *);
815 static void x_draw_image_foreground (struct glyph_string *);
816 static void x_draw_image_foreground_1 (struct glyph_string *, Pixmap);
817 static void x_clear_glyph_string_rect (struct glyph_string *, int,
818 int, int, int);
819 static void x_draw_relief_rect (struct frame *, int, int, int, int,
820 int, int, int, int, int, int,
821 XRectangle *);
822 static void x_draw_box_rect (struct glyph_string *, int, int, int, int,
823 int, int, int, XRectangle *);
824 static void x_scroll_bar_clear (struct frame *);
825
826 #ifdef GLYPH_DEBUG
827 static void x_check_font (struct frame *, struct font *);
828 #endif
829
830
831 /* Set S->gc to a suitable GC for drawing glyph string S in cursor
832 face. */
833
834 static void
835 x_set_cursor_gc (struct glyph_string *s)
836 {
837 if (s->font == FRAME_FONT (s->f)
838 && s->face->background == FRAME_BACKGROUND_PIXEL (s->f)
839 && s->face->foreground == FRAME_FOREGROUND_PIXEL (s->f)
840 && !s->cmp)
841 s->gc = s->f->output_data.x->cursor_gc;
842 else
843 {
844 /* Cursor on non-default face: must merge. */
845 XGCValues xgcv;
846 unsigned long mask;
847
848 xgcv.background = s->f->output_data.x->cursor_pixel;
849 xgcv.foreground = s->face->background;
850
851 /* If the glyph would be invisible, try a different foreground. */
852 if (xgcv.foreground == xgcv.background)
853 xgcv.foreground = s->face->foreground;
854 if (xgcv.foreground == xgcv.background)
855 xgcv.foreground = s->f->output_data.x->cursor_foreground_pixel;
856 if (xgcv.foreground == xgcv.background)
857 xgcv.foreground = s->face->foreground;
858
859 /* Make sure the cursor is distinct from text in this face. */
860 if (xgcv.background == s->face->background
861 && xgcv.foreground == s->face->foreground)
862 {
863 xgcv.background = s->face->foreground;
864 xgcv.foreground = s->face->background;
865 }
866
867 IF_DEBUG (x_check_font (s->f, s->font));
868 xgcv.graphics_exposures = False;
869 mask = GCForeground | GCBackground | GCGraphicsExposures;
870
871 if (FRAME_DISPLAY_INFO (s->f)->scratch_cursor_gc)
872 XChangeGC (s->display, FRAME_DISPLAY_INFO (s->f)->scratch_cursor_gc,
873 mask, &xgcv);
874 else
875 FRAME_DISPLAY_INFO (s->f)->scratch_cursor_gc
876 = XCreateGC (s->display, s->window, mask, &xgcv);
877
878 s->gc = FRAME_DISPLAY_INFO (s->f)->scratch_cursor_gc;
879 }
880 }
881
882
883 /* Set up S->gc of glyph string S for drawing text in mouse face. */
884
885 static void
886 x_set_mouse_face_gc (struct glyph_string *s)
887 {
888 int face_id;
889 struct face *face;
890
891 /* What face has to be used last for the mouse face? */
892 face_id = MOUSE_HL_INFO (s->f)->mouse_face_face_id;
893 face = FACE_FROM_ID (s->f, face_id);
894 if (face == NULL)
895 face = FACE_FROM_ID (s->f, MOUSE_FACE_ID);
896
897 if (s->first_glyph->type == CHAR_GLYPH)
898 face_id = FACE_FOR_CHAR (s->f, face, s->first_glyph->u.ch, -1, Qnil);
899 else
900 face_id = FACE_FOR_CHAR (s->f, face, 0, -1, Qnil);
901 s->face = FACE_FROM_ID (s->f, face_id);
902 prepare_face_for_display (s->f, s->face);
903
904 if (s->font == s->face->font)
905 s->gc = s->face->gc;
906 else
907 {
908 /* Otherwise construct scratch_cursor_gc with values from FACE
909 except for FONT. */
910 XGCValues xgcv;
911 unsigned long mask;
912
913 xgcv.background = s->face->background;
914 xgcv.foreground = s->face->foreground;
915 xgcv.graphics_exposures = False;
916 mask = GCForeground | GCBackground | GCGraphicsExposures;
917
918 if (FRAME_DISPLAY_INFO (s->f)->scratch_cursor_gc)
919 XChangeGC (s->display, FRAME_DISPLAY_INFO (s->f)->scratch_cursor_gc,
920 mask, &xgcv);
921 else
922 FRAME_DISPLAY_INFO (s->f)->scratch_cursor_gc
923 = XCreateGC (s->display, s->window, mask, &xgcv);
924
925 s->gc = FRAME_DISPLAY_INFO (s->f)->scratch_cursor_gc;
926
927 }
928 eassert (s->gc != 0);
929 }
930
931
932 /* Set S->gc of glyph string S to a GC suitable for drawing a mode line.
933 Faces to use in the mode line have already been computed when the
934 matrix was built, so there isn't much to do, here. */
935
936 static void
937 x_set_mode_line_face_gc (struct glyph_string *s)
938 {
939 s->gc = s->face->gc;
940 }
941
942
943 /* Set S->gc of glyph string S for drawing that glyph string. Set
944 S->stippled_p to a non-zero value if the face of S has a stipple
945 pattern. */
946
947 static void
948 x_set_glyph_string_gc (struct glyph_string *s)
949 {
950 prepare_face_for_display (s->f, s->face);
951
952 if (s->hl == DRAW_NORMAL_TEXT)
953 {
954 s->gc = s->face->gc;
955 s->stippled_p = s->face->stipple != 0;
956 }
957 else if (s->hl == DRAW_INVERSE_VIDEO)
958 {
959 x_set_mode_line_face_gc (s);
960 s->stippled_p = s->face->stipple != 0;
961 }
962 else if (s->hl == DRAW_CURSOR)
963 {
964 x_set_cursor_gc (s);
965 s->stippled_p = 0;
966 }
967 else if (s->hl == DRAW_MOUSE_FACE)
968 {
969 x_set_mouse_face_gc (s);
970 s->stippled_p = s->face->stipple != 0;
971 }
972 else if (s->hl == DRAW_IMAGE_RAISED
973 || s->hl == DRAW_IMAGE_SUNKEN)
974 {
975 s->gc = s->face->gc;
976 s->stippled_p = s->face->stipple != 0;
977 }
978 else
979 emacs_abort ();
980
981 /* GC must have been set. */
982 eassert (s->gc != 0);
983 }
984
985
986 /* Set clipping for output of glyph string S. S may be part of a mode
987 line or menu if we don't have X toolkit support. */
988
989 static void
990 x_set_glyph_string_clipping (struct glyph_string *s)
991 {
992 XRectangle *r = s->clip;
993 int n = get_glyph_string_clip_rects (s, r, 2);
994
995 if (n > 0)
996 XSetClipRectangles (s->display, s->gc, 0, 0, r, n, Unsorted);
997 s->num_clips = n;
998 }
999
1000
1001 /* Set SRC's clipping for output of glyph string DST. This is called
1002 when we are drawing DST's left_overhang or right_overhang only in
1003 the area of SRC. */
1004
1005 static void
1006 x_set_glyph_string_clipping_exactly (struct glyph_string *src, struct glyph_string *dst)
1007 {
1008 XRectangle r;
1009
1010 r.x = src->x;
1011 r.width = src->width;
1012 r.y = src->y;
1013 r.height = src->height;
1014 dst->clip[0] = r;
1015 dst->num_clips = 1;
1016 XSetClipRectangles (dst->display, dst->gc, 0, 0, &r, 1, Unsorted);
1017 }
1018
1019
1020 /* RIF:
1021 Compute left and right overhang of glyph string S. */
1022
1023 static void
1024 x_compute_glyph_string_overhangs (struct glyph_string *s)
1025 {
1026 if (s->cmp == NULL
1027 && (s->first_glyph->type == CHAR_GLYPH
1028 || s->first_glyph->type == COMPOSITE_GLYPH))
1029 {
1030 struct font_metrics metrics;
1031
1032 if (s->first_glyph->type == CHAR_GLYPH)
1033 {
1034 unsigned *code = alloca (sizeof (unsigned) * s->nchars);
1035 struct font *font = s->font;
1036 int i;
1037
1038 for (i = 0; i < s->nchars; i++)
1039 code[i] = (s->char2b[i].byte1 << 8) | s->char2b[i].byte2;
1040 font->driver->text_extents (font, code, s->nchars, &metrics);
1041 }
1042 else
1043 {
1044 Lisp_Object gstring = composition_gstring_from_id (s->cmp_id);
1045
1046 composition_gstring_width (gstring, s->cmp_from, s->cmp_to, &metrics);
1047 }
1048 s->right_overhang = (metrics.rbearing > metrics.width
1049 ? metrics.rbearing - metrics.width : 0);
1050 s->left_overhang = metrics.lbearing < 0 ? - metrics.lbearing : 0;
1051 }
1052 else if (s->cmp)
1053 {
1054 s->right_overhang = s->cmp->rbearing - s->cmp->pixel_width;
1055 s->left_overhang = - s->cmp->lbearing;
1056 }
1057 }
1058
1059
1060 /* Fill rectangle X, Y, W, H with background color of glyph string S. */
1061
1062 static void
1063 x_clear_glyph_string_rect (struct glyph_string *s, int x, int y, int w, int h)
1064 {
1065 XGCValues xgcv;
1066 XGetGCValues (s->display, s->gc, GCForeground | GCBackground, &xgcv);
1067 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, xgcv.background);
1068 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc, x, y, w, h);
1069 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, xgcv.foreground);
1070 }
1071
1072
1073 /* Draw the background of glyph_string S. If S->background_filled_p
1074 is non-zero don't draw it. FORCE_P non-zero means draw the
1075 background even if it wouldn't be drawn normally. This is used
1076 when a string preceding S draws into the background of S, or S
1077 contains the first component of a composition. */
1078
1079 static void
1080 x_draw_glyph_string_background (struct glyph_string *s, bool force_p)
1081 {
1082 /* Nothing to do if background has already been drawn or if it
1083 shouldn't be drawn in the first place. */
1084 if (!s->background_filled_p)
1085 {
1086 int box_line_width = max (s->face->box_line_width, 0);
1087
1088 if (s->stippled_p)
1089 {
1090 /* Fill background with a stipple pattern. */
1091 XSetFillStyle (s->display, s->gc, FillOpaqueStippled);
1092 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc, s->x,
1093 s->y + box_line_width,
1094 s->background_width,
1095 s->height - 2 * box_line_width);
1096 XSetFillStyle (s->display, s->gc, FillSolid);
1097 s->background_filled_p = 1;
1098 }
1099 else if (FONT_HEIGHT (s->font) < s->height - 2 * box_line_width
1100 || s->font_not_found_p
1101 || s->extends_to_end_of_line_p
1102 || force_p)
1103 {
1104 x_clear_glyph_string_rect (s, s->x, s->y + box_line_width,
1105 s->background_width,
1106 s->height - 2 * box_line_width);
1107 s->background_filled_p = 1;
1108 }
1109 }
1110 }
1111
1112
1113 /* Draw the foreground of glyph string S. */
1114
1115 static void
1116 x_draw_glyph_string_foreground (struct glyph_string *s)
1117 {
1118 int i, x;
1119
1120 /* If first glyph of S has a left box line, start drawing the text
1121 of S to the right of that box line. */
1122 if (s->face->box != FACE_NO_BOX
1123 && s->first_glyph->left_box_line_p)
1124 x = s->x + eabs (s->face->box_line_width);
1125 else
1126 x = s->x;
1127
1128 /* Draw characters of S as rectangles if S's font could not be
1129 loaded. */
1130 if (s->font_not_found_p)
1131 {
1132 for (i = 0; i < s->nchars; ++i)
1133 {
1134 struct glyph *g = s->first_glyph + i;
1135 XDrawRectangle (s->display, s->window,
1136 s->gc, x, s->y, g->pixel_width - 1,
1137 s->height - 1);
1138 x += g->pixel_width;
1139 }
1140 }
1141 else
1142 {
1143 struct font *font = s->font;
1144 int boff = font->baseline_offset;
1145 int y;
1146
1147 if (font->vertical_centering)
1148 boff = VCENTER_BASELINE_OFFSET (font, s->f) - boff;
1149
1150 y = s->ybase - boff;
1151 if (s->for_overlaps
1152 || (s->background_filled_p && s->hl != DRAW_CURSOR))
1153 font->driver->draw (s, 0, s->nchars, x, y, 0);
1154 else
1155 font->driver->draw (s, 0, s->nchars, x, y, 1);
1156 if (s->face->overstrike)
1157 font->driver->draw (s, 0, s->nchars, x + 1, y, 0);
1158 }
1159 }
1160
1161 /* Draw the foreground of composite glyph string S. */
1162
1163 static void
1164 x_draw_composite_glyph_string_foreground (struct glyph_string *s)
1165 {
1166 int i, j, x;
1167 struct font *font = s->font;
1168
1169 /* If first glyph of S has a left box line, start drawing the text
1170 of S to the right of that box line. */
1171 if (s->face && s->face->box != FACE_NO_BOX
1172 && s->first_glyph->left_box_line_p)
1173 x = s->x + eabs (s->face->box_line_width);
1174 else
1175 x = s->x;
1176
1177 /* S is a glyph string for a composition. S->cmp_from is the index
1178 of the first character drawn for glyphs of this composition.
1179 S->cmp_from == 0 means we are drawing the very first character of
1180 this composition. */
1181
1182 /* Draw a rectangle for the composition if the font for the very
1183 first character of the composition could not be loaded. */
1184 if (s->font_not_found_p)
1185 {
1186 if (s->cmp_from == 0)
1187 XDrawRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc, x, s->y,
1188 s->width - 1, s->height - 1);
1189 }
1190 else if (! s->first_glyph->u.cmp.automatic)
1191 {
1192 int y = s->ybase;
1193
1194 for (i = 0, j = s->cmp_from; i < s->nchars; i++, j++)
1195 /* TAB in a composition means display glyphs with padding
1196 space on the left or right. */
1197 if (COMPOSITION_GLYPH (s->cmp, j) != '\t')
1198 {
1199 int xx = x + s->cmp->offsets[j * 2];
1200 int yy = y - s->cmp->offsets[j * 2 + 1];
1201
1202 font->driver->draw (s, j, j + 1, xx, yy, 0);
1203 if (s->face->overstrike)
1204 font->driver->draw (s, j, j + 1, xx + 1, yy, 0);
1205 }
1206 }
1207 else
1208 {
1209 Lisp_Object gstring = composition_gstring_from_id (s->cmp_id);
1210 Lisp_Object glyph;
1211 int y = s->ybase;
1212 int width = 0;
1213
1214 for (i = j = s->cmp_from; i < s->cmp_to; i++)
1215 {
1216 glyph = LGSTRING_GLYPH (gstring, i);
1217 if (NILP (LGLYPH_ADJUSTMENT (glyph)))
1218 width += LGLYPH_WIDTH (glyph);
1219 else
1220 {
1221 int xoff, yoff, wadjust;
1222
1223 if (j < i)
1224 {
1225 font->driver->draw (s, j, i, x, y, 0);
1226 if (s->face->overstrike)
1227 font->driver->draw (s, j, i, x + 1, y, 0);
1228 x += width;
1229 }
1230 xoff = LGLYPH_XOFF (glyph);
1231 yoff = LGLYPH_YOFF (glyph);
1232 wadjust = LGLYPH_WADJUST (glyph);
1233 font->driver->draw (s, i, i + 1, x + xoff, y + yoff, 0);
1234 if (s->face->overstrike)
1235 font->driver->draw (s, i, i + 1, x + xoff + 1, y + yoff, 0);
1236 x += wadjust;
1237 j = i + 1;
1238 width = 0;
1239 }
1240 }
1241 if (j < i)
1242 {
1243 font->driver->draw (s, j, i, x, y, 0);
1244 if (s->face->overstrike)
1245 font->driver->draw (s, j, i, x + 1, y, 0);
1246 }
1247 }
1248 }
1249
1250
1251 /* Draw the foreground of glyph string S for glyphless characters. */
1252
1253 static void
1254 x_draw_glyphless_glyph_string_foreground (struct glyph_string *s)
1255 {
1256 struct glyph *glyph = s->first_glyph;
1257 XChar2b char2b[8];
1258 int x, i, j;
1259
1260 /* If first glyph of S has a left box line, start drawing the text
1261 of S to the right of that box line. */
1262 if (s->face && s->face->box != FACE_NO_BOX
1263 && s->first_glyph->left_box_line_p)
1264 x = s->x + eabs (s->face->box_line_width);
1265 else
1266 x = s->x;
1267
1268 s->char2b = char2b;
1269
1270 for (i = 0; i < s->nchars; i++, glyph++)
1271 {
1272 char buf[7], *str = NULL;
1273 int len = glyph->u.glyphless.len;
1274
1275 if (glyph->u.glyphless.method == GLYPHLESS_DISPLAY_ACRONYM)
1276 {
1277 if (len > 0
1278 && CHAR_TABLE_P (Vglyphless_char_display)
1279 && (CHAR_TABLE_EXTRA_SLOTS (XCHAR_TABLE (Vglyphless_char_display))
1280 >= 1))
1281 {
1282 Lisp_Object acronym
1283 = (! glyph->u.glyphless.for_no_font
1284 ? CHAR_TABLE_REF (Vglyphless_char_display,
1285 glyph->u.glyphless.ch)
1286 : XCHAR_TABLE (Vglyphless_char_display)->extras[0]);
1287 if (STRINGP (acronym))
1288 str = SSDATA (acronym);
1289 }
1290 }
1291 else if (glyph->u.glyphless.method == GLYPHLESS_DISPLAY_HEX_CODE)
1292 {
1293 sprintf (buf, "%0*X",
1294 glyph->u.glyphless.ch < 0x10000 ? 4 : 6,
1295 glyph->u.glyphless.ch);
1296 str = buf;
1297 }
1298
1299 if (str)
1300 {
1301 int upper_len = (len + 1) / 2;
1302 unsigned code;
1303
1304 /* It is assured that all LEN characters in STR is ASCII. */
1305 for (j = 0; j < len; j++)
1306 {
1307 code = s->font->driver->encode_char (s->font, str[j]);
1308 STORE_XCHAR2B (char2b + j, code >> 8, code & 0xFF);
1309 }
1310 s->font->driver->draw (s, 0, upper_len,
1311 x + glyph->slice.glyphless.upper_xoff,
1312 s->ybase + glyph->slice.glyphless.upper_yoff,
1313 0);
1314 s->font->driver->draw (s, upper_len, len,
1315 x + glyph->slice.glyphless.lower_xoff,
1316 s->ybase + glyph->slice.glyphless.lower_yoff,
1317 0);
1318 }
1319 if (glyph->u.glyphless.method != GLYPHLESS_DISPLAY_THIN_SPACE)
1320 XDrawRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc,
1321 x, s->ybase - glyph->ascent,
1322 glyph->pixel_width - 1,
1323 glyph->ascent + glyph->descent - 1);
1324 x += glyph->pixel_width;
1325 }
1326 }
1327
1328 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
1329
1330 #ifdef USE_LUCID
1331
1332 /* Return the frame on which widget WIDGET is used.. Abort if frame
1333 cannot be determined. */
1334
1335 static struct frame *
1336 x_frame_of_widget (Widget widget)
1337 {
1338 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
1339 Lisp_Object tail, frame;
1340 struct frame *f;
1341
1342 dpyinfo = x_display_info_for_display (XtDisplay (widget));
1343
1344 /* Find the top-level shell of the widget. Note that this function
1345 can be called when the widget is not yet realized, so XtWindow
1346 (widget) == 0. That's the reason we can't simply use
1347 x_any_window_to_frame. */
1348 while (!XtIsTopLevelShell (widget))
1349 widget = XtParent (widget);
1350
1351 /* Look for a frame with that top-level widget. Allocate the color
1352 on that frame to get the right gamma correction value. */
1353 FOR_EACH_FRAME (tail, frame)
1354 {
1355 f = XFRAME (frame);
1356 if (FRAME_X_P (f)
1357 && f->output_data.nothing != 1
1358 && FRAME_DISPLAY_INFO (f) == dpyinfo
1359 && f->output_data.x->widget == widget)
1360 return f;
1361 }
1362 emacs_abort ();
1363 }
1364
1365 /* Allocate a color which is lighter or darker than *PIXEL by FACTOR
1366 or DELTA. Try a color with RGB values multiplied by FACTOR first.
1367 If this produces the same color as PIXEL, try a color where all RGB
1368 values have DELTA added. Return the allocated color in *PIXEL.
1369 DISPLAY is the X display, CMAP is the colormap to operate on.
1370 Value is true if successful. */
1371
1372 bool
1373 x_alloc_lighter_color_for_widget (Widget widget, Display *display, Colormap cmap,
1374 unsigned long *pixel, double factor, int delta)
1375 {
1376 struct frame *f = x_frame_of_widget (widget);
1377 return x_alloc_lighter_color (f, display, cmap, pixel, factor, delta);
1378 }
1379
1380 #endif /* USE_LUCID */
1381
1382
1383 /* Structure specifying which arguments should be passed by Xt to
1384 cvt_string_to_pixel. We want the widget's screen and colormap. */
1385
1386 static XtConvertArgRec cvt_string_to_pixel_args[] =
1387 {
1388 {XtWidgetBaseOffset, (XtPointer) XtOffset (Widget, core.screen),
1389 sizeof (Screen *)},
1390 {XtWidgetBaseOffset, (XtPointer) XtOffset (Widget, core.colormap),
1391 sizeof (Colormap)}
1392 };
1393
1394
1395 /* The address of this variable is returned by
1396 cvt_string_to_pixel. */
1397
1398 static Pixel cvt_string_to_pixel_value;
1399
1400
1401 /* Convert a color name to a pixel color.
1402
1403 DPY is the display we are working on.
1404
1405 ARGS is an array of *NARGS XrmValue structures holding additional
1406 information about the widget for which the conversion takes place.
1407 The contents of this array are determined by the specification
1408 in cvt_string_to_pixel_args.
1409
1410 FROM is a pointer to an XrmValue which points to the color name to
1411 convert. TO is an XrmValue in which to return the pixel color.
1412
1413 CLOSURE_RET is a pointer to user-data, in which we record if
1414 we allocated the color or not.
1415
1416 Value is True if successful, False otherwise. */
1417
1418 static Boolean
1419 cvt_string_to_pixel (Display *dpy, XrmValue *args, Cardinal *nargs,
1420 XrmValue *from, XrmValue *to,
1421 XtPointer *closure_ret)
1422 {
1423 Screen *screen;
1424 Colormap cmap;
1425 Pixel pixel;
1426 String color_name;
1427 XColor color;
1428
1429 if (*nargs != 2)
1430 {
1431 XtAppWarningMsg (XtDisplayToApplicationContext (dpy),
1432 "wrongParameters", "cvt_string_to_pixel",
1433 "XtToolkitError",
1434 "Screen and colormap args required", NULL, NULL);
1435 return False;
1436 }
1437
1438 screen = *(Screen **) args[0].addr;
1439 cmap = *(Colormap *) args[1].addr;
1440 color_name = (String) from->addr;
1441
1442 if (strcmp (color_name, XtDefaultBackground) == 0)
1443 {
1444 *closure_ret = (XtPointer) False;
1445 pixel = WhitePixelOfScreen (screen);
1446 }
1447 else if (strcmp (color_name, XtDefaultForeground) == 0)
1448 {
1449 *closure_ret = (XtPointer) False;
1450 pixel = BlackPixelOfScreen (screen);
1451 }
1452 else if (XParseColor (dpy, cmap, color_name, &color)
1453 && x_alloc_nearest_color_1 (dpy, cmap, &color))
1454 {
1455 pixel = color.pixel;
1456 *closure_ret = (XtPointer) True;
1457 }
1458 else
1459 {
1460 String params[1];
1461 Cardinal nparams = 1;
1462
1463 params[0] = color_name;
1464 XtAppWarningMsg (XtDisplayToApplicationContext (dpy),
1465 "badValue", "cvt_string_to_pixel",
1466 "XtToolkitError", "Invalid color `%s'",
1467 params, &nparams);
1468 return False;
1469 }
1470
1471 if (to->addr != NULL)
1472 {
1473 if (to->size < sizeof (Pixel))
1474 {
1475 to->size = sizeof (Pixel);
1476 return False;
1477 }
1478
1479 *(Pixel *) to->addr = pixel;
1480 }
1481 else
1482 {
1483 cvt_string_to_pixel_value = pixel;
1484 to->addr = (XtPointer) &cvt_string_to_pixel_value;
1485 }
1486
1487 to->size = sizeof (Pixel);
1488 return True;
1489 }
1490
1491
1492 /* Free a pixel color which was previously allocated via
1493 cvt_string_to_pixel. This is registered as the destructor
1494 for this type of resource via XtSetTypeConverter.
1495
1496 APP is the application context in which we work.
1497
1498 TO is a pointer to an XrmValue holding the color to free.
1499 CLOSURE is the value we stored in CLOSURE_RET for this color
1500 in cvt_string_to_pixel.
1501
1502 ARGS and NARGS are like for cvt_string_to_pixel. */
1503
1504 static void
1505 cvt_pixel_dtor (XtAppContext app, XrmValuePtr to, XtPointer closure, XrmValuePtr args,
1506 Cardinal *nargs)
1507 {
1508 if (*nargs != 2)
1509 {
1510 XtAppWarningMsg (app, "wrongParameters", "cvt_pixel_dtor",
1511 "XtToolkitError",
1512 "Screen and colormap arguments required",
1513 NULL, NULL);
1514 }
1515 else if (closure != NULL)
1516 {
1517 /* We did allocate the pixel, so free it. */
1518 Screen *screen = *(Screen **) args[0].addr;
1519 Colormap cmap = *(Colormap *) args[1].addr;
1520 x_free_dpy_colors (DisplayOfScreen (screen), screen, cmap,
1521 (Pixel *) to->addr, 1);
1522 }
1523 }
1524
1525
1526 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
1527
1528
1529 /* Value is an array of XColor structures for the contents of the
1530 color map of display DPY. Set *NCELLS to the size of the array.
1531 Note that this probably shouldn't be called for large color maps,
1532 say a 24-bit TrueColor map. */
1533
1534 static const XColor *
1535 x_color_cells (Display *dpy, int *ncells)
1536 {
1537 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = x_display_info_for_display (dpy);
1538
1539 if (dpyinfo->color_cells == NULL)
1540 {
1541 Screen *screen = dpyinfo->screen;
1542 int ncolor_cells = XDisplayCells (dpy, XScreenNumberOfScreen (screen));
1543 int i;
1544
1545 dpyinfo->color_cells = xnmalloc (ncolor_cells,
1546 sizeof *dpyinfo->color_cells);
1547 dpyinfo->ncolor_cells = ncolor_cells;
1548
1549 for (i = 0; i < ncolor_cells; ++i)
1550 dpyinfo->color_cells[i].pixel = i;
1551
1552 XQueryColors (dpy, dpyinfo->cmap,
1553 dpyinfo->color_cells, ncolor_cells);
1554 }
1555
1556 *ncells = dpyinfo->ncolor_cells;
1557 return dpyinfo->color_cells;
1558 }
1559
1560
1561 /* On frame F, translate pixel colors to RGB values for the NCOLORS
1562 colors in COLORS. Use cached information, if available. */
1563
1564 void
1565 x_query_colors (struct frame *f, XColor *colors, int ncolors)
1566 {
1567 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
1568
1569 if (dpyinfo->color_cells)
1570 {
1571 int i;
1572 for (i = 0; i < ncolors; ++i)
1573 {
1574 unsigned long pixel = colors[i].pixel;
1575 eassert (pixel < dpyinfo->ncolor_cells);
1576 eassert (dpyinfo->color_cells[pixel].pixel == pixel);
1577 colors[i] = dpyinfo->color_cells[pixel];
1578 }
1579 }
1580 else
1581 XQueryColors (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_COLORMAP (f), colors, ncolors);
1582 }
1583
1584
1585 /* On frame F, translate pixel color to RGB values for the color in
1586 COLOR. Use cached information, if available. */
1587
1588 void
1589 x_query_color (struct frame *f, XColor *color)
1590 {
1591 x_query_colors (f, color, 1);
1592 }
1593
1594
1595 /* Allocate the color COLOR->pixel on DISPLAY, colormap CMAP. If an
1596 exact match can't be allocated, try the nearest color available.
1597 Value is true if successful. Set *COLOR to the color
1598 allocated. */
1599
1600 static bool
1601 x_alloc_nearest_color_1 (Display *dpy, Colormap cmap, XColor *color)
1602 {
1603 bool rc;
1604
1605 rc = XAllocColor (dpy, cmap, color) != 0;
1606 if (rc == 0)
1607 {
1608 /* If we got to this point, the colormap is full, so we're going
1609 to try to get the next closest color. The algorithm used is
1610 a least-squares matching, which is what X uses for closest
1611 color matching with StaticColor visuals. */
1612 int nearest, i;
1613 int max_color_delta = 255;
1614 int max_delta = 3 * max_color_delta;
1615 int nearest_delta = max_delta + 1;
1616 int ncells;
1617 const XColor *cells = x_color_cells (dpy, &ncells);
1618
1619 for (nearest = i = 0; i < ncells; ++i)
1620 {
1621 int dred = (color->red >> 8) - (cells[i].red >> 8);
1622 int dgreen = (color->green >> 8) - (cells[i].green >> 8);
1623 int dblue = (color->blue >> 8) - (cells[i].blue >> 8);
1624 int delta = dred * dred + dgreen * dgreen + dblue * dblue;
1625
1626 if (delta < nearest_delta)
1627 {
1628 nearest = i;
1629 nearest_delta = delta;
1630 }
1631 }
1632
1633 color->red = cells[nearest].red;
1634 color->green = cells[nearest].green;
1635 color->blue = cells[nearest].blue;
1636 rc = XAllocColor (dpy, cmap, color) != 0;
1637 }
1638 else
1639 {
1640 /* If allocation succeeded, and the allocated pixel color is not
1641 equal to a cached pixel color recorded earlier, there was a
1642 change in the colormap, so clear the color cache. */
1643 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = x_display_info_for_display (dpy);
1644 XColor *cached_color;
1645
1646 if (dpyinfo->color_cells
1647 && (cached_color = &dpyinfo->color_cells[color->pixel],
1648 (cached_color->red != color->red
1649 || cached_color->blue != color->blue
1650 || cached_color->green != color->green)))
1651 {
1652 xfree (dpyinfo->color_cells);
1653 dpyinfo->color_cells = NULL;
1654 dpyinfo->ncolor_cells = 0;
1655 }
1656 }
1657
1658 #ifdef DEBUG_X_COLORS
1659 if (rc)
1660 register_color (color->pixel);
1661 #endif /* DEBUG_X_COLORS */
1662
1663 return rc;
1664 }
1665
1666
1667 /* Allocate the color COLOR->pixel on frame F, colormap CMAP. If an
1668 exact match can't be allocated, try the nearest color available.
1669 Value is true if successful. Set *COLOR to the color
1670 allocated. */
1671
1672 bool
1673 x_alloc_nearest_color (struct frame *f, Colormap cmap, XColor *color)
1674 {
1675 gamma_correct (f, color);
1676 return x_alloc_nearest_color_1 (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), cmap, color);
1677 }
1678
1679
1680 /* Allocate color PIXEL on frame F. PIXEL must already be allocated.
1681 It's necessary to do this instead of just using PIXEL directly to
1682 get color reference counts right. */
1683
1684 unsigned long
1685 x_copy_color (struct frame *f, unsigned long pixel)
1686 {
1687 XColor color;
1688
1689 color.pixel = pixel;
1690 block_input ();
1691 x_query_color (f, &color);
1692 XAllocColor (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_COLORMAP (f), &color);
1693 unblock_input ();
1694 #ifdef DEBUG_X_COLORS
1695 register_color (pixel);
1696 #endif
1697 return color.pixel;
1698 }
1699
1700
1701 /* Brightness beyond which a color won't have its highlight brightness
1702 boosted.
1703
1704 Nominally, highlight colors for `3d' faces are calculated by
1705 brightening an object's color by a constant scale factor, but this
1706 doesn't yield good results for dark colors, so for colors who's
1707 brightness is less than this value (on a scale of 0-65535) have an
1708 use an additional additive factor.
1709
1710 The value here is set so that the default menu-bar/mode-line color
1711 (grey75) will not have its highlights changed at all. */
1712 #define HIGHLIGHT_COLOR_DARK_BOOST_LIMIT 48000
1713
1714
1715 /* Allocate a color which is lighter or darker than *PIXEL by FACTOR
1716 or DELTA. Try a color with RGB values multiplied by FACTOR first.
1717 If this produces the same color as PIXEL, try a color where all RGB
1718 values have DELTA added. Return the allocated color in *PIXEL.
1719 DISPLAY is the X display, CMAP is the colormap to operate on.
1720 Value is non-zero if successful. */
1721
1722 static bool
1723 x_alloc_lighter_color (struct frame *f, Display *display, Colormap cmap,
1724 unsigned long *pixel, double factor, int delta)
1725 {
1726 XColor color, new;
1727 long bright;
1728 bool success_p;
1729
1730 /* Get RGB color values. */
1731 color.pixel = *pixel;
1732 x_query_color (f, &color);
1733
1734 /* Change RGB values by specified FACTOR. Avoid overflow! */
1735 eassert (factor >= 0);
1736 new.red = min (0xffff, factor * color.red);
1737 new.green = min (0xffff, factor * color.green);
1738 new.blue = min (0xffff, factor * color.blue);
1739
1740 /* Calculate brightness of COLOR. */
1741 bright = (2 * color.red + 3 * color.green + color.blue) / 6;
1742
1743 /* We only boost colors that are darker than
1744 HIGHLIGHT_COLOR_DARK_BOOST_LIMIT. */
1745 if (bright < HIGHLIGHT_COLOR_DARK_BOOST_LIMIT)
1746 /* Make an additive adjustment to NEW, because it's dark enough so
1747 that scaling by FACTOR alone isn't enough. */
1748 {
1749 /* How far below the limit this color is (0 - 1, 1 being darker). */
1750 double dimness = 1 - (double)bright / HIGHLIGHT_COLOR_DARK_BOOST_LIMIT;
1751 /* The additive adjustment. */
1752 int min_delta = delta * dimness * factor / 2;
1753
1754 if (factor < 1)
1755 {
1756 new.red = max (0, new.red - min_delta);
1757 new.green = max (0, new.green - min_delta);
1758 new.blue = max (0, new.blue - min_delta);
1759 }
1760 else
1761 {
1762 new.red = min (0xffff, min_delta + new.red);
1763 new.green = min (0xffff, min_delta + new.green);
1764 new.blue = min (0xffff, min_delta + new.blue);
1765 }
1766 }
1767
1768 /* Try to allocate the color. */
1769 success_p = x_alloc_nearest_color (f, cmap, &new);
1770 if (success_p)
1771 {
1772 if (new.pixel == *pixel)
1773 {
1774 /* If we end up with the same color as before, try adding
1775 delta to the RGB values. */
1776 x_free_colors (f, &new.pixel, 1);
1777
1778 new.red = min (0xffff, delta + color.red);
1779 new.green = min (0xffff, delta + color.green);
1780 new.blue = min (0xffff, delta + color.blue);
1781 success_p = x_alloc_nearest_color (f, cmap, &new);
1782 }
1783 else
1784 success_p = 1;
1785 *pixel = new.pixel;
1786 }
1787
1788 return success_p;
1789 }
1790
1791
1792 /* Set up the foreground color for drawing relief lines of glyph
1793 string S. RELIEF is a pointer to a struct relief containing the GC
1794 with which lines will be drawn. Use a color that is FACTOR or
1795 DELTA lighter or darker than the relief's background which is found
1796 in S->f->output_data.x->relief_background. If such a color cannot
1797 be allocated, use DEFAULT_PIXEL, instead. */
1798
1799 static void
1800 x_setup_relief_color (struct frame *f, struct relief *relief, double factor,
1801 int delta, unsigned long default_pixel)
1802 {
1803 XGCValues xgcv;
1804 struct x_output *di = f->output_data.x;
1805 unsigned long mask = GCForeground | GCLineWidth | GCGraphicsExposures;
1806 unsigned long pixel;
1807 unsigned long background = di->relief_background;
1808 Colormap cmap = FRAME_X_COLORMAP (f);
1809 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
1810 Display *dpy = FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f);
1811
1812 xgcv.graphics_exposures = False;
1813 xgcv.line_width = 1;
1814
1815 /* Free previously allocated color. The color cell will be reused
1816 when it has been freed as many times as it was allocated, so this
1817 doesn't affect faces using the same colors. */
1818 if (relief->gc && relief->pixel != -1)
1819 {
1820 x_free_colors (f, &relief->pixel, 1);
1821 relief->pixel = -1;
1822 }
1823
1824 /* Allocate new color. */
1825 xgcv.foreground = default_pixel;
1826 pixel = background;
1827 if (dpyinfo->n_planes != 1
1828 && x_alloc_lighter_color (f, dpy, cmap, &pixel, factor, delta))
1829 xgcv.foreground = relief->pixel = pixel;
1830
1831 if (relief->gc == 0)
1832 {
1833 xgcv.stipple = dpyinfo->gray;
1834 mask |= GCStipple;
1835 relief->gc = XCreateGC (dpy, FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), mask, &xgcv);
1836 }
1837 else
1838 XChangeGC (dpy, relief->gc, mask, &xgcv);
1839 }
1840
1841
1842 /* Set up colors for the relief lines around glyph string S. */
1843
1844 static void
1845 x_setup_relief_colors (struct glyph_string *s)
1846 {
1847 struct x_output *di = s->f->output_data.x;
1848 unsigned long color;
1849
1850 if (s->face->use_box_color_for_shadows_p)
1851 color = s->face->box_color;
1852 else if (s->first_glyph->type == IMAGE_GLYPH
1853 && s->img->pixmap
1854 && !IMAGE_BACKGROUND_TRANSPARENT (s->img, s->f, 0))
1855 color = IMAGE_BACKGROUND (s->img, s->f, 0);
1856 else
1857 {
1858 XGCValues xgcv;
1859
1860 /* Get the background color of the face. */
1861 XGetGCValues (s->display, s->gc, GCBackground, &xgcv);
1862 color = xgcv.background;
1863 }
1864
1865 if (di->white_relief.gc == 0
1866 || color != di->relief_background)
1867 {
1868 di->relief_background = color;
1869 x_setup_relief_color (s->f, &di->white_relief, 1.2, 0x8000,
1870 WHITE_PIX_DEFAULT (s->f));
1871 x_setup_relief_color (s->f, &di->black_relief, 0.6, 0x4000,
1872 BLACK_PIX_DEFAULT (s->f));
1873 }
1874 }
1875
1876
1877 /* Draw a relief on frame F inside the rectangle given by LEFT_X,
1878 TOP_Y, RIGHT_X, and BOTTOM_Y. WIDTH is the thickness of the relief
1879 to draw, it must be >= 0. RAISED_P non-zero means draw a raised
1880 relief. LEFT_P non-zero means draw a relief on the left side of
1881 the rectangle. RIGHT_P non-zero means draw a relief on the right
1882 side of the rectangle. CLIP_RECT is the clipping rectangle to use
1883 when drawing. */
1884
1885 static void
1886 x_draw_relief_rect (struct frame *f,
1887 int left_x, int top_y, int right_x, int bottom_y, int width,
1888 int raised_p, int top_p, int bot_p, int left_p, int right_p,
1889 XRectangle *clip_rect)
1890 {
1891 Display *dpy = FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f);
1892 Window window = FRAME_X_WINDOW (f);
1893 int i;
1894 GC gc;
1895
1896 if (raised_p)
1897 gc = f->output_data.x->white_relief.gc;
1898 else
1899 gc = f->output_data.x->black_relief.gc;
1900 XSetClipRectangles (dpy, gc, 0, 0, clip_rect, 1, Unsorted);
1901
1902 /* This code is more complicated than it has to be, because of two
1903 minor hacks to make the boxes look nicer: (i) if width > 1, draw
1904 the outermost line using the black relief. (ii) Omit the four
1905 corner pixels. */
1906
1907 /* Top. */
1908 if (top_p)
1909 {
1910 if (width == 1)
1911 XDrawLine (dpy, window, gc,
1912 left_x + (left_p ? 1 : 0), top_y,
1913 right_x + (right_p ? 0 : 1), top_y);
1914
1915 for (i = 1; i < width; ++i)
1916 XDrawLine (dpy, window, gc,
1917 left_x + i * left_p, top_y + i,
1918 right_x + 1 - i * right_p, top_y + i);
1919 }
1920
1921 /* Left. */
1922 if (left_p)
1923 {
1924 if (width == 1)
1925 XDrawLine (dpy, window, gc, left_x, top_y + 1, left_x, bottom_y);
1926
1927 XClearArea (dpy, window, left_x, top_y, 1, 1, False);
1928 XClearArea (dpy, window, left_x, bottom_y, 1, 1, False);
1929
1930 for (i = (width > 1 ? 1 : 0); i < width; ++i)
1931 XDrawLine (dpy, window, gc,
1932 left_x + i, top_y + (i + 1) * top_p,
1933 left_x + i, bottom_y + 1 - (i + 1) * bot_p);
1934 }
1935
1936 XSetClipMask (dpy, gc, None);
1937 if (raised_p)
1938 gc = f->output_data.x->black_relief.gc;
1939 else
1940 gc = f->output_data.x->white_relief.gc;
1941 XSetClipRectangles (dpy, gc, 0, 0, clip_rect, 1, Unsorted);
1942
1943 if (width > 1)
1944 {
1945 /* Outermost top line. */
1946 if (top_p)
1947 XDrawLine (dpy, window, gc,
1948 left_x + (left_p ? 1 : 0), top_y,
1949 right_x + (right_p ? 0 : 1), top_y);
1950
1951 /* Outermost left line. */
1952 if (left_p)
1953 XDrawLine (dpy, window, gc, left_x, top_y + 1, left_x, bottom_y);
1954 }
1955
1956 /* Bottom. */
1957 if (bot_p)
1958 {
1959 XDrawLine (dpy, window, gc,
1960 left_x + (left_p ? 1 : 0), bottom_y,
1961 right_x + (right_p ? 0 : 1), bottom_y);
1962 for (i = 1; i < width; ++i)
1963 XDrawLine (dpy, window, gc,
1964 left_x + i * left_p, bottom_y - i,
1965 right_x + 1 - i * right_p, bottom_y - i);
1966 }
1967
1968 /* Right. */
1969 if (right_p)
1970 {
1971 XClearArea (dpy, window, right_x, top_y, 1, 1, False);
1972 XClearArea (dpy, window, right_x, bottom_y, 1, 1, False);
1973 for (i = 0; i < width; ++i)
1974 XDrawLine (dpy, window, gc,
1975 right_x - i, top_y + (i + 1) * top_p,
1976 right_x - i, bottom_y + 1 - (i + 1) * bot_p);
1977 }
1978
1979 XSetClipMask (dpy, gc, None);
1980 }
1981
1982
1983 /* Draw a box on frame F inside the rectangle given by LEFT_X, TOP_Y,
1984 RIGHT_X, and BOTTOM_Y. WIDTH is the thickness of the lines to
1985 draw, it must be >= 0. LEFT_P non-zero means draw a line on the
1986 left side of the rectangle. RIGHT_P non-zero means draw a line
1987 on the right side of the rectangle. CLIP_RECT is the clipping
1988 rectangle to use when drawing. */
1989
1990 static void
1991 x_draw_box_rect (struct glyph_string *s,
1992 int left_x, int top_y, int right_x, int bottom_y, int width,
1993 int left_p, int right_p, XRectangle *clip_rect)
1994 {
1995 XGCValues xgcv;
1996
1997 XGetGCValues (s->display, s->gc, GCForeground, &xgcv);
1998 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, s->face->box_color);
1999 XSetClipRectangles (s->display, s->gc, 0, 0, clip_rect, 1, Unsorted);
2000
2001 /* Top. */
2002 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc,
2003 left_x, top_y, right_x - left_x + 1, width);
2004
2005 /* Left. */
2006 if (left_p)
2007 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc,
2008 left_x, top_y, width, bottom_y - top_y + 1);
2009
2010 /* Bottom. */
2011 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc,
2012 left_x, bottom_y - width + 1, right_x - left_x + 1, width);
2013
2014 /* Right. */
2015 if (right_p)
2016 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc,
2017 right_x - width + 1, top_y, width, bottom_y - top_y + 1);
2018
2019 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, xgcv.foreground);
2020 XSetClipMask (s->display, s->gc, None);
2021 }
2022
2023
2024 /* Draw a box around glyph string S. */
2025
2026 static void
2027 x_draw_glyph_string_box (struct glyph_string *s)
2028 {
2029 int width, left_x, right_x, top_y, bottom_y, last_x, raised_p;
2030 int left_p, right_p;
2031 struct glyph *last_glyph;
2032 XRectangle clip_rect;
2033
2034 last_x = ((s->row->full_width_p && !s->w->pseudo_window_p)
2035 ? WINDOW_RIGHT_EDGE_X (s->w)
2036 : window_box_right (s->w, s->area));
2037
2038 /* The glyph that may have a right box line. */
2039 last_glyph = (s->cmp || s->img
2040 ? s->first_glyph
2041 : s->first_glyph + s->nchars - 1);
2042
2043 width = eabs (s->face->box_line_width);
2044 raised_p = s->face->box == FACE_RAISED_BOX;
2045 left_x = s->x;
2046 right_x = (s->row->full_width_p && s->extends_to_end_of_line_p
2047 ? last_x - 1
2048 : min (last_x, s->x + s->background_width) - 1);
2049 top_y = s->y;
2050 bottom_y = top_y + s->height - 1;
2051
2052 left_p = (s->first_glyph->left_box_line_p
2053 || (s->hl == DRAW_MOUSE_FACE
2054 && (s->prev == NULL
2055 || s->prev->hl != s->hl)));
2056 right_p = (last_glyph->right_box_line_p
2057 || (s->hl == DRAW_MOUSE_FACE
2058 && (s->next == NULL
2059 || s->next->hl != s->hl)));
2060
2061 get_glyph_string_clip_rect (s, &clip_rect);
2062
2063 if (s->face->box == FACE_SIMPLE_BOX)
2064 x_draw_box_rect (s, left_x, top_y, right_x, bottom_y, width,
2065 left_p, right_p, &clip_rect);
2066 else
2067 {
2068 x_setup_relief_colors (s);
2069 x_draw_relief_rect (s->f, left_x, top_y, right_x, bottom_y,
2070 width, raised_p, 1, 1, left_p, right_p, &clip_rect);
2071 }
2072 }
2073
2074
2075 /* Draw foreground of image glyph string S. */
2076
2077 static void
2078 x_draw_image_foreground (struct glyph_string *s)
2079 {
2080 int x = s->x;
2081 int y = s->ybase - image_ascent (s->img, s->face, &s->slice);
2082
2083 /* If first glyph of S has a left box line, start drawing it to the
2084 right of that line. */
2085 if (s->face->box != FACE_NO_BOX
2086 && s->first_glyph->left_box_line_p
2087 && s->slice.x == 0)
2088 x += eabs (s->face->box_line_width);
2089
2090 /* If there is a margin around the image, adjust x- and y-position
2091 by that margin. */
2092 if (s->slice.x == 0)
2093 x += s->img->hmargin;
2094 if (s->slice.y == 0)
2095 y += s->img->vmargin;
2096
2097 if (s->img->pixmap)
2098 {
2099 if (s->img->mask)
2100 {
2101 /* We can't set both a clip mask and use XSetClipRectangles
2102 because the latter also sets a clip mask. We also can't
2103 trust on the shape extension to be available
2104 (XShapeCombineRegion). So, compute the rectangle to draw
2105 manually. */
2106 unsigned long mask = (GCClipMask | GCClipXOrigin | GCClipYOrigin
2107 | GCFunction);
2108 XGCValues xgcv;
2109 XRectangle clip_rect, image_rect, r;
2110
2111 xgcv.clip_mask = s->img->mask;
2112 xgcv.clip_x_origin = x;
2113 xgcv.clip_y_origin = y;
2114 xgcv.function = GXcopy;
2115 XChangeGC (s->display, s->gc, mask, &xgcv);
2116
2117 get_glyph_string_clip_rect (s, &clip_rect);
2118 image_rect.x = x;
2119 image_rect.y = y;
2120 image_rect.width = s->slice.width;
2121 image_rect.height = s->slice.height;
2122 if (x_intersect_rectangles (&clip_rect, &image_rect, &r))
2123 XCopyArea (s->display, s->img->pixmap, s->window, s->gc,
2124 s->slice.x + r.x - x, s->slice.y + r.y - y,
2125 r.width, r.height, r.x, r.y);
2126 }
2127 else
2128 {
2129 XRectangle clip_rect, image_rect, r;
2130
2131 get_glyph_string_clip_rect (s, &clip_rect);
2132 image_rect.x = x;
2133 image_rect.y = y;
2134 image_rect.width = s->slice.width;
2135 image_rect.height = s->slice.height;
2136 if (x_intersect_rectangles (&clip_rect, &image_rect, &r))
2137 XCopyArea (s->display, s->img->pixmap, s->window, s->gc,
2138 s->slice.x + r.x - x, s->slice.y + r.y - y,
2139 r.width, r.height, r.x, r.y);
2140
2141 /* When the image has a mask, we can expect that at
2142 least part of a mouse highlight or a block cursor will
2143 be visible. If the image doesn't have a mask, make
2144 a block cursor visible by drawing a rectangle around
2145 the image. I believe it's looking better if we do
2146 nothing here for mouse-face. */
2147 if (s->hl == DRAW_CURSOR)
2148 {
2149 int relief = eabs (s->img->relief);
2150 XDrawRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc,
2151 x - relief, y - relief,
2152 s->slice.width + relief*2 - 1,
2153 s->slice.height + relief*2 - 1);
2154 }
2155 }
2156 }
2157 else
2158 /* Draw a rectangle if image could not be loaded. */
2159 XDrawRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc, x, y,
2160 s->slice.width - 1, s->slice.height - 1);
2161 }
2162
2163
2164 /* Draw a relief around the image glyph string S. */
2165
2166 static void
2167 x_draw_image_relief (struct glyph_string *s)
2168 {
2169 int x1, y1, thick, raised_p, top_p, bot_p, left_p, right_p;
2170 int extra_x, extra_y;
2171 XRectangle r;
2172 int x = s->x;
2173 int y = s->ybase - image_ascent (s->img, s->face, &s->slice);
2174
2175 /* If first glyph of S has a left box line, start drawing it to the
2176 right of that line. */
2177 if (s->face->box != FACE_NO_BOX
2178 && s->first_glyph->left_box_line_p
2179 && s->slice.x == 0)
2180 x += eabs (s->face->box_line_width);
2181
2182 /* If there is a margin around the image, adjust x- and y-position
2183 by that margin. */
2184 if (s->slice.x == 0)
2185 x += s->img->hmargin;
2186 if (s->slice.y == 0)
2187 y += s->img->vmargin;
2188
2189 if (s->hl == DRAW_IMAGE_SUNKEN
2190 || s->hl == DRAW_IMAGE_RAISED)
2191 {
2192 thick = tool_bar_button_relief >= 0 ? tool_bar_button_relief : DEFAULT_TOOL_BAR_BUTTON_RELIEF;
2193 raised_p = s->hl == DRAW_IMAGE_RAISED;
2194 }
2195 else
2196 {
2197 thick = eabs (s->img->relief);
2198 raised_p = s->img->relief > 0;
2199 }
2200
2201 x1 = x + s->slice.width - 1;
2202 y1 = y + s->slice.height - 1;
2203
2204 extra_x = extra_y = 0;
2205 if (s->face->id == TOOL_BAR_FACE_ID)
2206 {
2207 if (CONSP (Vtool_bar_button_margin)
2208 && INTEGERP (XCAR (Vtool_bar_button_margin))
2209 && INTEGERP (XCDR (Vtool_bar_button_margin)))
2210 {
2211 extra_x = XINT (XCAR (Vtool_bar_button_margin));
2212 extra_y = XINT (XCDR (Vtool_bar_button_margin));
2213 }
2214 else if (INTEGERP (Vtool_bar_button_margin))
2215 extra_x = extra_y = XINT (Vtool_bar_button_margin);
2216 }
2217
2218 top_p = bot_p = left_p = right_p = 0;
2219
2220 if (s->slice.x == 0)
2221 x -= thick + extra_x, left_p = 1;
2222 if (s->slice.y == 0)
2223 y -= thick + extra_y, top_p = 1;
2224 if (s->slice.x + s->slice.width == s->img->width)
2225 x1 += thick + extra_x, right_p = 1;
2226 if (s->slice.y + s->slice.height == s->img->height)
2227 y1 += thick + extra_y, bot_p = 1;
2228
2229 x_setup_relief_colors (s);
2230 get_glyph_string_clip_rect (s, &r);
2231 x_draw_relief_rect (s->f, x, y, x1, y1, thick, raised_p,
2232 top_p, bot_p, left_p, right_p, &r);
2233 }
2234
2235
2236 /* Draw the foreground of image glyph string S to PIXMAP. */
2237
2238 static void
2239 x_draw_image_foreground_1 (struct glyph_string *s, Pixmap pixmap)
2240 {
2241 int x = 0;
2242 int y = s->ybase - s->y - image_ascent (s->img, s->face, &s->slice);
2243
2244 /* If first glyph of S has a left box line, start drawing it to the
2245 right of that line. */
2246 if (s->face->box != FACE_NO_BOX
2247 && s->first_glyph->left_box_line_p
2248 && s->slice.x == 0)
2249 x += eabs (s->face->box_line_width);
2250
2251 /* If there is a margin around the image, adjust x- and y-position
2252 by that margin. */
2253 if (s->slice.x == 0)
2254 x += s->img->hmargin;
2255 if (s->slice.y == 0)
2256 y += s->img->vmargin;
2257
2258 if (s->img->pixmap)
2259 {
2260 if (s->img->mask)
2261 {
2262 /* We can't set both a clip mask and use XSetClipRectangles
2263 because the latter also sets a clip mask. We also can't
2264 trust on the shape extension to be available
2265 (XShapeCombineRegion). So, compute the rectangle to draw
2266 manually. */
2267 unsigned long mask = (GCClipMask | GCClipXOrigin | GCClipYOrigin
2268 | GCFunction);
2269 XGCValues xgcv;
2270
2271 xgcv.clip_mask = s->img->mask;
2272 xgcv.clip_x_origin = x - s->slice.x;
2273 xgcv.clip_y_origin = y - s->slice.y;
2274 xgcv.function = GXcopy;
2275 XChangeGC (s->display, s->gc, mask, &xgcv);
2276
2277 XCopyArea (s->display, s->img->pixmap, pixmap, s->gc,
2278 s->slice.x, s->slice.y,
2279 s->slice.width, s->slice.height, x, y);
2280 XSetClipMask (s->display, s->gc, None);
2281 }
2282 else
2283 {
2284 XCopyArea (s->display, s->img->pixmap, pixmap, s->gc,
2285 s->slice.x, s->slice.y,
2286 s->slice.width, s->slice.height, x, y);
2287
2288 /* When the image has a mask, we can expect that at
2289 least part of a mouse highlight or a block cursor will
2290 be visible. If the image doesn't have a mask, make
2291 a block cursor visible by drawing a rectangle around
2292 the image. I believe it's looking better if we do
2293 nothing here for mouse-face. */
2294 if (s->hl == DRAW_CURSOR)
2295 {
2296 int r = eabs (s->img->relief);
2297 XDrawRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc, x - r, y - r,
2298 s->slice.width + r*2 - 1,
2299 s->slice.height + r*2 - 1);
2300 }
2301 }
2302 }
2303 else
2304 /* Draw a rectangle if image could not be loaded. */
2305 XDrawRectangle (s->display, pixmap, s->gc, x, y,
2306 s->slice.width - 1, s->slice.height - 1);
2307 }
2308
2309
2310 /* Draw part of the background of glyph string S. X, Y, W, and H
2311 give the rectangle to draw. */
2312
2313 static void
2314 x_draw_glyph_string_bg_rect (struct glyph_string *s, int x, int y, int w, int h)
2315 {
2316 if (s->stippled_p)
2317 {
2318 /* Fill background with a stipple pattern. */
2319 XSetFillStyle (s->display, s->gc, FillOpaqueStippled);
2320 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc, x, y, w, h);
2321 XSetFillStyle (s->display, s->gc, FillSolid);
2322 }
2323 else
2324 x_clear_glyph_string_rect (s, x, y, w, h);
2325 }
2326
2327
2328 /* Draw image glyph string S.
2329
2330 s->y
2331 s->x +-------------------------
2332 | s->face->box
2333 |
2334 | +-------------------------
2335 | | s->img->margin
2336 | |
2337 | | +-------------------
2338 | | | the image
2339
2340 */
2341
2342 static void
2343 x_draw_image_glyph_string (struct glyph_string *s)
2344 {
2345 int box_line_hwidth = eabs (s->face->box_line_width);
2346 int box_line_vwidth = max (s->face->box_line_width, 0);
2347 int height;
2348 Pixmap pixmap = None;
2349
2350 height = s->height;
2351 if (s->slice.y == 0)
2352 height -= box_line_vwidth;
2353 if (s->slice.y + s->slice.height >= s->img->height)
2354 height -= box_line_vwidth;
2355
2356 /* Fill background with face under the image. Do it only if row is
2357 taller than image or if image has a clip mask to reduce
2358 flickering. */
2359 s->stippled_p = s->face->stipple != 0;
2360 if (height > s->slice.height
2361 || s->img->hmargin
2362 || s->img->vmargin
2363 || s->img->mask
2364 || s->img->pixmap == 0
2365 || s->width != s->background_width)
2366 {
2367 if (s->img->mask)
2368 {
2369 /* Create a pixmap as large as the glyph string. Fill it
2370 with the background color. Copy the image to it, using
2371 its mask. Copy the temporary pixmap to the display. */
2372 Screen *screen = FRAME_X_SCREEN (s->f);
2373 int depth = DefaultDepthOfScreen (screen);
2374
2375 /* Create a pixmap as large as the glyph string. */
2376 pixmap = XCreatePixmap (s->display, s->window,
2377 s->background_width,
2378 s->height, depth);
2379
2380 /* Don't clip in the following because we're working on the
2381 pixmap. */
2382 XSetClipMask (s->display, s->gc, None);
2383
2384 /* Fill the pixmap with the background color/stipple. */
2385 if (s->stippled_p)
2386 {
2387 /* Fill background with a stipple pattern. */
2388 XSetFillStyle (s->display, s->gc, FillOpaqueStippled);
2389 XSetTSOrigin (s->display, s->gc, - s->x, - s->y);
2390 XFillRectangle (s->display, pixmap, s->gc,
2391 0, 0, s->background_width, s->height);
2392 XSetFillStyle (s->display, s->gc, FillSolid);
2393 XSetTSOrigin (s->display, s->gc, 0, 0);
2394 }
2395 else
2396 {
2397 XGCValues xgcv;
2398 XGetGCValues (s->display, s->gc, GCForeground | GCBackground,
2399 &xgcv);
2400 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, xgcv.background);
2401 XFillRectangle (s->display, pixmap, s->gc,
2402 0, 0, s->background_width, s->height);
2403 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, xgcv.foreground);
2404 }
2405 }
2406 else
2407 {
2408 int x = s->x;
2409 int y = s->y;
2410 int width = s->background_width;
2411
2412 if (s->first_glyph->left_box_line_p
2413 && s->slice.x == 0)
2414 {
2415 x += box_line_hwidth;
2416 width -= box_line_hwidth;
2417 }
2418
2419 if (s->slice.y == 0)
2420 y += box_line_vwidth;
2421
2422 x_draw_glyph_string_bg_rect (s, x, y, width, height);
2423 }
2424
2425 s->background_filled_p = 1;
2426 }
2427
2428 /* Draw the foreground. */
2429 if (pixmap != None)
2430 {
2431 x_draw_image_foreground_1 (s, pixmap);
2432 x_set_glyph_string_clipping (s);
2433 XCopyArea (s->display, pixmap, s->window, s->gc,
2434 0, 0, s->background_width, s->height, s->x, s->y);
2435 XFreePixmap (s->display, pixmap);
2436 }
2437 else
2438 x_draw_image_foreground (s);
2439
2440 /* If we must draw a relief around the image, do it. */
2441 if (s->img->relief
2442 || s->hl == DRAW_IMAGE_RAISED
2443 || s->hl == DRAW_IMAGE_SUNKEN)
2444 x_draw_image_relief (s);
2445 }
2446
2447
2448 /* Draw stretch glyph string S. */
2449
2450 static void
2451 x_draw_stretch_glyph_string (struct glyph_string *s)
2452 {
2453 eassert (s->first_glyph->type == STRETCH_GLYPH);
2454
2455 if (s->hl == DRAW_CURSOR
2456 && !x_stretch_cursor_p)
2457 {
2458 /* If `x-stretch-cursor' is nil, don't draw a block cursor as
2459 wide as the stretch glyph. */
2460 int width, background_width = s->background_width;
2461 int x = s->x;
2462
2463 if (!s->row->reversed_p)
2464 {
2465 int left_x = window_box_left_offset (s->w, TEXT_AREA);
2466
2467 if (x < left_x)
2468 {
2469 background_width -= left_x - x;
2470 x = left_x;
2471 }
2472 }
2473 else
2474 {
2475 /* In R2L rows, draw the cursor on the right edge of the
2476 stretch glyph. */
2477 int right_x = window_box_right (s->w, TEXT_AREA);
2478
2479 if (x + background_width > right_x)
2480 background_width -= x - right_x;
2481 x += background_width;
2482 }
2483 width = min (FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (s->f), background_width);
2484 if (s->row->reversed_p)
2485 x -= width;
2486
2487 /* Draw cursor. */
2488 x_draw_glyph_string_bg_rect (s, x, s->y, width, s->height);
2489
2490 /* Clear rest using the GC of the original non-cursor face. */
2491 if (width < background_width)
2492 {
2493 int y = s->y;
2494 int w = background_width - width, h = s->height;
2495 XRectangle r;
2496 GC gc;
2497
2498 if (!s->row->reversed_p)
2499 x += width;
2500 else
2501 x = s->x;
2502 if (s->row->mouse_face_p
2503 && cursor_in_mouse_face_p (s->w))
2504 {
2505 x_set_mouse_face_gc (s);
2506 gc = s->gc;
2507 }
2508 else
2509 gc = s->face->gc;
2510
2511 get_glyph_string_clip_rect (s, &r);
2512 XSetClipRectangles (s->display, gc, 0, 0, &r, 1, Unsorted);
2513
2514 if (s->face->stipple)
2515 {
2516 /* Fill background with a stipple pattern. */
2517 XSetFillStyle (s->display, gc, FillOpaqueStippled);
2518 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, gc, x, y, w, h);
2519 XSetFillStyle (s->display, gc, FillSolid);
2520 }
2521 else
2522 {
2523 XGCValues xgcv;
2524 XGetGCValues (s->display, gc, GCForeground | GCBackground, &xgcv);
2525 XSetForeground (s->display, gc, xgcv.background);
2526 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, gc, x, y, w, h);
2527 XSetForeground (s->display, gc, xgcv.foreground);
2528 }
2529
2530 XSetClipMask (s->display, gc, None);
2531 }
2532 }
2533 else if (!s->background_filled_p)
2534 {
2535 int background_width = s->background_width;
2536 int x = s->x, left_x = window_box_left_offset (s->w, TEXT_AREA);
2537
2538 /* Don't draw into left margin, fringe or scrollbar area
2539 except for header line and mode line. */
2540 if (x < left_x && !s->row->mode_line_p)
2541 {
2542 background_width -= left_x - x;
2543 x = left_x;
2544 }
2545 if (background_width > 0)
2546 x_draw_glyph_string_bg_rect (s, x, s->y, background_width, s->height);
2547 }
2548
2549 s->background_filled_p = 1;
2550 }
2551
2552 /*
2553 Draw a wavy line under S. The wave fills wave_height pixels from y0.
2554
2555 x0 wave_length = 2
2556 --
2557 y0 * * * * *
2558 |* * * * * * * * *
2559 wave_height = 3 | * * * *
2560
2561 */
2562
2563 static void
2564 x_draw_underwave (struct glyph_string *s)
2565 {
2566 int wave_height = 3, wave_length = 2;
2567 int dx, dy, x0, y0, width, x1, y1, x2, y2, odd, xmax;
2568 XRectangle wave_clip, string_clip, final_clip;
2569
2570 dx = wave_length;
2571 dy = wave_height - 1;
2572 x0 = s->x;
2573 y0 = s->ybase - wave_height + 3;
2574 width = s->width;
2575 xmax = x0 + width;
2576
2577 /* Find and set clipping rectangle */
2578
2579 wave_clip.x = x0;
2580 wave_clip.y = y0;
2581 wave_clip.width = width;
2582 wave_clip.height = wave_height;
2583 get_glyph_string_clip_rect (s, &string_clip);
2584
2585 if (!x_intersect_rectangles (&wave_clip, &string_clip, &final_clip))
2586 return;
2587
2588 XSetClipRectangles (s->display, s->gc, 0, 0, &final_clip, 1, Unsorted);
2589
2590 /* Draw the waves */
2591
2592 x1 = x0 - (x0 % dx);
2593 x2 = x1 + dx;
2594 odd = (x1/dx) % 2;
2595 y1 = y2 = y0;
2596
2597 if (odd)
2598 y1 += dy;
2599 else
2600 y2 += dy;
2601
2602 if (INT_MAX - dx < xmax)
2603 emacs_abort ();
2604
2605 while (x1 <= xmax)
2606 {
2607 XDrawLine (s->display, s->window, s->gc, x1, y1, x2, y2);
2608 x1 = x2, y1 = y2;
2609 x2 += dx, y2 = y0 + odd*dy;
2610 odd = !odd;
2611 }
2612
2613 /* Restore previous clipping rectangle(s) */
2614 XSetClipRectangles (s->display, s->gc, 0, 0, s->clip, s->num_clips, Unsorted);
2615 }
2616
2617
2618 /* Draw glyph string S. */
2619
2620 static void
2621 x_draw_glyph_string (struct glyph_string *s)
2622 {
2623 bool relief_drawn_p = 0;
2624
2625 /* If S draws into the background of its successors, draw the
2626 background of the successors first so that S can draw into it.
2627 This makes S->next use XDrawString instead of XDrawImageString. */
2628 if (s->next && s->right_overhang && !s->for_overlaps)
2629 {
2630 int width;
2631 struct glyph_string *next;
2632
2633 for (width = 0, next = s->next;
2634 next && width < s->right_overhang;
2635 width += next->width, next = next->next)
2636 if (next->first_glyph->type != IMAGE_GLYPH)
2637 {
2638 x_set_glyph_string_gc (next);
2639 x_set_glyph_string_clipping (next);
2640 if (next->first_glyph->type == STRETCH_GLYPH)
2641 x_draw_stretch_glyph_string (next);
2642 else
2643 x_draw_glyph_string_background (next, 1);
2644 next->num_clips = 0;
2645 }
2646 }
2647
2648 /* Set up S->gc, set clipping and draw S. */
2649 x_set_glyph_string_gc (s);
2650
2651 /* Draw relief (if any) in advance for char/composition so that the
2652 glyph string can be drawn over it. */
2653 if (!s->for_overlaps
2654 && s->face->box != FACE_NO_BOX
2655 && (s->first_glyph->type == CHAR_GLYPH
2656 || s->first_glyph->type == COMPOSITE_GLYPH))
2657
2658 {
2659 x_set_glyph_string_clipping (s);
2660 x_draw_glyph_string_background (s, 1);
2661 x_draw_glyph_string_box (s);
2662 x_set_glyph_string_clipping (s);
2663 relief_drawn_p = 1;
2664 }
2665 else if (!s->clip_head /* draw_glyphs didn't specify a clip mask. */
2666 && !s->clip_tail
2667 && ((s->prev && s->prev->hl != s->hl && s->left_overhang)
2668 || (s->next && s->next->hl != s->hl && s->right_overhang)))
2669 /* We must clip just this glyph. left_overhang part has already
2670 drawn when s->prev was drawn, and right_overhang part will be
2671 drawn later when s->next is drawn. */
2672 x_set_glyph_string_clipping_exactly (s, s);
2673 else
2674 x_set_glyph_string_clipping (s);
2675
2676 switch (s->first_glyph->type)
2677 {
2678 case IMAGE_GLYPH:
2679 x_draw_image_glyph_string (s);
2680 break;
2681
2682 case STRETCH_GLYPH:
2683 x_draw_stretch_glyph_string (s);
2684 break;
2685
2686 case CHAR_GLYPH:
2687 if (s->for_overlaps)
2688 s->background_filled_p = 1;
2689 else
2690 x_draw_glyph_string_background (s, 0);
2691 x_draw_glyph_string_foreground (s);
2692 break;
2693
2694 case COMPOSITE_GLYPH:
2695 if (s->for_overlaps || (s->cmp_from > 0
2696 && ! s->first_glyph->u.cmp.automatic))
2697 s->background_filled_p = 1;
2698 else
2699 x_draw_glyph_string_background (s, 1);
2700 x_draw_composite_glyph_string_foreground (s);
2701 break;
2702
2703 case GLYPHLESS_GLYPH:
2704 if (s->for_overlaps)
2705 s->background_filled_p = 1;
2706 else
2707 x_draw_glyph_string_background (s, 1);
2708 x_draw_glyphless_glyph_string_foreground (s);
2709 break;
2710
2711 default:
2712 emacs_abort ();
2713 }
2714
2715 if (!s->for_overlaps)
2716 {
2717 /* Draw underline. */
2718 if (s->face->underline_p)
2719 {
2720 if (s->face->underline_type == FACE_UNDER_WAVE)
2721 {
2722 if (s->face->underline_defaulted_p)
2723 x_draw_underwave (s);
2724 else
2725 {
2726 XGCValues xgcv;
2727 XGetGCValues (s->display, s->gc, GCForeground, &xgcv);
2728 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, s->face->underline_color);
2729 x_draw_underwave (s);
2730 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, xgcv.foreground);
2731 }
2732 }
2733 else if (s->face->underline_type == FACE_UNDER_LINE)
2734 {
2735 unsigned long thickness, position;
2736 int y;
2737
2738 if (s->prev && s->prev->face->underline_p
2739 && s->prev->face->underline_type == FACE_UNDER_LINE)
2740 {
2741 /* We use the same underline style as the previous one. */
2742 thickness = s->prev->underline_thickness;
2743 position = s->prev->underline_position;
2744 }
2745 else
2746 {
2747 /* Get the underline thickness. Default is 1 pixel. */
2748 if (s->font && s->font->underline_thickness > 0)
2749 thickness = s->font->underline_thickness;
2750 else
2751 thickness = 1;
2752 if (x_underline_at_descent_line)
2753 position = (s->height - thickness) - (s->ybase - s->y);
2754 else
2755 {
2756 /* Get the underline position. This is the recommended
2757 vertical offset in pixels from the baseline to the top of
2758 the underline. This is a signed value according to the
2759 specs, and its default is
2760
2761 ROUND ((maximum descent) / 2), with
2762 ROUND(x) = floor (x + 0.5) */
2763
2764 if (x_use_underline_position_properties
2765 && s->font && s->font->underline_position >= 0)
2766 position = s->font->underline_position;
2767 else if (s->font)
2768 position = (s->font->descent + 1) / 2;
2769 else
2770 position = underline_minimum_offset;
2771 }
2772 position = max (position, underline_minimum_offset);
2773 }
2774 /* Check the sanity of thickness and position. We should
2775 avoid drawing underline out of the current line area. */
2776 if (s->y + s->height <= s->ybase + position)
2777 position = (s->height - 1) - (s->ybase - s->y);
2778 if (s->y + s->height < s->ybase + position + thickness)
2779 thickness = (s->y + s->height) - (s->ybase + position);
2780 s->underline_thickness = thickness;
2781 s->underline_position = position;
2782 y = s->ybase + position;
2783 if (s->face->underline_defaulted_p)
2784 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc,
2785 s->x, y, s->width, thickness);
2786 else
2787 {
2788 XGCValues xgcv;
2789 XGetGCValues (s->display, s->gc, GCForeground, &xgcv);
2790 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, s->face->underline_color);
2791 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc,
2792 s->x, y, s->width, thickness);
2793 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, xgcv.foreground);
2794 }
2795 }
2796 }
2797 /* Draw overline. */
2798 if (s->face->overline_p)
2799 {
2800 unsigned long dy = 0, h = 1;
2801
2802 if (s->face->overline_color_defaulted_p)
2803 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc, s->x, s->y + dy,
2804 s->width, h);
2805 else
2806 {
2807 XGCValues xgcv;
2808 XGetGCValues (s->display, s->gc, GCForeground, &xgcv);
2809 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, s->face->overline_color);
2810 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc, s->x, s->y + dy,
2811 s->width, h);
2812 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, xgcv.foreground);
2813 }
2814 }
2815
2816 /* Draw strike-through. */
2817 if (s->face->strike_through_p)
2818 {
2819 unsigned long h = 1;
2820 unsigned long dy = (s->height - h) / 2;
2821
2822 if (s->face->strike_through_color_defaulted_p)
2823 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc, s->x, s->y + dy,
2824 s->width, h);
2825 else
2826 {
2827 XGCValues xgcv;
2828 XGetGCValues (s->display, s->gc, GCForeground, &xgcv);
2829 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, s->face->strike_through_color);
2830 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc, s->x, s->y + dy,
2831 s->width, h);
2832 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, xgcv.foreground);
2833 }
2834 }
2835
2836 /* Draw relief if not yet drawn. */
2837 if (!relief_drawn_p && s->face->box != FACE_NO_BOX)
2838 x_draw_glyph_string_box (s);
2839
2840 if (s->prev)
2841 {
2842 struct glyph_string *prev;
2843
2844 for (prev = s->prev; prev; prev = prev->prev)
2845 if (prev->hl != s->hl
2846 && prev->x + prev->width + prev->right_overhang > s->x)
2847 {
2848 /* As prev was drawn while clipped to its own area, we
2849 must draw the right_overhang part using s->hl now. */
2850 enum draw_glyphs_face save = prev->hl;
2851
2852 prev->hl = s->hl;
2853 x_set_glyph_string_gc (prev);
2854 x_set_glyph_string_clipping_exactly (s, prev);
2855 if (prev->first_glyph->type == CHAR_GLYPH)
2856 x_draw_glyph_string_foreground (prev);
2857 else
2858 x_draw_composite_glyph_string_foreground (prev);
2859 XSetClipMask (prev->display, prev->gc, None);
2860 prev->hl = save;
2861 prev->num_clips = 0;
2862 }
2863 }
2864
2865 if (s->next)
2866 {
2867 struct glyph_string *next;
2868
2869 for (next = s->next; next; next = next->next)
2870 if (next->hl != s->hl
2871 && next->x - next->left_overhang < s->x + s->width)
2872 {
2873 /* As next will be drawn while clipped to its own area,
2874 we must draw the left_overhang part using s->hl now. */
2875 enum draw_glyphs_face save = next->hl;
2876
2877 next->hl = s->hl;
2878 x_set_glyph_string_gc (next);
2879 x_set_glyph_string_clipping_exactly (s, next);
2880 if (next->first_glyph->type == CHAR_GLYPH)
2881 x_draw_glyph_string_foreground (next);
2882 else
2883 x_draw_composite_glyph_string_foreground (next);
2884 XSetClipMask (next->display, next->gc, None);
2885 next->hl = save;
2886 next->num_clips = 0;
2887 next->clip_head = s->next;
2888 }
2889 }
2890 }
2891
2892 /* Reset clipping. */
2893 XSetClipMask (s->display, s->gc, None);
2894 s->num_clips = 0;
2895 }
2896
2897 /* Shift display to make room for inserted glyphs. */
2898
2899 static void
2900 x_shift_glyphs_for_insert (struct frame *f, int x, int y, int width, int height, int shift_by)
2901 {
2902 XCopyArea (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
2903 f->output_data.x->normal_gc,
2904 x, y, width, height,
2905 x + shift_by, y);
2906 }
2907
2908 /* Delete N glyphs at the nominal cursor position. Not implemented
2909 for X frames. */
2910
2911 static void
2912 x_delete_glyphs (struct frame *f, register int n)
2913 {
2914 emacs_abort ();
2915 }
2916
2917
2918 /* Like XClearArea, but check that WIDTH and HEIGHT are reasonable.
2919 If they are <= 0, this is probably an error. */
2920
2921 void
2922 x_clear_area (Display *dpy, Window window, int x, int y, int width, int height)
2923 {
2924 eassert (width > 0 && height > 0);
2925 XClearArea (dpy, window, x, y, width, height, False);
2926 }
2927
2928
2929 /* Clear an entire frame. */
2930
2931 static void
2932 x_clear_frame (struct frame *f)
2933 {
2934 /* Clearing the frame will erase any cursor, so mark them all as no
2935 longer visible. */
2936 mark_window_cursors_off (XWINDOW (FRAME_ROOT_WINDOW (f)));
2937
2938 block_input ();
2939
2940 XClearWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f));
2941
2942 /* We have to clear the scroll bars. If we have changed colors or
2943 something like that, then they should be notified. */
2944 x_scroll_bar_clear (f);
2945
2946 #if defined (USE_GTK) && defined (USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS)
2947 /* Make sure scroll bars are redrawn. As they aren't redrawn by
2948 redisplay, do it here. */
2949 if (FRAME_GTK_WIDGET (f))
2950 gtk_widget_queue_draw (FRAME_GTK_WIDGET (f));
2951 #endif
2952
2953 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
2954
2955 unblock_input ();
2956 }
2957
2958 /* RIF: Show hourglass cursor on frame F. */
2959
2960 static void
2961 x_show_hourglass (struct frame *f)
2962 {
2963 Display *dpy = FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f);
2964
2965 if (dpy)
2966 {
2967 struct x_output *x = FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f);
2968 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
2969 if (x->widget)
2970 #else
2971 if (FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f))
2972 #endif
2973 {
2974 x->hourglass_p = 1;
2975
2976 if (!x->hourglass_window)
2977 {
2978 unsigned long mask = CWCursor;
2979 XSetWindowAttributes attrs;
2980 #ifdef USE_GTK
2981 Window parent = FRAME_X_WINDOW (f);
2982 #else
2983 Window parent = FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f);
2984 #endif
2985 attrs.cursor = x->hourglass_cursor;
2986
2987 x->hourglass_window = XCreateWindow
2988 (dpy, parent, 0, 0, 32000, 32000, 0, 0,
2989 InputOnly, CopyFromParent, mask, &attrs);
2990 }
2991
2992 XMapRaised (dpy, x->hourglass_window);
2993 XFlush (dpy);
2994 }
2995 }
2996 }
2997
2998 /* RIF: Cancel hourglass cursor on frame F. */
2999
3000 static void
3001 x_hide_hourglass (struct frame *f)
3002 {
3003 struct x_output *x = FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f);
3004
3005 /* Watch out for newly created frames. */
3006 if (x->hourglass_window)
3007 {
3008 XUnmapWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), x->hourglass_window);
3009 /* Sync here because XTread_socket looks at the
3010 hourglass_p flag that is reset to zero below. */
3011 XSync (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), False);
3012 x->hourglass_p = 0;
3013 }
3014 }
3015
3016 /* Invert the middle quarter of the frame for .15 sec. */
3017
3018 static void
3019 XTflash (struct frame *f)
3020 {
3021 block_input ();
3022
3023 {
3024 #ifdef USE_GTK
3025 /* Use Gdk routines to draw. This way, we won't draw over scroll bars
3026 when the scroll bars and the edit widget share the same X window. */
3027 GdkWindow *window = gtk_widget_get_window (FRAME_GTK_WIDGET (f));
3028 #ifdef HAVE_GTK3
3029 cairo_t *cr = gdk_cairo_create (window);
3030 cairo_set_source_rgb (cr, 1, 1, 1);
3031 cairo_set_operator (cr, CAIRO_OPERATOR_DIFFERENCE);
3032 #define XFillRectangle(d, win, gc, x, y, w, h) \
3033 do { \
3034 cairo_rectangle (cr, x, y, w, h); \
3035 cairo_fill (cr); \
3036 } \
3037 while (0)
3038 #else /* ! HAVE_GTK3 */
3039 GdkGCValues vals;
3040 GdkGC *gc;
3041 vals.foreground.pixel = (FRAME_FOREGROUND_PIXEL (f)
3042 ^ FRAME_BACKGROUND_PIXEL (f));
3043 vals.function = GDK_XOR;
3044 gc = gdk_gc_new_with_values (window,
3045 &vals, GDK_GC_FUNCTION | GDK_GC_FOREGROUND);
3046 #define XFillRectangle(d, win, gc, x, y, w, h) \
3047 gdk_draw_rectangle (window, gc, TRUE, x, y, w, h)
3048 #endif /* ! HAVE_GTK3 */
3049 #else /* ! USE_GTK */
3050 GC gc;
3051
3052 /* Create a GC that will use the GXxor function to flip foreground
3053 pixels into background pixels. */
3054 {
3055 XGCValues values;
3056
3057 values.function = GXxor;
3058 values.foreground = (FRAME_FOREGROUND_PIXEL (f)
3059 ^ FRAME_BACKGROUND_PIXEL (f));
3060
3061 gc = XCreateGC (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
3062 GCFunction | GCForeground, &values);
3063 }
3064 #endif
3065 {
3066 /* Get the height not including a menu bar widget. */
3067 int height = FRAME_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f);
3068 /* Height of each line to flash. */
3069 int flash_height = FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (f);
3070 /* These will be the left and right margins of the rectangles. */
3071 int flash_left = FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f);
3072 int flash_right = FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f) - FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f);
3073 int width = flash_right - flash_left;
3074
3075 /* If window is tall, flash top and bottom line. */
3076 if (height > 3 * FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (f))
3077 {
3078 XFillRectangle (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), gc,
3079 flash_left,
3080 (FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f)
3081 + FRAME_TOP_MARGIN_HEIGHT (f)),
3082 width, flash_height);
3083 XFillRectangle (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), gc,
3084 flash_left,
3085 (height - flash_height
3086 - FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f)),
3087 width, flash_height);
3088
3089 }
3090 else
3091 /* If it is short, flash it all. */
3092 XFillRectangle (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), gc,
3093 flash_left, FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f),
3094 width, height - 2 * FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f));
3095
3096 x_flush (f);
3097
3098 {
3099 struct timespec delay = make_timespec (0, 150 * 1000 * 1000);
3100 struct timespec wakeup = timespec_add (current_timespec (), delay);
3101
3102 /* Keep waiting until past the time wakeup or any input gets
3103 available. */
3104 while (! detect_input_pending ())
3105 {
3106 struct timespec current = current_timespec ();
3107 struct timespec timeout;
3108
3109 /* Break if result would not be positive. */
3110 if (timespec_cmp (wakeup, current) <= 0)
3111 break;
3112
3113 /* How long `select' should wait. */
3114 timeout = make_timespec (0, 10 * 1000 * 1000);
3115
3116 /* Try to wait that long--but we might wake up sooner. */
3117 pselect (0, NULL, NULL, NULL, &timeout, NULL);
3118 }
3119 }
3120
3121 /* If window is tall, flash top and bottom line. */
3122 if (height > 3 * FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (f))
3123 {
3124 XFillRectangle (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), gc,
3125 flash_left,
3126 (FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f)
3127 + FRAME_TOP_MARGIN_HEIGHT (f)),
3128 width, flash_height);
3129 XFillRectangle (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), gc,
3130 flash_left,
3131 (height - flash_height
3132 - FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f)),
3133 width, flash_height);
3134 }
3135 else
3136 /* If it is short, flash it all. */
3137 XFillRectangle (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), gc,
3138 flash_left, FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f),
3139 width, height - 2 * FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f));
3140
3141 #ifdef USE_GTK
3142 #ifdef HAVE_GTK3
3143 cairo_destroy (cr);
3144 #else
3145 g_object_unref (G_OBJECT (gc));
3146 #endif
3147 #undef XFillRectangle
3148 #else
3149 XFreeGC (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), gc);
3150 #endif
3151 x_flush (f);
3152 }
3153 }
3154
3155 unblock_input ();
3156 }
3157
3158
3159 static void
3160 XTtoggle_invisible_pointer (struct frame *f, int invisible)
3161 {
3162 block_input ();
3163 FRAME_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->toggle_visible_pointer (f, invisible);
3164 unblock_input ();
3165 }
3166
3167
3168 /* Make audible bell. */
3169
3170 static void
3171 XTring_bell (struct frame *f)
3172 {
3173 if (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f))
3174 {
3175 if (visible_bell)
3176 XTflash (f);
3177 else
3178 {
3179 block_input ();
3180 #ifdef HAVE_XKB
3181 XkbBell (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), None, 0, None);
3182 #else
3183 XBell (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), 0);
3184 #endif
3185 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
3186 unblock_input ();
3187 }
3188 }
3189 }
3190
3191 /***********************************************************************
3192 Line Dance
3193 ***********************************************************************/
3194
3195 /* Perform an insert-lines or delete-lines operation, inserting N
3196 lines or deleting -N lines at vertical position VPOS. */
3197
3198 static void
3199 x_ins_del_lines (struct frame *f, int vpos, int n)
3200 {
3201 emacs_abort ();
3202 }
3203
3204
3205 /* Scroll part of the display as described by RUN. */
3206
3207 static void
3208 x_scroll_run (struct window *w, struct run *run)
3209 {
3210 struct frame *f = XFRAME (w->frame);
3211 int x, y, width, height, from_y, to_y, bottom_y;
3212
3213 /* Get frame-relative bounding box of the text display area of W,
3214 without mode lines. Include in this box the left and right
3215 fringe of W. */
3216 window_box (w, ANY_AREA, &x, &y, &width, &height);
3217
3218 from_y = WINDOW_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_Y (w, run->current_y);
3219 to_y = WINDOW_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_Y (w, run->desired_y);
3220 bottom_y = y + height;
3221
3222 if (to_y < from_y)
3223 {
3224 /* Scrolling up. Make sure we don't copy part of the mode
3225 line at the bottom. */
3226 if (from_y + run->height > bottom_y)
3227 height = bottom_y - from_y;
3228 else
3229 height = run->height;
3230 }
3231 else
3232 {
3233 /* Scrolling down. Make sure we don't copy over the mode line.
3234 at the bottom. */
3235 if (to_y + run->height > bottom_y)
3236 height = bottom_y - to_y;
3237 else
3238 height = run->height;
3239 }
3240
3241 block_input ();
3242
3243 /* Cursor off. Will be switched on again in x_update_window_end. */
3244 x_clear_cursor (w);
3245
3246 XCopyArea (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f),
3247 FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
3248 f->output_data.x->normal_gc,
3249 x, from_y,
3250 width, height,
3251 x, to_y);
3252
3253 unblock_input ();
3254 }
3255
3256
3257 \f
3258 /***********************************************************************
3259 Exposure Events
3260 ***********************************************************************/
3261
3262 \f
3263 static void
3264 frame_highlight (struct frame *f)
3265 {
3266 /* We used to only do this if Vx_no_window_manager was non-nil, but
3267 the ICCCM (section 4.1.6) says that the window's border pixmap
3268 and border pixel are window attributes which are "private to the
3269 client", so we can always change it to whatever we want. */
3270 block_input ();
3271 /* I recently started to get errors in this XSetWindowBorder, depending on
3272 the window-manager in use, tho something more is at play since I've been
3273 using that same window-manager binary for ever. Let's not crash just
3274 because of this (bug#9310). */
3275 x_catch_errors (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
3276 XSetWindowBorder (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
3277 f->output_data.x->border_pixel);
3278 x_uncatch_errors ();
3279 unblock_input ();
3280 x_update_cursor (f, 1);
3281 x_set_frame_alpha (f);
3282 }
3283
3284 static void
3285 frame_unhighlight (struct frame *f)
3286 {
3287 /* We used to only do this if Vx_no_window_manager was non-nil, but
3288 the ICCCM (section 4.1.6) says that the window's border pixmap
3289 and border pixel are window attributes which are "private to the
3290 client", so we can always change it to whatever we want. */
3291 block_input ();
3292 /* Same as above for XSetWindowBorder (bug#9310). */
3293 x_catch_errors (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
3294 XSetWindowBorderPixmap (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
3295 f->output_data.x->border_tile);
3296 x_uncatch_errors ();
3297 unblock_input ();
3298 x_update_cursor (f, 1);
3299 x_set_frame_alpha (f);
3300 }
3301
3302 /* The focus has changed. Update the frames as necessary to reflect
3303 the new situation. Note that we can't change the selected frame
3304 here, because the Lisp code we are interrupting might become confused.
3305 Each event gets marked with the frame in which it occurred, so the
3306 Lisp code can tell when the switch took place by examining the events. */
3307
3308 static void
3309 x_new_focus_frame (struct x_display_info *dpyinfo, struct frame *frame)
3310 {
3311 struct frame *old_focus = dpyinfo->x_focus_frame;
3312
3313 if (frame != dpyinfo->x_focus_frame)
3314 {
3315 /* Set this before calling other routines, so that they see
3316 the correct value of x_focus_frame. */
3317 dpyinfo->x_focus_frame = frame;
3318
3319 if (old_focus && old_focus->auto_lower)
3320 x_lower_frame (old_focus);
3321
3322 if (dpyinfo->x_focus_frame && dpyinfo->x_focus_frame->auto_raise)
3323 dpyinfo->x_pending_autoraise_frame = dpyinfo->x_focus_frame;
3324 else
3325 dpyinfo->x_pending_autoraise_frame = NULL;
3326 }
3327
3328 x_frame_rehighlight (dpyinfo);
3329 }
3330
3331 /* Handle FocusIn and FocusOut state changes for FRAME.
3332 If FRAME has focus and there exists more than one frame, puts
3333 a FOCUS_IN_EVENT into *BUFP. */
3334
3335 static void
3336 x_focus_changed (int type, int state, struct x_display_info *dpyinfo, struct frame *frame, struct input_event *bufp)
3337 {
3338 if (type == FocusIn)
3339 {
3340 if (dpyinfo->x_focus_event_frame != frame)
3341 {
3342 x_new_focus_frame (dpyinfo, frame);
3343 dpyinfo->x_focus_event_frame = frame;
3344
3345 /* Don't stop displaying the initial startup message
3346 for a switch-frame event we don't need. */
3347 /* When run as a daemon, Vterminal_frame is always NIL. */
3348 bufp->arg = (((NILP (Vterminal_frame)
3349 || ! FRAME_X_P (XFRAME (Vterminal_frame))
3350 || EQ (Fdaemonp (), Qt))
3351 && CONSP (Vframe_list)
3352 && !NILP (XCDR (Vframe_list)))
3353 ? Qt : Qnil);
3354 bufp->kind = FOCUS_IN_EVENT;
3355 XSETFRAME (bufp->frame_or_window, frame);
3356 }
3357
3358 frame->output_data.x->focus_state |= state;
3359
3360 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
3361 if (FRAME_XIC (frame))
3362 XSetICFocus (FRAME_XIC (frame));
3363 #endif
3364 }
3365 else if (type == FocusOut)
3366 {
3367 frame->output_data.x->focus_state &= ~state;
3368
3369 if (dpyinfo->x_focus_event_frame == frame)
3370 {
3371 dpyinfo->x_focus_event_frame = 0;
3372 x_new_focus_frame (dpyinfo, 0);
3373
3374 bufp->kind = FOCUS_OUT_EVENT;
3375 XSETFRAME (bufp->frame_or_window, frame);
3376 }
3377
3378 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
3379 if (FRAME_XIC (frame))
3380 XUnsetICFocus (FRAME_XIC (frame));
3381 #endif
3382 if (frame->pointer_invisible)
3383 XTtoggle_invisible_pointer (frame, 0);
3384 }
3385 }
3386
3387 /* Return the Emacs frame-object corresponding to an X window.
3388 It could be the frame's main window or an icon window. */
3389
3390 static struct frame *
3391 x_window_to_frame (struct x_display_info *dpyinfo, int wdesc)
3392 {
3393 Lisp_Object tail, frame;
3394 struct frame *f;
3395
3396 if (wdesc == None)
3397 return NULL;
3398
3399 FOR_EACH_FRAME (tail, frame)
3400 {
3401 f = XFRAME (frame);
3402 if (!FRAME_X_P (f) || FRAME_DISPLAY_INFO (f) != dpyinfo)
3403 continue;
3404 if (f->output_data.x->hourglass_window == wdesc)
3405 return f;
3406 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
3407 if ((f->output_data.x->edit_widget
3408 && XtWindow (f->output_data.x->edit_widget) == wdesc)
3409 /* A tooltip frame? */
3410 || (!f->output_data.x->edit_widget
3411 && FRAME_X_WINDOW (f) == wdesc)
3412 || f->output_data.x->icon_desc == wdesc)
3413 return f;
3414 #else /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
3415 #ifdef USE_GTK
3416 if (f->output_data.x->edit_widget)
3417 {
3418 GtkWidget *gwdesc = xg_win_to_widget (dpyinfo->display, wdesc);
3419 struct x_output *x = f->output_data.x;
3420 if (gwdesc != 0 && gwdesc == x->edit_widget)
3421 return f;
3422 }
3423 #endif /* USE_GTK */
3424 if (FRAME_X_WINDOW (f) == wdesc
3425 || f->output_data.x->icon_desc == wdesc)
3426 return f;
3427 #endif /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
3428 }
3429 return 0;
3430 }
3431
3432 #if defined (USE_X_TOOLKIT) || defined (USE_GTK)
3433
3434 /* Like x_window_to_frame but also compares the window with the widget's
3435 windows. */
3436
3437 static struct frame *
3438 x_any_window_to_frame (struct x_display_info *dpyinfo, int wdesc)
3439 {
3440 Lisp_Object tail, frame;
3441 struct frame *f, *found = NULL;
3442 struct x_output *x;
3443
3444 if (wdesc == None)
3445 return NULL;
3446
3447 FOR_EACH_FRAME (tail, frame)
3448 {
3449 if (found)
3450 break;
3451 f = XFRAME (frame);
3452 if (FRAME_X_P (f) && FRAME_DISPLAY_INFO (f) == dpyinfo)
3453 {
3454 /* This frame matches if the window is any of its widgets. */
3455 x = f->output_data.x;
3456 if (x->hourglass_window == wdesc)
3457 found = f;
3458 else if (x->widget)
3459 {
3460 #ifdef USE_GTK
3461 GtkWidget *gwdesc = xg_win_to_widget (dpyinfo->display, wdesc);
3462 if (gwdesc != 0
3463 && gtk_widget_get_toplevel (gwdesc) == x->widget)
3464 found = f;
3465 #else
3466 if (wdesc == XtWindow (x->widget)
3467 || wdesc == XtWindow (x->column_widget)
3468 || wdesc == XtWindow (x->edit_widget))
3469 found = f;
3470 /* Match if the window is this frame's menubar. */
3471 else if (lw_window_is_in_menubar (wdesc, x->menubar_widget))
3472 found = f;
3473 #endif
3474 }
3475 else if (FRAME_X_WINDOW (f) == wdesc)
3476 /* A tooltip frame. */
3477 found = f;
3478 }
3479 }
3480
3481 return found;
3482 }
3483
3484 /* Likewise, but consider only the menu bar widget. */
3485
3486 static struct frame *
3487 x_menubar_window_to_frame (struct x_display_info *dpyinfo,
3488 const XEvent *event)
3489 {
3490 Window wdesc = event->xany.window;
3491 Lisp_Object tail, frame;
3492 struct frame *f;
3493 struct x_output *x;
3494
3495 if (wdesc == None)
3496 return NULL;
3497
3498 FOR_EACH_FRAME (tail, frame)
3499 {
3500 f = XFRAME (frame);
3501 if (!FRAME_X_P (f) || FRAME_DISPLAY_INFO (f) != dpyinfo)
3502 continue;
3503 x = f->output_data.x;
3504 #ifdef USE_GTK
3505 if (x->menubar_widget && xg_event_is_for_menubar (f, event))
3506 return f;
3507 #else
3508 /* Match if the window is this frame's menubar. */
3509 if (x->menubar_widget
3510 && lw_window_is_in_menubar (wdesc, x->menubar_widget))
3511 return f;
3512 #endif
3513 }
3514 return 0;
3515 }
3516
3517 /* Return the frame whose principal (outermost) window is WDESC.
3518 If WDESC is some other (smaller) window, we return 0. */
3519
3520 struct frame *
3521 x_top_window_to_frame (struct x_display_info *dpyinfo, int wdesc)
3522 {
3523 Lisp_Object tail, frame;
3524 struct frame *f;
3525 struct x_output *x;
3526
3527 if (wdesc == None)
3528 return NULL;
3529
3530 FOR_EACH_FRAME (tail, frame)
3531 {
3532 f = XFRAME (frame);
3533 if (!FRAME_X_P (f) || FRAME_DISPLAY_INFO (f) != dpyinfo)
3534 continue;
3535 x = f->output_data.x;
3536
3537 if (x->widget)
3538 {
3539 /* This frame matches if the window is its topmost widget. */
3540 #ifdef USE_GTK
3541 GtkWidget *gwdesc = xg_win_to_widget (dpyinfo->display, wdesc);
3542 if (gwdesc == x->widget)
3543 return f;
3544 #else
3545 if (wdesc == XtWindow (x->widget))
3546 return f;
3547 #endif
3548 }
3549 else if (FRAME_X_WINDOW (f) == wdesc)
3550 /* Tooltip frame. */
3551 return f;
3552 }
3553 return 0;
3554 }
3555
3556 #else /* !USE_X_TOOLKIT && !USE_GTK */
3557
3558 #define x_any_window_to_frame(d, i) x_window_to_frame (d, i)
3559 #define x_top_window_to_frame(d, i) x_window_to_frame (d, i)
3560
3561 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT || USE_GTK */
3562
3563 /* The focus may have changed. Figure out if it is a real focus change,
3564 by checking both FocusIn/Out and Enter/LeaveNotify events.
3565
3566 Returns FOCUS_IN_EVENT event in *BUFP. */
3567
3568 static void
3569 x_detect_focus_change (struct x_display_info *dpyinfo, struct frame *frame,
3570 const XEvent *event, struct input_event *bufp)
3571 {
3572 if (!frame)
3573 return;
3574
3575 switch (event->type)
3576 {
3577 case EnterNotify:
3578 case LeaveNotify:
3579 {
3580 struct frame *focus_frame = dpyinfo->x_focus_event_frame;
3581 int focus_state
3582 = focus_frame ? focus_frame->output_data.x->focus_state : 0;
3583
3584 if (event->xcrossing.detail != NotifyInferior
3585 && event->xcrossing.focus
3586 && ! (focus_state & FOCUS_EXPLICIT))
3587 x_focus_changed ((event->type == EnterNotify ? FocusIn : FocusOut),
3588 FOCUS_IMPLICIT,
3589 dpyinfo, frame, bufp);
3590 }
3591 break;
3592
3593 case FocusIn:
3594 case FocusOut:
3595 x_focus_changed (event->type,
3596 (event->xfocus.detail == NotifyPointer ?
3597 FOCUS_IMPLICIT : FOCUS_EXPLICIT),
3598 dpyinfo, frame, bufp);
3599 break;
3600
3601 case ClientMessage:
3602 if (event->xclient.message_type == dpyinfo->Xatom_XEMBED)
3603 {
3604 enum xembed_message msg = event->xclient.data.l[1];
3605 x_focus_changed ((msg == XEMBED_FOCUS_IN ? FocusIn : FocusOut),
3606 FOCUS_EXPLICIT, dpyinfo, frame, bufp);
3607 }
3608 break;
3609 }
3610 }
3611
3612
3613 #if !defined USE_X_TOOLKIT && !defined USE_GTK
3614 /* Handle an event saying the mouse has moved out of an Emacs frame. */
3615
3616 void
3617 x_mouse_leave (struct x_display_info *dpyinfo)
3618 {
3619 x_new_focus_frame (dpyinfo, dpyinfo->x_focus_event_frame);
3620 }
3621 #endif
3622
3623 /* The focus has changed, or we have redirected a frame's focus to
3624 another frame (this happens when a frame uses a surrogate
3625 mini-buffer frame). Shift the highlight as appropriate.
3626
3627 The FRAME argument doesn't necessarily have anything to do with which
3628 frame is being highlighted or un-highlighted; we only use it to find
3629 the appropriate X display info. */
3630
3631 static void
3632 XTframe_rehighlight (struct frame *frame)
3633 {
3634 x_frame_rehighlight (FRAME_DISPLAY_INFO (frame));
3635 }
3636
3637 static void
3638 x_frame_rehighlight (struct x_display_info *dpyinfo)
3639 {
3640 struct frame *old_highlight = dpyinfo->x_highlight_frame;
3641
3642 if (dpyinfo->x_focus_frame)
3643 {
3644 dpyinfo->x_highlight_frame
3645 = ((FRAMEP (FRAME_FOCUS_FRAME (dpyinfo->x_focus_frame)))
3646 ? XFRAME (FRAME_FOCUS_FRAME (dpyinfo->x_focus_frame))
3647 : dpyinfo->x_focus_frame);
3648 if (! FRAME_LIVE_P (dpyinfo->x_highlight_frame))
3649 {
3650 fset_focus_frame (dpyinfo->x_focus_frame, Qnil);
3651 dpyinfo->x_highlight_frame = dpyinfo->x_focus_frame;
3652 }
3653 }
3654 else
3655 dpyinfo->x_highlight_frame = 0;
3656
3657 if (dpyinfo->x_highlight_frame != old_highlight)
3658 {
3659 if (old_highlight)
3660 frame_unhighlight (old_highlight);
3661 if (dpyinfo->x_highlight_frame)
3662 frame_highlight (dpyinfo->x_highlight_frame);
3663 }
3664 }
3665
3666
3667 \f
3668 /* Keyboard processing - modifier keys, vendor-specific keysyms, etc. */
3669
3670 /* Initialize mode_switch_bit and modifier_meaning. */
3671 static void
3672 x_find_modifier_meanings (struct x_display_info *dpyinfo)
3673 {
3674 int min_code, max_code;
3675 KeySym *syms;
3676 int syms_per_code;
3677 XModifierKeymap *mods;
3678
3679 dpyinfo->meta_mod_mask = 0;
3680 dpyinfo->shift_lock_mask = 0;
3681 dpyinfo->alt_mod_mask = 0;
3682 dpyinfo->super_mod_mask = 0;
3683 dpyinfo->hyper_mod_mask = 0;
3684
3685 XDisplayKeycodes (dpyinfo->display, &min_code, &max_code);
3686
3687 syms = XGetKeyboardMapping (dpyinfo->display,
3688 min_code, max_code - min_code + 1,
3689 &syms_per_code);
3690 mods = XGetModifierMapping (dpyinfo->display);
3691
3692 /* Scan the modifier table to see which modifier bits the Meta and
3693 Alt keysyms are on. */
3694 {
3695 int row, col; /* The row and column in the modifier table. */
3696 int found_alt_or_meta;
3697
3698 for (row = 3; row < 8; row++)
3699 {
3700 found_alt_or_meta = 0;
3701 for (col = 0; col < mods->max_keypermod; col++)
3702 {
3703 KeyCode code = mods->modifiermap[(row * mods->max_keypermod) + col];
3704
3705 /* Zeroes are used for filler. Skip them. */
3706 if (code == 0)
3707 continue;
3708
3709 /* Are any of this keycode's keysyms a meta key? */
3710 {
3711 int code_col;
3712
3713 for (code_col = 0; code_col < syms_per_code; code_col++)
3714 {
3715 int sym = syms[((code - min_code) * syms_per_code) + code_col];
3716
3717 switch (sym)
3718 {
3719 case XK_Meta_L:
3720 case XK_Meta_R:
3721 found_alt_or_meta = 1;
3722 dpyinfo->meta_mod_mask |= (1 << row);
3723 break;
3724
3725 case XK_Alt_L:
3726 case XK_Alt_R:
3727 found_alt_or_meta = 1;
3728 dpyinfo->alt_mod_mask |= (1 << row);
3729 break;
3730
3731 case XK_Hyper_L:
3732 case XK_Hyper_R:
3733 if (!found_alt_or_meta)
3734 dpyinfo->hyper_mod_mask |= (1 << row);
3735 code_col = syms_per_code;
3736 col = mods->max_keypermod;
3737 break;
3738
3739 case XK_Super_L:
3740 case XK_Super_R:
3741 if (!found_alt_or_meta)
3742 dpyinfo->super_mod_mask |= (1 << row);
3743 code_col = syms_per_code;
3744 col = mods->max_keypermod;
3745 break;
3746
3747 case XK_Shift_Lock:
3748 /* Ignore this if it's not on the lock modifier. */
3749 if (!found_alt_or_meta && ((1 << row) == LockMask))
3750 dpyinfo->shift_lock_mask = LockMask;
3751 code_col = syms_per_code;
3752 col = mods->max_keypermod;
3753 break;
3754 }
3755 }
3756 }
3757 }
3758 }
3759 }
3760
3761 /* If we couldn't find any meta keys, accept any alt keys as meta keys. */
3762 if (! dpyinfo->meta_mod_mask)
3763 {
3764 dpyinfo->meta_mod_mask = dpyinfo->alt_mod_mask;
3765 dpyinfo->alt_mod_mask = 0;
3766 }
3767
3768 /* If some keys are both alt and meta,
3769 make them just meta, not alt. */
3770 if (dpyinfo->alt_mod_mask & dpyinfo->meta_mod_mask)
3771 {
3772 dpyinfo->alt_mod_mask &= ~dpyinfo->meta_mod_mask;
3773 }
3774
3775 XFree (syms);
3776 XFreeModifiermap (mods);
3777 }
3778
3779 /* Convert between the modifier bits X uses and the modifier bits
3780 Emacs uses. */
3781
3782 int
3783 x_x_to_emacs_modifiers (struct x_display_info *dpyinfo, int state)
3784 {
3785 int mod_meta = meta_modifier;
3786 int mod_alt = alt_modifier;
3787 int mod_hyper = hyper_modifier;
3788 int mod_super = super_modifier;
3789 Lisp_Object tem;
3790
3791 tem = Fget (Vx_alt_keysym, Qmodifier_value);
3792 if (INTEGERP (tem)) mod_alt = XINT (tem) & INT_MAX;
3793 tem = Fget (Vx_meta_keysym, Qmodifier_value);
3794 if (INTEGERP (tem)) mod_meta = XINT (tem) & INT_MAX;
3795 tem = Fget (Vx_hyper_keysym, Qmodifier_value);
3796 if (INTEGERP (tem)) mod_hyper = XINT (tem) & INT_MAX;
3797 tem = Fget (Vx_super_keysym, Qmodifier_value);
3798 if (INTEGERP (tem)) mod_super = XINT (tem) & INT_MAX;
3799
3800 return ( ((state & (ShiftMask | dpyinfo->shift_lock_mask)) ? shift_modifier : 0)
3801 | ((state & ControlMask) ? ctrl_modifier : 0)
3802 | ((state & dpyinfo->meta_mod_mask) ? mod_meta : 0)
3803 | ((state & dpyinfo->alt_mod_mask) ? mod_alt : 0)
3804 | ((state & dpyinfo->super_mod_mask) ? mod_super : 0)
3805 | ((state & dpyinfo->hyper_mod_mask) ? mod_hyper : 0));
3806 }
3807
3808 static int
3809 x_emacs_to_x_modifiers (struct x_display_info *dpyinfo, EMACS_INT state)
3810 {
3811 EMACS_INT mod_meta = meta_modifier;
3812 EMACS_INT mod_alt = alt_modifier;
3813 EMACS_INT mod_hyper = hyper_modifier;
3814 EMACS_INT mod_super = super_modifier;
3815
3816 Lisp_Object tem;
3817
3818 tem = Fget (Vx_alt_keysym, Qmodifier_value);
3819 if (INTEGERP (tem)) mod_alt = XINT (tem);
3820 tem = Fget (Vx_meta_keysym, Qmodifier_value);
3821 if (INTEGERP (tem)) mod_meta = XINT (tem);
3822 tem = Fget (Vx_hyper_keysym, Qmodifier_value);
3823 if (INTEGERP (tem)) mod_hyper = XINT (tem);
3824 tem = Fget (Vx_super_keysym, Qmodifier_value);
3825 if (INTEGERP (tem)) mod_super = XINT (tem);
3826
3827
3828 return ( ((state & mod_alt) ? dpyinfo->alt_mod_mask : 0)
3829 | ((state & mod_super) ? dpyinfo->super_mod_mask : 0)
3830 | ((state & mod_hyper) ? dpyinfo->hyper_mod_mask : 0)
3831 | ((state & shift_modifier) ? ShiftMask : 0)
3832 | ((state & ctrl_modifier) ? ControlMask : 0)
3833 | ((state & mod_meta) ? dpyinfo->meta_mod_mask : 0));
3834 }
3835
3836 /* Convert a keysym to its name. */
3837
3838 char *
3839 x_get_keysym_name (int keysym)
3840 {
3841 char *value;
3842
3843 block_input ();
3844 value = XKeysymToString (keysym);
3845 unblock_input ();
3846
3847 return value;
3848 }
3849
3850 /* Mouse clicks and mouse movement. Rah.
3851
3852 Formerly, we used PointerMotionHintMask (in standard_event_mask)
3853 so that we would have to call XQueryPointer after each MotionNotify
3854 event to ask for another such event. However, this made mouse tracking
3855 slow, and there was a bug that made it eventually stop.
3856
3857 Simply asking for MotionNotify all the time seems to work better.
3858
3859 In order to avoid asking for motion events and then throwing most
3860 of them away or busy-polling the server for mouse positions, we ask
3861 the server for pointer motion hints. This means that we get only
3862 one event per group of mouse movements. "Groups" are delimited by
3863 other kinds of events (focus changes and button clicks, for
3864 example), or by XQueryPointer calls; when one of these happens, we
3865 get another MotionNotify event the next time the mouse moves. This
3866 is at least as efficient as getting motion events when mouse
3867 tracking is on, and I suspect only negligibly worse when tracking
3868 is off. */
3869
3870 /* Prepare a mouse-event in *RESULT for placement in the input queue.
3871
3872 If the event is a button press, then note that we have grabbed
3873 the mouse. */
3874
3875 static Lisp_Object
3876 construct_mouse_click (struct input_event *result,
3877 const XButtonEvent *event,
3878 struct frame *f)
3879 {
3880 /* Make the event type NO_EVENT; we'll change that when we decide
3881 otherwise. */
3882 result->kind = MOUSE_CLICK_EVENT;
3883 result->code = event->button - Button1;
3884 result->timestamp = event->time;
3885 result->modifiers = (x_x_to_emacs_modifiers (FRAME_DISPLAY_INFO (f),
3886 event->state)
3887 | (event->type == ButtonRelease
3888 ? up_modifier
3889 : down_modifier));
3890
3891 XSETINT (result->x, event->x);
3892 XSETINT (result->y, event->y);
3893 XSETFRAME (result->frame_or_window, f);
3894 result->arg = Qnil;
3895 return Qnil;
3896 }
3897
3898 /* Function to report a mouse movement to the mainstream Emacs code.
3899 The input handler calls this.
3900
3901 We have received a mouse movement event, which is given in *event.
3902 If the mouse is over a different glyph than it was last time, tell
3903 the mainstream emacs code by setting mouse_moved. If not, ask for
3904 another motion event, so we can check again the next time it moves. */
3905
3906 static int
3907 note_mouse_movement (struct frame *frame, const XMotionEvent *event)
3908 {
3909 XRectangle *r;
3910 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
3911
3912 if (!FRAME_X_OUTPUT (frame))
3913 return 0;
3914
3915 dpyinfo = FRAME_DISPLAY_INFO (frame);
3916 dpyinfo->last_mouse_movement_time = event->time;
3917 dpyinfo->last_mouse_motion_frame = frame;
3918 dpyinfo->last_mouse_motion_x = event->x;
3919 dpyinfo->last_mouse_motion_y = event->y;
3920
3921 if (event->window != FRAME_X_WINDOW (frame))
3922 {
3923 frame->mouse_moved = 1;
3924 dpyinfo->last_mouse_scroll_bar = NULL;
3925 note_mouse_highlight (frame, -1, -1);
3926 dpyinfo->last_mouse_glyph_frame = NULL;
3927 return 1;
3928 }
3929
3930
3931 /* Has the mouse moved off the glyph it was on at the last sighting? */
3932 r = &dpyinfo->last_mouse_glyph;
3933 if (frame != dpyinfo->last_mouse_glyph_frame
3934 || event->x < r->x || event->x >= r->x + r->width
3935 || event->y < r->y || event->y >= r->y + r->height)
3936 {
3937 frame->mouse_moved = 1;
3938 dpyinfo->last_mouse_scroll_bar = NULL;
3939 note_mouse_highlight (frame, event->x, event->y);
3940 /* Remember which glyph we're now on. */
3941 remember_mouse_glyph (frame, event->x, event->y, r);
3942 dpyinfo->last_mouse_glyph_frame = frame;
3943 return 1;
3944 }
3945
3946 return 0;
3947 }
3948
3949 /* Return the current position of the mouse.
3950 *FP should be a frame which indicates which display to ask about.
3951
3952 If the mouse movement started in a scroll bar, set *FP, *BAR_WINDOW,
3953 and *PART to the frame, window, and scroll bar part that the mouse
3954 is over. Set *X and *Y to the portion and whole of the mouse's
3955 position on the scroll bar.
3956
3957 If the mouse movement started elsewhere, set *FP to the frame the
3958 mouse is on, *BAR_WINDOW to nil, and *X and *Y to the character cell
3959 the mouse is over.
3960
3961 Set *TIMESTAMP to the server time-stamp for the time at which the mouse
3962 was at this position.
3963
3964 Don't store anything if we don't have a valid set of values to report.
3965
3966 This clears the mouse_moved flag, so we can wait for the next mouse
3967 movement. */
3968
3969 static void
3970 XTmouse_position (struct frame **fp, int insist, Lisp_Object *bar_window,
3971 enum scroll_bar_part *part, Lisp_Object *x, Lisp_Object *y,
3972 Time *timestamp)
3973 {
3974 struct frame *f1;
3975 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_DISPLAY_INFO (*fp);
3976
3977 block_input ();
3978
3979 if (dpyinfo->last_mouse_scroll_bar && insist == 0)
3980 {
3981 struct scroll_bar *bar = dpyinfo->last_mouse_scroll_bar;
3982
3983 if (bar->horizontal)
3984 x_horizontal_scroll_bar_report_motion (fp, bar_window, part, x, y, timestamp);
3985 else
3986 x_scroll_bar_report_motion (fp, bar_window, part, x, y, timestamp);
3987 }
3988 else
3989 {
3990 Window root;
3991 int root_x, root_y;
3992
3993 Window dummy_window;
3994 int dummy;
3995
3996 Lisp_Object frame, tail;
3997
3998 /* Clear the mouse-moved flag for every frame on this display. */
3999 FOR_EACH_FRAME (tail, frame)
4000 if (FRAME_X_P (XFRAME (frame))
4001 && FRAME_X_DISPLAY (XFRAME (frame)) == FRAME_X_DISPLAY (*fp))
4002 XFRAME (frame)->mouse_moved = 0;
4003
4004 dpyinfo->last_mouse_scroll_bar = NULL;
4005
4006 /* Figure out which root window we're on. */
4007 XQueryPointer (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (*fp),
4008 DefaultRootWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (*fp)),
4009
4010 /* The root window which contains the pointer. */
4011 &root,
4012
4013 /* Trash which we can't trust if the pointer is on
4014 a different screen. */
4015 &dummy_window,
4016
4017 /* The position on that root window. */
4018 &root_x, &root_y,
4019
4020 /* More trash we can't trust. */
4021 &dummy, &dummy,
4022
4023 /* Modifier keys and pointer buttons, about which
4024 we don't care. */
4025 (unsigned int *) &dummy);
4026
4027 /* Now we have a position on the root; find the innermost window
4028 containing the pointer. */
4029 {
4030 Window win, child;
4031 int win_x, win_y;
4032 int parent_x = 0, parent_y = 0;
4033
4034 win = root;
4035
4036 /* XTranslateCoordinates can get errors if the window
4037 structure is changing at the same time this function
4038 is running. So at least we must not crash from them. */
4039
4040 x_catch_errors (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (*fp));
4041
4042 if (x_mouse_grabbed (dpyinfo))
4043 {
4044 /* If mouse was grabbed on a frame, give coords for that frame
4045 even if the mouse is now outside it. */
4046 XTranslateCoordinates (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (*fp),
4047
4048 /* From-window. */
4049 root,
4050
4051 /* To-window. */
4052 FRAME_X_WINDOW (dpyinfo->last_mouse_frame),
4053
4054 /* From-position, to-position. */
4055 root_x, root_y, &win_x, &win_y,
4056
4057 /* Child of win. */
4058 &child);
4059 f1 = dpyinfo->last_mouse_frame;
4060 }
4061 else
4062 {
4063 while (1)
4064 {
4065 XTranslateCoordinates (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (*fp),
4066
4067 /* From-window, to-window. */
4068 root, win,
4069
4070 /* From-position, to-position. */
4071 root_x, root_y, &win_x, &win_y,
4072
4073 /* Child of win. */
4074 &child);
4075
4076 if (child == None || child == win)
4077 break;
4078 #ifdef USE_GTK
4079 /* We don't wan't to know the innermost window. We
4080 want the edit window. For non-Gtk+ the innermost
4081 window is the edit window. For Gtk+ it might not
4082 be. It might be the tool bar for example. */
4083 if (x_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, win))
4084 break;
4085 #endif
4086 win = child;
4087 parent_x = win_x;
4088 parent_y = win_y;
4089 }
4090
4091 /* Now we know that:
4092 win is the innermost window containing the pointer
4093 (XTC says it has no child containing the pointer),
4094 win_x and win_y are the pointer's position in it
4095 (XTC did this the last time through), and
4096 parent_x and parent_y are the pointer's position in win's parent.
4097 (They are what win_x and win_y were when win was child.
4098 If win is the root window, it has no parent, and
4099 parent_{x,y} are invalid, but that's okay, because we'll
4100 never use them in that case.) */
4101
4102 #ifdef USE_GTK
4103 /* We don't wan't to know the innermost window. We
4104 want the edit window. */
4105 f1 = x_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, win);
4106 #else
4107 /* Is win one of our frames? */
4108 f1 = x_any_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, win);
4109 #endif
4110
4111 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
4112 /* If we end up with the menu bar window, say it's not
4113 on the frame. */
4114 if (f1 != NULL
4115 && f1->output_data.x->menubar_widget
4116 && win == XtWindow (f1->output_data.x->menubar_widget))
4117 f1 = NULL;
4118 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
4119 }
4120
4121 if (x_had_errors_p (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (*fp)))
4122 f1 = 0;
4123
4124 x_uncatch_errors ();
4125
4126 /* If not, is it one of our scroll bars? */
4127 if (! f1)
4128 {
4129 struct scroll_bar *bar;
4130
4131 bar = x_window_to_scroll_bar (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (*fp), win, 2);
4132
4133 if (bar)
4134 {
4135 f1 = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (XWINDOW (bar->window)));
4136 win_x = parent_x;
4137 win_y = parent_y;
4138 }
4139 }
4140
4141 if (f1 == 0 && insist > 0)
4142 f1 = SELECTED_FRAME ();
4143
4144 if (f1)
4145 {
4146 /* Ok, we found a frame. Store all the values.
4147 last_mouse_glyph is a rectangle used to reduce the
4148 generation of mouse events. To not miss any motion
4149 events, we must divide the frame into rectangles of the
4150 size of the smallest character that could be displayed
4151 on it, i.e. into the same rectangles that matrices on
4152 the frame are divided into. */
4153
4154 /* FIXME: what if F1 is not an X frame? */
4155 dpyinfo = FRAME_DISPLAY_INFO (f1);
4156 remember_mouse_glyph (f1, win_x, win_y, &dpyinfo->last_mouse_glyph);
4157 dpyinfo->last_mouse_glyph_frame = f1;
4158
4159 *bar_window = Qnil;
4160 *part = 0;
4161 *fp = f1;
4162 XSETINT (*x, win_x);
4163 XSETINT (*y, win_y);
4164 *timestamp = dpyinfo->last_mouse_movement_time;
4165 }
4166 }
4167 }
4168
4169 unblock_input ();
4170 }
4171
4172
4173 \f
4174 /***********************************************************************
4175 Scroll bars
4176 ***********************************************************************/
4177
4178 /* Scroll bar support. */
4179
4180 /* Given an X window ID and a DISPLAY, find the struct scroll_bar which
4181 manages it.
4182 This can be called in GC, so we have to make sure to strip off mark
4183 bits. */
4184
4185 static struct scroll_bar *
4186 x_window_to_scroll_bar (Display *display, Window window_id, int type)
4187 {
4188 Lisp_Object tail, frame;
4189
4190 #if defined (USE_GTK) && defined (USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS)
4191 window_id = (Window) xg_get_scroll_id_for_window (display, window_id);
4192 #endif /* USE_GTK && USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
4193
4194 FOR_EACH_FRAME (tail, frame)
4195 {
4196 Lisp_Object bar, condemned;
4197
4198 if (! FRAME_X_P (XFRAME (frame)))
4199 continue;
4200
4201 /* Scan this frame's scroll bar list for a scroll bar with the
4202 right window ID. */
4203 condemned = FRAME_CONDEMNED_SCROLL_BARS (XFRAME (frame));
4204 for (bar = FRAME_SCROLL_BARS (XFRAME (frame));
4205 /* This trick allows us to search both the ordinary and
4206 condemned scroll bar lists with one loop. */
4207 ! NILP (bar) || (bar = condemned,
4208 condemned = Qnil,
4209 ! NILP (bar));
4210 bar = XSCROLL_BAR (bar)->next)
4211 if (XSCROLL_BAR (bar)->x_window == window_id
4212 && FRAME_X_DISPLAY (XFRAME (frame)) == display
4213 && (type = 2
4214 || (type == 1 && XSCROLL_BAR (bar)->horizontal)
4215 || (type == 0 && !XSCROLL_BAR (bar)->horizontal)))
4216 return XSCROLL_BAR (bar);
4217 }
4218
4219 return NULL;
4220 }
4221
4222
4223 #if defined USE_LUCID
4224
4225 /* Return the Lucid menu bar WINDOW is part of. Return null
4226 if WINDOW is not part of a menu bar. */
4227
4228 static Widget
4229 x_window_to_menu_bar (Window window)
4230 {
4231 Lisp_Object tail, frame;
4232
4233 FOR_EACH_FRAME (tail, frame)
4234 if (FRAME_X_P (XFRAME (frame)))
4235 {
4236 Widget menu_bar = XFRAME (frame)->output_data.x->menubar_widget;
4237
4238 if (menu_bar && xlwmenu_window_p (menu_bar, window))
4239 return menu_bar;
4240 }
4241 return NULL;
4242 }
4243
4244 #endif /* USE_LUCID */
4245
4246 \f
4247 /************************************************************************
4248 Toolkit scroll bars
4249 ************************************************************************/
4250
4251 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
4252
4253 static void x_send_scroll_bar_event (Lisp_Object, int, int, int, bool);
4254
4255 /* Lisp window being scrolled. Set when starting to interact with
4256 a toolkit scroll bar, reset to nil when ending the interaction. */
4257
4258 static Lisp_Object window_being_scrolled;
4259
4260 /* Whether this is an Xaw with arrow-scrollbars. This should imply
4261 that movements of 1/20 of the screen size are mapped to up/down. */
4262
4263 #ifndef USE_GTK
4264 /* Id of action hook installed for scroll bars. */
4265
4266 static XtActionHookId action_hook_id;
4267 static XtActionHookId horizontal_action_hook_id;
4268
4269 static Boolean xaw3d_arrow_scroll;
4270
4271 /* Whether the drag scrolling maintains the mouse at the top of the
4272 thumb. If not, resizing the thumb needs to be done more carefully
4273 to avoid jerkiness. */
4274
4275 static Boolean xaw3d_pick_top;
4276
4277 /* Action hook installed via XtAppAddActionHook when toolkit scroll
4278 bars are used.. The hook is responsible for detecting when
4279 the user ends an interaction with the scroll bar, and generates
4280 a `end-scroll' SCROLL_BAR_CLICK_EVENT' event if so. */
4281
4282 static void
4283 xt_action_hook (Widget widget, XtPointer client_data, String action_name,
4284 XEvent *event, String *params, Cardinal *num_params)
4285 {
4286 int scroll_bar_p;
4287 const char *end_action;
4288
4289 #ifdef USE_MOTIF
4290 scroll_bar_p = XmIsScrollBar (widget);
4291 end_action = "Release";
4292 #else /* !USE_MOTIF i.e. use Xaw */
4293 scroll_bar_p = XtIsSubclass (widget, scrollbarWidgetClass);
4294 end_action = "EndScroll";
4295 #endif /* USE_MOTIF */
4296
4297 if (scroll_bar_p
4298 && strcmp (action_name, end_action) == 0
4299 && WINDOWP (window_being_scrolled))
4300 {
4301 struct window *w;
4302 struct scroll_bar *bar;
4303
4304 x_send_scroll_bar_event (window_being_scrolled,
4305 scroll_bar_end_scroll, 0, 0, 0);
4306 w = XWINDOW (window_being_scrolled);
4307 bar = XSCROLL_BAR (w->vertical_scroll_bar);
4308
4309 if (bar->dragging != -1)
4310 {
4311 bar->dragging = -1;
4312 /* The thumb size is incorrect while dragging: fix it. */
4313 set_vertical_scroll_bar (w);
4314 }
4315 window_being_scrolled = Qnil;
4316 #if defined (USE_LUCID)
4317 bar->last_seen_part = scroll_bar_nowhere;
4318 #endif
4319 /* Xt timeouts no longer needed. */
4320 toolkit_scroll_bar_interaction = 0;
4321 }
4322 }
4323
4324
4325 static void
4326 xt_horizontal_action_hook (Widget widget, XtPointer client_data, String action_name,
4327 XEvent *event, String *params, Cardinal *num_params)
4328 {
4329 int scroll_bar_p;
4330 const char *end_action;
4331
4332 #ifdef USE_MOTIF
4333 scroll_bar_p = XmIsScrollBar (widget);
4334 end_action = "Release";
4335 #else /* !USE_MOTIF i.e. use Xaw */
4336 scroll_bar_p = XtIsSubclass (widget, scrollbarWidgetClass);
4337 end_action = "EndScroll";
4338 #endif /* USE_MOTIF */
4339
4340 if (scroll_bar_p
4341 && strcmp (action_name, end_action) == 0
4342 && WINDOWP (window_being_scrolled))
4343 {
4344 struct window *w;
4345 struct scroll_bar *bar;
4346
4347 x_send_scroll_bar_event (window_being_scrolled,
4348 scroll_bar_end_scroll, 0, 0, 1);
4349 w = XWINDOW (window_being_scrolled);
4350 bar = XSCROLL_BAR (w->horizontal_scroll_bar);
4351
4352 if (bar->dragging != -1)
4353 {
4354 bar->dragging = -1;
4355 /* The thumb size is incorrect while dragging: fix it. */
4356 set_horizontal_scroll_bar (w);
4357 }
4358 window_being_scrolled = Qnil;
4359 #if defined (USE_LUCID)
4360 bar->last_seen_part = scroll_bar_nowhere;
4361 #endif
4362 /* Xt timeouts no longer needed. */
4363 toolkit_scroll_bar_interaction = 0;
4364 }
4365 }
4366 #endif /* not USE_GTK */
4367
4368 /* Send a client message with message type Xatom_Scrollbar for a
4369 scroll action to the frame of WINDOW. PART is a value identifying
4370 the part of the scroll bar that was clicked on. PORTION is the
4371 amount to scroll of a whole of WHOLE. */
4372
4373 static void
4374 x_send_scroll_bar_event (Lisp_Object window, int part, int portion, int whole, bool horizontal)
4375 {
4376 XEvent event;
4377 XClientMessageEvent *ev = &event.xclient;
4378 struct window *w = XWINDOW (window);
4379 struct frame *f = XFRAME (w->frame);
4380 intptr_t iw = (intptr_t) w;
4381 enum { BITS_PER_INTPTR = CHAR_BIT * sizeof iw };
4382 verify (BITS_PER_INTPTR <= 64);
4383 int sign_shift = BITS_PER_INTPTR - 32;
4384
4385 block_input ();
4386
4387 /* Construct a ClientMessage event to send to the frame. */
4388 ev->type = ClientMessage;
4389 ev->message_type = (horizontal
4390 ? FRAME_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->Xatom_Horizontal_Scrollbar
4391 : FRAME_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->Xatom_Scrollbar);
4392 ev->display = FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f);
4393 ev->window = FRAME_X_WINDOW (f);
4394 ev->format = 32;
4395
4396 /* A 32-bit X client on a 64-bit X server can pass a window pointer
4397 as-is. A 64-bit client on a 32-bit X server is in trouble
4398 because a pointer does not fit and would be truncated while
4399 passing through the server. So use two slots and hope that X12
4400 will resolve such issues someday. */
4401 ev->data.l[0] = iw >> 31 >> 1;
4402 ev->data.l[1] = sign_shift <= 0 ? iw : iw << sign_shift >> sign_shift;
4403 ev->data.l[2] = part;
4404 ev->data.l[3] = portion;
4405 ev->data.l[4] = whole;
4406
4407 /* Make Xt timeouts work while the scroll bar is active. */
4408 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
4409 toolkit_scroll_bar_interaction = 1;
4410 x_activate_timeout_atimer ();
4411 #endif
4412
4413 /* Setting the event mask to zero means that the message will
4414 be sent to the client that created the window, and if that
4415 window no longer exists, no event will be sent. */
4416 XSendEvent (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), False, 0, &event);
4417 unblock_input ();
4418 }
4419
4420
4421 /* Transform a scroll bar ClientMessage EVENT to an Emacs input event
4422 in *IEVENT. */
4423
4424 static void
4425 x_scroll_bar_to_input_event (const XEvent *event,
4426 struct input_event *ievent)
4427 {
4428 const XClientMessageEvent *ev = &event->xclient;
4429 Lisp_Object window;
4430 struct window *w;
4431
4432 /* See the comment in the function above. */
4433 intptr_t iw0 = ev->data.l[0];
4434 intptr_t iw1 = ev->data.l[1];
4435 intptr_t iw = (iw0 << 31 << 1) + (iw1 & 0xffffffffu);
4436 w = (struct window *) iw;
4437
4438 XSETWINDOW (window, w);
4439
4440 ievent->kind = SCROLL_BAR_CLICK_EVENT;
4441 ievent->frame_or_window = window;
4442 ievent->arg = Qnil;
4443 #ifdef USE_GTK
4444 ievent->timestamp = CurrentTime;
4445 #else
4446 ievent->timestamp =
4447 XtLastTimestampProcessed (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (XFRAME (w->frame)));
4448 #endif
4449 ievent->code = 0;
4450 ievent->part = ev->data.l[2];
4451 ievent->x = make_number (ev->data.l[3]);
4452 ievent->y = make_number (ev->data.l[4]);
4453 ievent->modifiers = 0;
4454 }
4455
4456 /* Transform a horizontal scroll bar ClientMessage EVENT to an Emacs
4457 input event in *IEVENT. */
4458
4459 static void
4460 x_horizontal_scroll_bar_to_input_event (const XEvent *event,
4461 struct input_event *ievent)
4462 {
4463 const XClientMessageEvent *ev = &event->xclient;
4464 Lisp_Object window;
4465 struct window *w;
4466
4467 /* See the comment in the function above. */
4468 intptr_t iw0 = ev->data.l[0];
4469 intptr_t iw1 = ev->data.l[1];
4470 intptr_t iw = (iw0 << 31 << 1) + (iw1 & 0xffffffffu);
4471 w = (struct window *) iw;
4472
4473 XSETWINDOW (window, w);
4474
4475 ievent->kind = HORIZONTAL_SCROLL_BAR_CLICK_EVENT;
4476 ievent->frame_or_window = window;
4477 ievent->arg = Qnil;
4478 #ifdef USE_GTK
4479 ievent->timestamp = CurrentTime;
4480 #else
4481 ievent->timestamp =
4482 XtLastTimestampProcessed (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (XFRAME (w->frame)));
4483 #endif
4484 ievent->code = 0;
4485 ievent->part = ev->data.l[2];
4486 ievent->x = make_number (ev->data.l[3]);
4487 ievent->y = make_number (ev->data.l[4]);
4488 ievent->modifiers = 0;
4489 }
4490
4491
4492 #ifdef USE_MOTIF
4493
4494 /* Minimum and maximum values used for Motif scroll bars. */
4495
4496 #define XM_SB_MAX 10000000
4497
4498 /* Scroll bar callback for Motif scroll bars. WIDGET is the scroll
4499 bar widget. CLIENT_DATA is a pointer to the scroll_bar structure.
4500 CALL_DATA is a pointer to a XmScrollBarCallbackStruct. */
4501
4502 static void
4503 xm_scroll_callback (Widget widget, XtPointer client_data, XtPointer call_data)
4504 {
4505 struct scroll_bar *bar = client_data;
4506 XmScrollBarCallbackStruct *cs = call_data;
4507 int part = -1, whole = 0, portion = 0;
4508 int horizontal = bar->horizontal;
4509
4510 switch (cs->reason)
4511 {
4512 case XmCR_DECREMENT:
4513 bar->dragging = -1;
4514 part = horizontal ? scroll_bar_left_arrow : scroll_bar_up_arrow;
4515 break;
4516
4517 case XmCR_INCREMENT:
4518 bar->dragging = -1;
4519 part = horizontal ? scroll_bar_right_arrow : scroll_bar_down_arrow;
4520 break;
4521
4522 case XmCR_PAGE_DECREMENT:
4523 bar->dragging = -1;
4524 part = horizontal ? scroll_bar_before_handle : scroll_bar_above_handle;
4525 break;
4526
4527 case XmCR_PAGE_INCREMENT:
4528 bar->dragging = -1;
4529 part = horizontal ? scroll_bar_after_handle : scroll_bar_below_handle;
4530 break;
4531
4532 case XmCR_TO_TOP:
4533 bar->dragging = -1;
4534 part = horizontal ? scroll_bar_to_leftmost : scroll_bar_to_top;
4535 break;
4536
4537 case XmCR_TO_BOTTOM:
4538 bar->dragging = -1;
4539 part = horizontal ? scroll_bar_to_rightmost : scroll_bar_to_bottom;
4540 break;
4541
4542 case XmCR_DRAG:
4543 {
4544 int slider_size;
4545
4546 block_input ();
4547 XtVaGetValues (widget, XmNsliderSize, &slider_size, NULL);
4548 unblock_input ();
4549
4550 if (horizontal)
4551 {
4552 portion = bar->whole * ((float)cs->value / XM_SB_MAX);
4553 whole = bar->whole * ((float)(XM_SB_MAX - slider_size) / XM_SB_MAX);
4554 portion = min (portion, whole);
4555 part = scroll_bar_horizontal_handle;
4556 }
4557 else
4558 {
4559 whole = XM_SB_MAX - slider_size;
4560 portion = min (cs->value, whole);
4561 part = scroll_bar_handle;
4562 }
4563
4564 bar->dragging = cs->value;
4565 }
4566 break;
4567
4568 case XmCR_VALUE_CHANGED:
4569 break;
4570 };
4571
4572 if (part >= 0)
4573 {
4574 window_being_scrolled = bar->window;
4575 x_send_scroll_bar_event (bar->window, part, portion, whole, bar->horizontal);
4576 }
4577 }
4578
4579 #elif defined USE_GTK
4580
4581 /* Scroll bar callback for GTK scroll bars. WIDGET is the scroll
4582 bar widget. DATA is a pointer to the scroll_bar structure. */
4583
4584 static gboolean
4585 xg_scroll_callback (GtkRange *range,
4586 GtkScrollType scroll,
4587 gdouble value,
4588 gpointer user_data)
4589 {
4590 struct scroll_bar *bar = user_data;
4591 int part = -1, whole = 0, portion = 0;
4592 GtkAdjustment *adj = GTK_ADJUSTMENT (gtk_range_get_adjustment (range));
4593 struct frame *f = g_object_get_data (G_OBJECT (range), XG_FRAME_DATA);
4594
4595 if (xg_ignore_gtk_scrollbar) return FALSE;
4596
4597 switch (scroll)
4598 {
4599 case GTK_SCROLL_JUMP:
4600 /* Buttons 1 2 or 3 must be grabbed. */
4601 if (FRAME_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->grabbed != 0
4602 && FRAME_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->grabbed < (1 << 4))
4603 {
4604 if (bar->horizontal)
4605 {
4606 part = scroll_bar_horizontal_handle;
4607 whole = (int)(gtk_adjustment_get_upper (adj) -
4608 gtk_adjustment_get_page_size (adj));
4609 portion = min ((int)value, whole);
4610 bar->dragging = portion;
4611 }
4612 else
4613 {
4614 part = scroll_bar_handle;
4615 whole = gtk_adjustment_get_upper (adj) -
4616 gtk_adjustment_get_page_size (adj);
4617 portion = min ((int)value, whole);
4618 bar->dragging = portion;
4619 }
4620 }
4621 break;
4622 case GTK_SCROLL_STEP_BACKWARD:
4623 part = (bar->horizontal
4624 ? scroll_bar_left_arrow : scroll_bar_up_arrow);
4625 bar->dragging = -1;
4626 break;
4627 case GTK_SCROLL_STEP_FORWARD:
4628 part = (bar->horizontal
4629 ? scroll_bar_right_arrow : scroll_bar_down_arrow);
4630 bar->dragging = -1;
4631 break;
4632 case GTK_SCROLL_PAGE_BACKWARD:
4633 part = (bar->horizontal
4634 ? scroll_bar_before_handle : scroll_bar_above_handle);
4635 bar->dragging = -1;
4636 break;
4637 case GTK_SCROLL_PAGE_FORWARD:
4638 part = (bar->horizontal
4639 ? scroll_bar_after_handle : scroll_bar_below_handle);
4640 bar->dragging = -1;
4641 break;
4642 }
4643
4644 if (part >= 0)
4645 {
4646 window_being_scrolled = bar->window;
4647 x_send_scroll_bar_event (bar->window, part, portion, whole, bar->horizontal);
4648 }
4649
4650 return FALSE;
4651 }
4652
4653 /* Callback for button release. Sets dragging to -1 when dragging is done. */
4654
4655 static gboolean
4656 xg_end_scroll_callback (GtkWidget *widget,
4657 GdkEventButton *event,
4658 gpointer user_data)
4659 {
4660 struct scroll_bar *bar = user_data;
4661 bar->dragging = -1;
4662 if (WINDOWP (window_being_scrolled))
4663 {
4664 x_send_scroll_bar_event (window_being_scrolled,
4665 scroll_bar_end_scroll, 0, 0, bar->horizontal);
4666 window_being_scrolled = Qnil;
4667 }
4668
4669 return FALSE;
4670 }
4671
4672
4673 #else /* not USE_GTK and not USE_MOTIF */
4674
4675 /* Xaw scroll bar callback. Invoked when the thumb is dragged.
4676 WIDGET is the scroll bar widget. CLIENT_DATA is a pointer to the
4677 scroll bar struct. CALL_DATA is a pointer to a float saying where
4678 the thumb is. */
4679
4680 static void
4681 xaw_jump_callback (Widget widget, XtPointer client_data, XtPointer call_data)
4682 {
4683 struct scroll_bar *bar = client_data;
4684 float *top_addr = call_data;
4685 float top = *top_addr;
4686 float shown;
4687 int whole, portion, height, width;
4688 enum scroll_bar_part part;
4689 int horizontal = bar->horizontal;
4690
4691
4692 if (horizontal)
4693 {
4694 /* Get the size of the thumb, a value between 0 and 1. */
4695 block_input ();
4696 XtVaGetValues (widget, XtNshown, &shown, XtNwidth, &width, NULL);
4697 unblock_input ();
4698
4699 if (shown < 1)
4700 {
4701 whole = bar->whole - (shown * bar->whole);
4702 portion = min (top * bar->whole, whole);
4703 }
4704 else
4705 {
4706 whole = bar->whole;
4707 portion = 0;
4708 }
4709
4710 part = scroll_bar_horizontal_handle;
4711 }
4712 else
4713 {
4714 /* Get the size of the thumb, a value between 0 and 1. */
4715 block_input ();
4716 XtVaGetValues (widget, XtNshown, &shown, XtNheight, &height, NULL);
4717 unblock_input ();
4718
4719 whole = 10000000;
4720 portion = shown < 1 ? top * whole : 0;
4721
4722 if (shown < 1 && (eabs (top + shown - 1) < 1.0f / height))
4723 /* Some derivatives of Xaw refuse to shrink the thumb when you reach
4724 the bottom, so we force the scrolling whenever we see that we're
4725 too close to the bottom (in x_set_toolkit_scroll_bar_thumb
4726 we try to ensure that we always stay two pixels away from the
4727 bottom). */
4728 part = scroll_bar_down_arrow;
4729 else
4730 part = scroll_bar_handle;
4731 }
4732
4733 window_being_scrolled = bar->window;
4734 bar->dragging = portion;
4735 bar->last_seen_part = part;
4736 x_send_scroll_bar_event (bar->window, part, portion, whole, bar->horizontal);
4737 }
4738
4739
4740 /* Xaw scroll bar callback. Invoked for incremental scrolling.,
4741 i.e. line or page up or down. WIDGET is the Xaw scroll bar
4742 widget. CLIENT_DATA is a pointer to the scroll_bar structure for
4743 the scroll bar. CALL_DATA is an integer specifying the action that
4744 has taken place. Its magnitude is in the range 0..height of the
4745 scroll bar. Negative values mean scroll towards buffer start.
4746 Values < height of scroll bar mean line-wise movement. */
4747
4748 static void
4749 xaw_scroll_callback (Widget widget, XtPointer client_data, XtPointer call_data)
4750 {
4751 struct scroll_bar *bar = client_data;
4752 /* The position really is stored cast to a pointer. */
4753 int position = (intptr_t) call_data;
4754 Dimension height, width;
4755 enum scroll_bar_part part;
4756
4757 if (bar->horizontal)
4758 {
4759 /* Get the width of the scroll bar. */
4760 block_input ();
4761 XtVaGetValues (widget, XtNwidth, &width, NULL);
4762 unblock_input ();
4763
4764 if (eabs (position) >= width)
4765 part = (position < 0) ? scroll_bar_before_handle : scroll_bar_after_handle;
4766
4767 /* If Xaw3d was compiled with ARROW_SCROLLBAR,
4768 it maps line-movement to call_data = max(5, height/20). */
4769 else if (xaw3d_arrow_scroll && eabs (position) <= max (5, width / 20))
4770 part = (position < 0) ? scroll_bar_left_arrow : scroll_bar_right_arrow;
4771 else
4772 part = scroll_bar_move_ratio;
4773
4774 window_being_scrolled = bar->window;
4775 bar->dragging = -1;
4776 bar->last_seen_part = part;
4777 x_send_scroll_bar_event (bar->window, part, position, width, bar->horizontal);
4778 }
4779 else
4780 {
4781
4782 /* Get the height of the scroll bar. */
4783 block_input ();
4784 XtVaGetValues (widget, XtNheight, &height, NULL);
4785 unblock_input ();
4786
4787 if (eabs (position) >= height)
4788 part = (position < 0) ? scroll_bar_above_handle : scroll_bar_below_handle;
4789
4790 /* If Xaw3d was compiled with ARROW_SCROLLBAR,
4791 it maps line-movement to call_data = max(5, height/20). */
4792 else if (xaw3d_arrow_scroll && eabs (position) <= max (5, height / 20))
4793 part = (position < 0) ? scroll_bar_up_arrow : scroll_bar_down_arrow;
4794 else
4795 part = scroll_bar_move_ratio;
4796
4797 window_being_scrolled = bar->window;
4798 bar->dragging = -1;
4799 bar->last_seen_part = part;
4800 x_send_scroll_bar_event (bar->window, part, position, height, bar->horizontal);
4801 }
4802 }
4803
4804 #endif /* not USE_GTK and not USE_MOTIF */
4805
4806 #define SCROLL_BAR_NAME "verticalScrollBar"
4807 #define SCROLL_BAR_HORIZONTAL_NAME "horizontalScrollBar"
4808
4809 /* Create the widget for scroll bar BAR on frame F. Record the widget
4810 and X window of the scroll bar in BAR. */
4811
4812 #ifdef USE_GTK
4813 static void
4814 x_create_toolkit_scroll_bar (struct frame *f, struct scroll_bar *bar)
4815 {
4816 const char *scroll_bar_name = SCROLL_BAR_NAME;
4817
4818 block_input ();
4819 xg_create_scroll_bar (f, bar, G_CALLBACK (xg_scroll_callback),
4820 G_CALLBACK (xg_end_scroll_callback),
4821 scroll_bar_name);
4822 unblock_input ();
4823 }
4824
4825 static void
4826 x_create_horizontal_toolkit_scroll_bar (struct frame *f, struct scroll_bar *bar)
4827 {
4828 const char *scroll_bar_name = SCROLL_BAR_HORIZONTAL_NAME;
4829
4830 block_input ();
4831 xg_create_horizontal_scroll_bar (f, bar, G_CALLBACK (xg_scroll_callback),
4832 G_CALLBACK (xg_end_scroll_callback),
4833 scroll_bar_name);
4834 unblock_input ();
4835 }
4836
4837 #else /* not USE_GTK */
4838
4839 static void
4840 x_create_toolkit_scroll_bar (struct frame *f, struct scroll_bar *bar)
4841 {
4842 Window xwindow;
4843 Widget widget;
4844 Arg av[20];
4845 int ac = 0;
4846 const char *scroll_bar_name = SCROLL_BAR_NAME;
4847 unsigned long pixel;
4848
4849 block_input ();
4850
4851 #ifdef USE_MOTIF
4852 /* Set resources. Create the widget. */
4853 XtSetArg (av[ac], XtNmappedWhenManaged, False); ++ac;
4854 XtSetArg (av[ac], XmNminimum, 0); ++ac;
4855 XtSetArg (av[ac], XmNmaximum, XM_SB_MAX); ++ac;
4856 XtSetArg (av[ac], XmNorientation, XmVERTICAL); ++ac;
4857 XtSetArg (av[ac], XmNprocessingDirection, XmMAX_ON_BOTTOM), ++ac;
4858 XtSetArg (av[ac], XmNincrement, 1); ++ac;
4859 XtSetArg (av[ac], XmNpageIncrement, 1); ++ac;
4860
4861 pixel = f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_foreground_pixel;
4862 if (pixel != -1)
4863 {
4864 XtSetArg (av[ac], XmNforeground, pixel);
4865 ++ac;
4866 }
4867
4868 pixel = f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_background_pixel;
4869 if (pixel != -1)
4870 {
4871 XtSetArg (av[ac], XmNbackground, pixel);
4872 ++ac;
4873 }
4874
4875 widget = XmCreateScrollBar (f->output_data.x->edit_widget,
4876 (char *) scroll_bar_name, av, ac);
4877
4878 /* Add one callback for everything that can happen. */
4879 XtAddCallback (widget, XmNdecrementCallback, xm_scroll_callback,
4880 (XtPointer) bar);
4881 XtAddCallback (widget, XmNdragCallback, xm_scroll_callback,
4882 (XtPointer) bar);
4883 XtAddCallback (widget, XmNincrementCallback, xm_scroll_callback,
4884 (XtPointer) bar);
4885 XtAddCallback (widget, XmNpageDecrementCallback, xm_scroll_callback,
4886 (XtPointer) bar);
4887 XtAddCallback (widget, XmNpageIncrementCallback, xm_scroll_callback,
4888 (XtPointer) bar);
4889 XtAddCallback (widget, XmNtoBottomCallback, xm_scroll_callback,
4890 (XtPointer) bar);
4891 XtAddCallback (widget, XmNtoTopCallback, xm_scroll_callback,
4892 (XtPointer) bar);
4893
4894 /* Realize the widget. Only after that is the X window created. */
4895 XtRealizeWidget (widget);
4896
4897 /* Set the cursor to an arrow. I didn't find a resource to do that.
4898 And I'm wondering why it hasn't an arrow cursor by default. */
4899 XDefineCursor (XtDisplay (widget), XtWindow (widget),
4900 f->output_data.x->nontext_cursor);
4901
4902 #else /* !USE_MOTIF i.e. use Xaw */
4903
4904 /* Set resources. Create the widget. The background of the
4905 Xaw3d scroll bar widget is a little bit light for my taste.
4906 We don't alter it here to let users change it according
4907 to their taste with `emacs*verticalScrollBar.background: xxx'. */
4908 XtSetArg (av[ac], XtNmappedWhenManaged, False); ++ac;
4909 XtSetArg (av[ac], XtNorientation, XtorientVertical); ++ac;
4910 /* For smoother scrolling with Xaw3d -sm */
4911 /* XtSetArg (av[ac], XtNpickTop, True); ++ac; */
4912
4913 pixel = f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_foreground_pixel;
4914 if (pixel != -1)
4915 {
4916 XtSetArg (av[ac], XtNforeground, pixel);
4917 ++ac;
4918 }
4919
4920 pixel = f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_background_pixel;
4921 if (pixel != -1)
4922 {
4923 XtSetArg (av[ac], XtNbackground, pixel);
4924 ++ac;
4925 }
4926
4927 /* Top/bottom shadow colors. */
4928
4929 /* Allocate them, if necessary. */
4930 if (f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_top_shadow_pixel == -1)
4931 {
4932 pixel = f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_background_pixel;
4933 if (pixel != -1)
4934 {
4935 if (!x_alloc_lighter_color (f, FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f),
4936 FRAME_X_COLORMAP (f),
4937 &pixel, 1.2, 0x8000))
4938 pixel = -1;
4939 f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_top_shadow_pixel = pixel;
4940 }
4941 }
4942 if (f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_bottom_shadow_pixel == -1)
4943 {
4944 pixel = f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_background_pixel;
4945 if (pixel != -1)
4946 {
4947 if (!x_alloc_lighter_color (f, FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f),
4948 FRAME_X_COLORMAP (f),
4949 &pixel, 0.6, 0x4000))
4950 pixel = -1;
4951 f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_bottom_shadow_pixel = pixel;
4952 }
4953 }
4954
4955 #ifdef XtNbeNiceToColormap
4956 /* Tell the toolkit about them. */
4957 if (f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_top_shadow_pixel == -1
4958 || f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_bottom_shadow_pixel == -1)
4959 /* We tried to allocate a color for the top/bottom shadow, and
4960 failed, so tell Xaw3d to use dithering instead. */
4961 /* But only if we have a small colormap. Xaw3d can allocate nice
4962 colors itself. */
4963 {
4964 XtSetArg (av[ac], XtNbeNiceToColormap,
4965 DefaultDepthOfScreen (FRAME_X_SCREEN (f)) < 16);
4966 ++ac;
4967 }
4968 else
4969 /* Tell what colors Xaw3d should use for the top/bottom shadow, to
4970 be more consistent with other emacs 3d colors, and since Xaw3d is
4971 not good at dealing with allocation failure. */
4972 {
4973 /* This tells Xaw3d to use real colors instead of dithering for
4974 the shadows. */
4975 XtSetArg (av[ac], XtNbeNiceToColormap, False);
4976 ++ac;
4977
4978 /* Specify the colors. */
4979 pixel = f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_top_shadow_pixel;
4980 if (pixel != -1)
4981 {
4982 XtSetArg (av[ac], XtNtopShadowPixel, pixel);
4983 ++ac;
4984 }
4985 pixel = f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_bottom_shadow_pixel;
4986 if (pixel != -1)
4987 {
4988 XtSetArg (av[ac], XtNbottomShadowPixel, pixel);
4989 ++ac;
4990 }
4991 }
4992 #endif
4993
4994 widget = XtCreateWidget (scroll_bar_name, scrollbarWidgetClass,
4995 f->output_data.x->edit_widget, av, ac);
4996
4997 {
4998 char const *initial = "";
4999 char const *val = initial;
5000 XtVaGetValues (widget, XtNscrollVCursor, (XtPointer) &val,
5001 #ifdef XtNarrowScrollbars
5002 XtNarrowScrollbars, (XtPointer) &xaw3d_arrow_scroll,
5003 #endif
5004 XtNpickTop, (XtPointer) &xaw3d_pick_top, NULL);
5005 if (xaw3d_arrow_scroll || val == initial)
5006 { /* ARROW_SCROLL */
5007 xaw3d_arrow_scroll = True;
5008 /* Isn't that just a personal preference ? --Stef */
5009 XtVaSetValues (widget, XtNcursorName, "top_left_arrow", NULL);
5010 }
5011 }
5012
5013 /* Define callbacks. */
5014 XtAddCallback (widget, XtNjumpProc, xaw_jump_callback, (XtPointer) bar);
5015 XtAddCallback (widget, XtNscrollProc, xaw_scroll_callback,
5016 (XtPointer) bar);
5017
5018 /* Realize the widget. Only after that is the X window created. */
5019 XtRealizeWidget (widget);
5020
5021 #endif /* !USE_MOTIF */
5022
5023 /* Install an action hook that lets us detect when the user
5024 finishes interacting with a scroll bar. */
5025 if (action_hook_id == 0)
5026 action_hook_id = XtAppAddActionHook (Xt_app_con, xt_action_hook, 0);
5027
5028 /* Remember X window and widget in the scroll bar vector. */
5029 SET_SCROLL_BAR_X_WIDGET (bar, widget);
5030 xwindow = XtWindow (widget);
5031 bar->x_window = xwindow;
5032 bar->whole = 1;
5033 bar->horizontal = 0;
5034
5035 unblock_input ();
5036 }
5037
5038 static void
5039 x_create_horizontal_toolkit_scroll_bar (struct frame *f, struct scroll_bar *bar)
5040 {
5041 Window xwindow;
5042 Widget widget;
5043 Arg av[20];
5044 int ac = 0;
5045 const char *scroll_bar_name = SCROLL_BAR_HORIZONTAL_NAME;
5046 unsigned long pixel;
5047
5048 block_input ();
5049
5050 #ifdef USE_MOTIF
5051 /* Set resources. Create the widget. */
5052 XtSetArg (av[ac], XtNmappedWhenManaged, False); ++ac;
5053 XtSetArg (av[ac], XmNminimum, 0); ++ac;
5054 XtSetArg (av[ac], XmNmaximum, XM_SB_MAX); ++ac;
5055 XtSetArg (av[ac], XmNorientation, XmHORIZONTAL); ++ac;
5056 XtSetArg (av[ac], XmNprocessingDirection, XmMAX_ON_RIGHT), ++ac;
5057 XtSetArg (av[ac], XmNincrement, 1); ++ac;
5058 XtSetArg (av[ac], XmNpageIncrement, 1); ++ac;
5059
5060 pixel = f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_foreground_pixel;
5061 if (pixel != -1)
5062 {
5063 XtSetArg (av[ac], XmNforeground, pixel);
5064 ++ac;
5065 }
5066
5067 pixel = f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_background_pixel;
5068 if (pixel != -1)
5069 {
5070 XtSetArg (av[ac], XmNbackground, pixel);
5071 ++ac;
5072 }
5073
5074 widget = XmCreateScrollBar (f->output_data.x->edit_widget,
5075 (char *) scroll_bar_name, av, ac);
5076
5077 /* Add one callback for everything that can happen. */
5078 XtAddCallback (widget, XmNdecrementCallback, xm_scroll_callback,
5079 (XtPointer) bar);
5080 XtAddCallback (widget, XmNdragCallback, xm_scroll_callback,
5081 (XtPointer) bar);
5082 XtAddCallback (widget, XmNincrementCallback, xm_scroll_callback,
5083 (XtPointer) bar);
5084 XtAddCallback (widget, XmNpageDecrementCallback, xm_scroll_callback,
5085 (XtPointer) bar);
5086 XtAddCallback (widget, XmNpageIncrementCallback, xm_scroll_callback,
5087 (XtPointer) bar);
5088 XtAddCallback (widget, XmNtoBottomCallback, xm_scroll_callback,
5089 (XtPointer) bar);
5090 XtAddCallback (widget, XmNtoTopCallback, xm_scroll_callback,
5091 (XtPointer) bar);
5092
5093 /* Realize the widget. Only after that is the X window created. */
5094 XtRealizeWidget (widget);
5095
5096 /* Set the cursor to an arrow. I didn't find a resource to do that.
5097 And I'm wondering why it hasn't an arrow cursor by default. */
5098 XDefineCursor (XtDisplay (widget), XtWindow (widget),
5099 f->output_data.x->nontext_cursor);
5100
5101 #else /* !USE_MOTIF i.e. use Xaw */
5102
5103 /* Set resources. Create the widget. The background of the
5104 Xaw3d scroll bar widget is a little bit light for my taste.
5105 We don't alter it here to let users change it according
5106 to their taste with `emacs*verticalScrollBar.background: xxx'. */
5107 XtSetArg (av[ac], XtNmappedWhenManaged, False); ++ac;
5108 XtSetArg (av[ac], XtNorientation, XtorientHorizontal); ++ac;
5109 /* For smoother scrolling with Xaw3d -sm */
5110 /* XtSetArg (av[ac], XtNpickTop, True); ++ac; */
5111
5112 pixel = f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_foreground_pixel;
5113 if (pixel != -1)
5114 {
5115 XtSetArg (av[ac], XtNforeground, pixel);
5116 ++ac;
5117 }
5118
5119 pixel = f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_background_pixel;
5120 if (pixel != -1)
5121 {
5122 XtSetArg (av[ac], XtNbackground, pixel);
5123 ++ac;
5124 }
5125
5126 /* Top/bottom shadow colors. */
5127
5128 /* Allocate them, if necessary. */
5129 if (f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_top_shadow_pixel == -1)
5130 {
5131 pixel = f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_background_pixel;
5132 if (pixel != -1)
5133 {
5134 if (!x_alloc_lighter_color (f, FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f),
5135 FRAME_X_COLORMAP (f),
5136 &pixel, 1.2, 0x8000))
5137 pixel = -1;
5138 f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_top_shadow_pixel = pixel;
5139 }
5140 }
5141 if (f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_bottom_shadow_pixel == -1)
5142 {
5143 pixel = f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_background_pixel;
5144 if (pixel != -1)
5145 {
5146 if (!x_alloc_lighter_color (f, FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f),
5147 FRAME_X_COLORMAP (f),
5148 &pixel, 0.6, 0x4000))
5149 pixel = -1;
5150 f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_bottom_shadow_pixel = pixel;
5151 }
5152 }
5153
5154 #ifdef XtNbeNiceToColormap
5155 /* Tell the toolkit about them. */
5156 if (f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_top_shadow_pixel == -1
5157 || f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_bottom_shadow_pixel == -1)
5158 /* We tried to allocate a color for the top/bottom shadow, and
5159 failed, so tell Xaw3d to use dithering instead. */
5160 /* But only if we have a small colormap. Xaw3d can allocate nice
5161 colors itself. */
5162 {
5163 XtSetArg (av[ac], XtNbeNiceToColormap,
5164 DefaultDepthOfScreen (FRAME_X_SCREEN (f)) < 16);
5165 ++ac;
5166 }
5167 else
5168 /* Tell what colors Xaw3d should use for the top/bottom shadow, to
5169 be more consistent with other emacs 3d colors, and since Xaw3d is
5170 not good at dealing with allocation failure. */
5171 {
5172 /* This tells Xaw3d to use real colors instead of dithering for
5173 the shadows. */
5174 XtSetArg (av[ac], XtNbeNiceToColormap, False);
5175 ++ac;
5176
5177 /* Specify the colors. */
5178 pixel = f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_top_shadow_pixel;
5179 if (pixel != -1)
5180 {
5181 XtSetArg (av[ac], XtNtopShadowPixel, pixel);
5182 ++ac;
5183 }
5184 pixel = f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_bottom_shadow_pixel;
5185 if (pixel != -1)
5186 {
5187 XtSetArg (av[ac], XtNbottomShadowPixel, pixel);
5188 ++ac;
5189 }
5190 }
5191 #endif
5192
5193 widget = XtCreateWidget (scroll_bar_name, scrollbarWidgetClass,
5194 f->output_data.x->edit_widget, av, ac);
5195
5196 {
5197 char const *initial = "";
5198 char const *val = initial;
5199 XtVaGetValues (widget, XtNscrollVCursor, (XtPointer) &val,
5200 #ifdef XtNarrowScrollbars
5201 XtNarrowScrollbars, (XtPointer) &xaw3d_arrow_scroll,
5202 #endif
5203 XtNpickTop, (XtPointer) &xaw3d_pick_top, NULL);
5204 if (xaw3d_arrow_scroll || val == initial)
5205 { /* ARROW_SCROLL */
5206 xaw3d_arrow_scroll = True;
5207 /* Isn't that just a personal preference ? --Stef */
5208 XtVaSetValues (widget, XtNcursorName, "top_left_arrow", NULL);
5209 }
5210 }
5211
5212 /* Define callbacks. */
5213 XtAddCallback (widget, XtNjumpProc, xaw_jump_callback, (XtPointer) bar);
5214 XtAddCallback (widget, XtNscrollProc, xaw_scroll_callback,
5215 (XtPointer) bar);
5216
5217 /* Realize the widget. Only after that is the X window created. */
5218 XtRealizeWidget (widget);
5219
5220 #endif /* !USE_MOTIF */
5221
5222 /* Install an action hook that lets us detect when the user
5223 finishes interacting with a scroll bar. */
5224 if (horizontal_action_hook_id == 0)
5225 horizontal_action_hook_id
5226 = XtAppAddActionHook (Xt_app_con, xt_horizontal_action_hook, 0);
5227
5228 /* Remember X window and widget in the scroll bar vector. */
5229 SET_SCROLL_BAR_X_WIDGET (bar, widget);
5230 xwindow = XtWindow (widget);
5231 bar->x_window = xwindow;
5232 bar->whole = 1;
5233 bar->horizontal = 1;
5234
5235 unblock_input ();
5236 }
5237 #endif /* not USE_GTK */
5238
5239
5240 /* Set the thumb size and position of scroll bar BAR. We are currently
5241 displaying PORTION out of a whole WHOLE, and our position POSITION. */
5242
5243 #ifdef USE_GTK
5244 static void
5245 x_set_toolkit_scroll_bar_thumb (struct scroll_bar *bar, int portion, int position, int whole)
5246 {
5247 xg_set_toolkit_scroll_bar_thumb (bar, portion, position, whole);
5248 }
5249
5250 static void
5251 x_set_toolkit_horizontal_scroll_bar_thumb (struct scroll_bar *bar, int portion, int position, int whole)
5252 {
5253 xg_set_toolkit_horizontal_scroll_bar_thumb (bar, portion, position, whole);
5254 }
5255
5256 #else /* not USE_GTK */
5257 static void
5258 x_set_toolkit_scroll_bar_thumb (struct scroll_bar *bar, int portion, int position,
5259 int whole)
5260 {
5261 struct frame *f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (XWINDOW (bar->window)));
5262 Widget widget = SCROLL_BAR_X_WIDGET (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), bar);
5263 float top, shown;
5264
5265 block_input ();
5266
5267 #ifdef USE_MOTIF
5268
5269 if (scroll_bar_adjust_thumb_portion_p)
5270 {
5271 /* We use an estimate of 30 chars per line rather than the real
5272 `portion' value. This has the disadvantage that the thumb size
5273 is not very representative, but it makes our life a lot easier.
5274 Otherwise, we have to constantly adjust the thumb size, which
5275 we can't always do quickly enough: while dragging, the size of
5276 the thumb might prevent the user from dragging the thumb all the
5277 way to the end. but Motif and some versions of Xaw3d don't allow
5278 updating the thumb size while dragging. Also, even if we can update
5279 its size, the update will often happen too late.
5280 If you don't believe it, check out revision 1.650 of xterm.c to see
5281 what hoops we were going through and the still poor behavior we got. */
5282 portion = WINDOW_TOTAL_LINES (XWINDOW (bar->window)) * 30;
5283 /* When the thumb is at the bottom, position == whole.
5284 So we need to increase `whole' to make space for the thumb. */
5285 whole += portion;
5286 }
5287
5288 if (whole <= 0)
5289 top = 0, shown = 1;
5290 else
5291 {
5292 top = (float) position / whole;
5293 shown = (float) portion / whole;
5294 }
5295
5296 if (bar->dragging == -1)
5297 {
5298 int size, value;
5299
5300 /* Slider size. Must be in the range [1 .. MAX - MIN] where MAX
5301 is the scroll bar's maximum and MIN is the scroll bar's minimum
5302 value. */
5303 size = clip_to_bounds (1, shown * XM_SB_MAX, XM_SB_MAX);
5304
5305 /* Position. Must be in the range [MIN .. MAX - SLIDER_SIZE]. */
5306 value = top * XM_SB_MAX;
5307 value = min (value, XM_SB_MAX - size);
5308
5309 XmScrollBarSetValues (widget, value, size, 0, 0, False);
5310 }
5311 #else /* !USE_MOTIF i.e. use Xaw */
5312
5313 if (whole == 0)
5314 top = 0, shown = 1;
5315 else
5316 {
5317 top = (float) position / whole;
5318 shown = (float) portion / whole;
5319 }
5320
5321 {
5322 float old_top, old_shown;
5323 Dimension height;
5324 XtVaGetValues (widget,
5325 XtNtopOfThumb, &old_top,
5326 XtNshown, &old_shown,
5327 XtNheight, &height,
5328 NULL);
5329
5330 /* Massage the top+shown values. */
5331 if (bar->dragging == -1 || bar->last_seen_part == scroll_bar_down_arrow)
5332 top = max (0, min (1, top));
5333 else
5334 top = old_top;
5335 #if ! defined (HAVE_XAW3D)
5336 /* With Xaw, 'top' values too closer to 1.0 may
5337 cause the thumb to disappear. Fix that. */
5338 top = min (top, 0.99f);
5339 #endif
5340 /* Keep two pixels available for moving the thumb down. */
5341 shown = max (0, min (1 - top - (2.0f / height), shown));
5342 #if ! defined (HAVE_XAW3D)
5343 /* Likewise with too small 'shown'. */
5344 shown = max (shown, 0.01f);
5345 #endif
5346
5347 /* If the call to XawScrollbarSetThumb below doesn't seem to
5348 work, check that 'NARROWPROTO' is defined in src/config.h.
5349 If this is not so, most likely you need to fix configure. */
5350 if (top != old_top || shown != old_shown)
5351 {
5352 if (bar->dragging == -1)
5353 XawScrollbarSetThumb (widget, top, shown);
5354 else
5355 {
5356 /* Try to make the scrolling a tad smoother. */
5357 if (!xaw3d_pick_top)
5358 shown = min (shown, old_shown);
5359
5360 XawScrollbarSetThumb (widget, top, shown);
5361 }
5362 }
5363 }
5364 #endif /* !USE_MOTIF */
5365
5366 unblock_input ();
5367 }
5368
5369 static void
5370 x_set_toolkit_horizontal_scroll_bar_thumb (struct scroll_bar *bar, int portion, int position,
5371 int whole)
5372 {
5373 struct frame *f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (XWINDOW (bar->window)));
5374 Widget widget = SCROLL_BAR_X_WIDGET (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), bar);
5375 float top, shown;
5376
5377 block_input ();
5378
5379 #ifdef USE_MOTIF
5380 bar->whole = whole;
5381 shown = (float) portion / whole;
5382 top = (float) position / (whole - portion);
5383 {
5384 int size = clip_to_bounds (1, shown * XM_SB_MAX, XM_SB_MAX);
5385 int value = clip_to_bounds (0, top * (XM_SB_MAX - size), XM_SB_MAX - size);
5386
5387 XmScrollBarSetValues (widget, value, size, 0, 0, False);
5388 }
5389 #else /* !USE_MOTIF i.e. use Xaw */
5390 bar->whole = whole;
5391 if (whole == 0)
5392 top = 0, shown = 1;
5393 else
5394 {
5395 top = (float) position / whole;
5396 shown = (float) portion / whole;
5397 }
5398
5399 {
5400 float old_top, old_shown;
5401 Dimension height;
5402 XtVaGetValues (widget,
5403 XtNtopOfThumb, &old_top,
5404 XtNshown, &old_shown,
5405 XtNheight, &height,
5406 NULL);
5407
5408 #if 0
5409 /* Massage the top+shown values. */
5410 if (bar->dragging == -1 || bar->last_seen_part == scroll_bar_down_arrow)
5411 top = max (0, min (1, top));
5412 else
5413 top = old_top;
5414 #if ! defined (HAVE_XAW3D)
5415 /* With Xaw, 'top' values too closer to 1.0 may
5416 cause the thumb to disappear. Fix that. */
5417 top = min (top, 0.99f);
5418 #endif
5419 /* Keep two pixels available for moving the thumb down. */
5420 shown = max (0, min (1 - top - (2.0f / height), shown));
5421 #if ! defined (HAVE_XAW3D)
5422 /* Likewise with too small 'shown'. */
5423 shown = max (shown, 0.01f);
5424 #endif
5425 #endif
5426
5427 /* If the call to XawScrollbarSetThumb below doesn't seem to
5428 work, check that 'NARROWPROTO' is defined in src/config.h.
5429 If this is not so, most likely you need to fix configure. */
5430 XawScrollbarSetThumb (widget, top, shown);
5431 #if 0
5432 if (top != old_top || shown != old_shown)
5433 {
5434 if (bar->dragging == -1)
5435 XawScrollbarSetThumb (widget, top, shown);
5436 else
5437 {
5438 /* Try to make the scrolling a tad smoother. */
5439 if (!xaw3d_pick_top)
5440 shown = min (shown, old_shown);
5441
5442 XawScrollbarSetThumb (widget, top, shown);
5443 }
5444 }
5445 #endif
5446 }
5447 #endif /* !USE_MOTIF */
5448
5449 unblock_input ();
5450 }
5451 #endif /* not USE_GTK */
5452
5453 #endif /* USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
5454
5455
5456 \f
5457 /************************************************************************
5458 Scroll bars, general
5459 ************************************************************************/
5460
5461 /* Create a scroll bar and return the scroll bar vector for it. W is
5462 the Emacs window on which to create the scroll bar. TOP, LEFT,
5463 WIDTH and HEIGHT are the pixel coordinates and dimensions of the
5464 scroll bar. */
5465
5466 static struct scroll_bar *
5467 x_scroll_bar_create (struct window *w, int top, int left, int width, int height, bool horizontal)
5468 {
5469 struct frame *f = XFRAME (w->frame);
5470 struct scroll_bar *bar
5471 = ALLOCATE_PSEUDOVECTOR (struct scroll_bar, x_window, PVEC_OTHER);
5472 Lisp_Object barobj;
5473
5474 block_input ();
5475
5476 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
5477 if (horizontal)
5478 x_create_horizontal_toolkit_scroll_bar (f, bar);
5479 else
5480 x_create_toolkit_scroll_bar (f, bar);
5481 #else /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
5482 {
5483 XSetWindowAttributes a;
5484 unsigned long mask;
5485 Window window;
5486
5487 a.background_pixel = f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_background_pixel;
5488 if (a.background_pixel == -1)
5489 a.background_pixel = FRAME_BACKGROUND_PIXEL (f);
5490
5491 a.event_mask = (ButtonPressMask | ButtonReleaseMask
5492 | ButtonMotionMask | PointerMotionHintMask
5493 | ExposureMask);
5494 a.cursor = FRAME_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->vertical_scroll_bar_cursor;
5495
5496 mask = (CWBackPixel | CWEventMask | CWCursor);
5497
5498 /* Clear the area of W that will serve as a scroll bar. This is
5499 for the case that a window has been split horizontally. In
5500 this case, no clear_frame is generated to reduce flickering. */
5501 if (width > 0 && window_box_height (w) > 0)
5502 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
5503 left, top, width, window_box_height (w));
5504
5505 window = XCreateWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
5506 /* Position and size of scroll bar. */
5507 left, top, width, height,
5508 /* Border width, depth, class, and visual. */
5509 0,
5510 CopyFromParent,
5511 CopyFromParent,
5512 CopyFromParent,
5513 /* Attributes. */
5514 mask, &a);
5515 bar->x_window = window;
5516 }
5517 #endif /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
5518
5519 XSETWINDOW (bar->window, w);
5520 bar->top = top;
5521 bar->left = left;
5522 bar->width = width;
5523 bar->height = height;
5524 bar->start = 0;
5525 bar->end = 0;
5526 bar->dragging = -1;
5527 bar->horizontal = horizontal;
5528 #if defined (USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS) && defined (USE_LUCID)
5529 bar->last_seen_part = scroll_bar_nowhere;
5530 #endif
5531
5532 /* Add bar to its frame's list of scroll bars. */
5533 bar->next = FRAME_SCROLL_BARS (f);
5534 bar->prev = Qnil;
5535 XSETVECTOR (barobj, bar);
5536 fset_scroll_bars (f, barobj);
5537 if (!NILP (bar->next))
5538 XSETVECTOR (XSCROLL_BAR (bar->next)->prev, bar);
5539
5540 /* Map the window/widget. */
5541 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
5542 {
5543 #ifdef USE_GTK
5544 if (horizontal)
5545 xg_update_horizontal_scrollbar_pos (f, bar->x_window, top,
5546 left, width, max (height, 1));
5547 else
5548 xg_update_scrollbar_pos (f, bar->x_window, top,
5549 left, width, max (height, 1));
5550 #else /* not USE_GTK */
5551 Widget scroll_bar = SCROLL_BAR_X_WIDGET (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), bar);
5552 XtConfigureWidget (scroll_bar, left, top, width, max (height, 1), 0);
5553 XtMapWidget (scroll_bar);
5554 #endif /* not USE_GTK */
5555 }
5556 #else /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
5557 XMapRaised (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), bar->x_window);
5558 #endif /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
5559
5560 unblock_input ();
5561 return bar;
5562 }
5563
5564
5565 #ifndef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
5566
5567 /* Draw BAR's handle in the proper position.
5568
5569 If the handle is already drawn from START to END, don't bother
5570 redrawing it, unless REBUILD is non-zero; in that case, always
5571 redraw it. (REBUILD is handy for drawing the handle after expose
5572 events.)
5573
5574 Normally, we want to constrain the start and end of the handle to
5575 fit inside its rectangle, but if the user is dragging the scroll
5576 bar handle, we want to let them drag it down all the way, so that
5577 the bar's top is as far down as it goes; otherwise, there's no way
5578 to move to the very end of the buffer. */
5579
5580 static void
5581 x_scroll_bar_set_handle (struct scroll_bar *bar, int start, int end, int rebuild)
5582 {
5583 bool dragging = bar->dragging != -1;
5584 Window w = bar->x_window;
5585 struct frame *f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (XWINDOW (bar->window)));
5586 GC gc = f->output_data.x->normal_gc;
5587
5588 /* If the display is already accurate, do nothing. */
5589 if (! rebuild
5590 && start == bar->start
5591 && end == bar->end)
5592 return;
5593
5594 block_input ();
5595
5596 {
5597 int inside_width = VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_INSIDE_WIDTH (f, bar->width);
5598 int inside_height = VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_INSIDE_HEIGHT (f, bar->height);
5599 int top_range = VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_TOP_RANGE (f, bar->height);
5600
5601 /* Make sure the values are reasonable, and try to preserve
5602 the distance between start and end. */
5603 {
5604 int length = end - start;
5605
5606 if (start < 0)
5607 start = 0;
5608 else if (start > top_range)
5609 start = top_range;
5610 end = start + length;
5611
5612 if (end < start)
5613 end = start;
5614 else if (end > top_range && ! dragging)
5615 end = top_range;
5616 }
5617
5618 /* Store the adjusted setting in the scroll bar. */
5619 bar->start = start;
5620 bar->end = end;
5621
5622 /* Clip the end position, just for display. */
5623 if (end > top_range)
5624 end = top_range;
5625
5626 /* Draw bottom positions VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_MIN_HANDLE pixels
5627 below top positions, to make sure the handle is always at least
5628 that many pixels tall. */
5629 end += VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_MIN_HANDLE;
5630
5631 /* Draw the empty space above the handle. Note that we can't clear
5632 zero-height areas; that means "clear to end of window." */
5633 if ((inside_width > 0) && (start > 0))
5634 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), w,
5635 VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_LEFT_BORDER,
5636 VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_TOP_BORDER,
5637 inside_width, start);
5638
5639 /* Change to proper foreground color if one is specified. */
5640 if (f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_foreground_pixel != -1)
5641 XSetForeground (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), gc,
5642 f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_foreground_pixel);
5643
5644 /* Draw the handle itself. */
5645 XFillRectangle (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), w, gc,
5646 /* x, y, width, height */
5647 VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_LEFT_BORDER,
5648 VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_TOP_BORDER + start,
5649 inside_width, end - start);
5650
5651 /* Restore the foreground color of the GC if we changed it above. */
5652 if (f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_foreground_pixel != -1)
5653 XSetForeground (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), gc,
5654 FRAME_FOREGROUND_PIXEL (f));
5655
5656 /* Draw the empty space below the handle. Note that we can't
5657 clear zero-height areas; that means "clear to end of window." */
5658 if ((inside_width > 0) && (end < inside_height))
5659 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), w,
5660 VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_LEFT_BORDER,
5661 VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_TOP_BORDER + end,
5662 inside_width, inside_height - end);
5663 }
5664
5665 unblock_input ();
5666 }
5667
5668 #endif /* !USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
5669
5670 /* Destroy scroll bar BAR, and set its Emacs window's scroll bar to
5671 nil. */
5672
5673 static void
5674 x_scroll_bar_remove (struct scroll_bar *bar)
5675 {
5676 struct frame *f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (XWINDOW (bar->window)));
5677 block_input ();
5678
5679 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
5680 #ifdef USE_GTK
5681 xg_remove_scroll_bar (f, bar->x_window);
5682 #else /* not USE_GTK */
5683 XtDestroyWidget (SCROLL_BAR_X_WIDGET (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), bar));
5684 #endif /* not USE_GTK */
5685 #else
5686 XDestroyWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), bar->x_window);
5687 #endif
5688
5689 /* Dissociate this scroll bar from its window. */
5690 if (bar->horizontal)
5691 wset_horizontal_scroll_bar (XWINDOW (bar->window), Qnil);
5692 else
5693 wset_vertical_scroll_bar (XWINDOW (bar->window), Qnil);
5694
5695 unblock_input ();
5696 }
5697
5698
5699 /* Set the handle of the vertical scroll bar for WINDOW to indicate
5700 that we are displaying PORTION characters out of a total of WHOLE
5701 characters, starting at POSITION. If WINDOW has no scroll bar,
5702 create one. */
5703
5704 static void
5705 XTset_vertical_scroll_bar (struct window *w, int portion, int whole, int position)
5706 {
5707 struct frame *f = XFRAME (w->frame);
5708 Lisp_Object barobj;
5709 struct scroll_bar *bar;
5710 int top, height, left, width;
5711 int window_y, window_height;
5712
5713 /* Get window dimensions. */
5714 window_box (w, ANY_AREA, 0, &window_y, 0, &window_height);
5715 top = window_y;
5716 height = window_height;
5717 left = WINDOW_SCROLL_BAR_AREA_X (w);
5718 width = WINDOW_SCROLL_BAR_AREA_WIDTH (w);
5719
5720 /* Does the scroll bar exist yet? */
5721 if (NILP (w->vertical_scroll_bar))
5722 {
5723 if (width > 0 && height > 0)
5724 {
5725 block_input ();
5726 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
5727 left, top, width, height);
5728 unblock_input ();
5729 }
5730
5731 bar = x_scroll_bar_create (w, top, left, width, max (height, 1), 0);
5732 }
5733 else
5734 {
5735 /* It may just need to be moved and resized. */
5736 unsigned int mask = 0;
5737
5738 bar = XSCROLL_BAR (w->vertical_scroll_bar);
5739
5740 block_input ();
5741
5742 if (left != bar->left)
5743 mask |= CWX;
5744 if (top != bar->top)
5745 mask |= CWY;
5746 if (width != bar->width)
5747 mask |= CWWidth;
5748 if (height != bar->height)
5749 mask |= CWHeight;
5750
5751 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
5752
5753 /* Move/size the scroll bar widget. */
5754 if (mask)
5755 {
5756 /* Since toolkit scroll bars are smaller than the space reserved
5757 for them on the frame, we have to clear "under" them. */
5758 if (width > 0 && height > 0)
5759 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
5760 left, top, width, height);
5761 #ifdef USE_GTK
5762 xg_update_scrollbar_pos (f, bar->x_window, top,
5763 left, width, max (height, 1));
5764 #else /* not USE_GTK */
5765 XtConfigureWidget (SCROLL_BAR_X_WIDGET (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), bar),
5766 left, top, width, max (height, 1), 0);
5767 #endif /* not USE_GTK */
5768 }
5769 #else /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
5770
5771 /* Move/size the scroll bar window. */
5772 if (mask)
5773 {
5774 XWindowChanges wc;
5775
5776 wc.x = left;
5777 wc.y = top;
5778 wc.width = width;
5779 wc.height = height;
5780 XConfigureWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), bar->x_window,
5781 mask, &wc);
5782 }
5783
5784 #endif /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
5785
5786 /* Remember new settings. */
5787 bar->left = left;
5788 bar->top = top;
5789 bar->width = width;
5790 bar->height = height;
5791
5792 unblock_input ();
5793 }
5794
5795 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
5796 x_set_toolkit_scroll_bar_thumb (bar, portion, position, whole);
5797 #else /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
5798 /* Set the scroll bar's current state, unless we're currently being
5799 dragged. */
5800 if (bar->dragging == -1)
5801 {
5802 int top_range = VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_TOP_RANGE (f, height);
5803
5804 if (whole == 0)
5805 x_scroll_bar_set_handle (bar, 0, top_range, 0);
5806 else
5807 {
5808 int start = ((double) position * top_range) / whole;
5809 int end = ((double) (position + portion) * top_range) / whole;
5810 x_scroll_bar_set_handle (bar, start, end, 0);
5811 }
5812 }
5813 #endif /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
5814
5815 XSETVECTOR (barobj, bar);
5816 wset_vertical_scroll_bar (w, barobj);
5817 }
5818
5819
5820 static void
5821 XTset_horizontal_scroll_bar (struct window *w, int portion, int whole, int position)
5822 {
5823 struct frame *f = XFRAME (w->frame);
5824 Lisp_Object barobj;
5825 struct scroll_bar *bar;
5826 int top, height, left, width;
5827 int window_x, window_width;
5828 int pixel_width = WINDOW_PIXEL_WIDTH (w);
5829
5830 /* Get window dimensions. */
5831 window_box (w, ANY_AREA, &window_x, 0, &window_width, 0);
5832 left = window_x;
5833 width = window_width;
5834 top = WINDOW_SCROLL_BAR_AREA_Y (w);
5835 height = WINDOW_SCROLL_BAR_AREA_HEIGHT (w);
5836
5837 /* Does the scroll bar exist yet? */
5838 if (NILP (w->horizontal_scroll_bar))
5839 {
5840 if (width > 0 && height > 0)
5841 {
5842 block_input ();
5843
5844 /* Clear also part between window_width and
5845 WINDOW_PIXEL_WIDTH. */
5846 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
5847 left, top, pixel_width, height);
5848 unblock_input ();
5849 }
5850
5851 bar = x_scroll_bar_create (w, top, left, width, height, 1);
5852 }
5853 else
5854 {
5855 /* It may just need to be moved and resized. */
5856 unsigned int mask = 0;
5857
5858 bar = XSCROLL_BAR (w->horizontal_scroll_bar);
5859
5860 block_input ();
5861
5862 if (left != bar->left)
5863 mask |= CWX;
5864 if (top != bar->top)
5865 mask |= CWY;
5866 if (width != bar->width)
5867 mask |= CWWidth;
5868 if (height != bar->height)
5869 mask |= CWHeight;
5870
5871 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
5872 /* Move/size the scroll bar widget. */
5873 if (mask)
5874 {
5875 /* Since toolkit scroll bars are smaller than the space reserved
5876 for them on the frame, we have to clear "under" them. */
5877 if (width > 0 && height > 0)
5878 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
5879 WINDOW_LEFT_EDGE_X (w), top,
5880 pixel_width - WINDOW_RIGHT_DIVIDER_WIDTH (w), height);
5881 #ifdef USE_GTK
5882 xg_update_horizontal_scrollbar_pos (f, bar->x_window, top, left,
5883 width, height);
5884 #else /* not USE_GTK */
5885 XtConfigureWidget (SCROLL_BAR_X_WIDGET (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), bar),
5886 left, top, width, height, 0);
5887 #endif /* not USE_GTK */
5888 }
5889 #else /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
5890
5891 /* Clear areas not covered by the scroll bar because it's not as
5892 wide as the area reserved for it. This makes sure a
5893 previous mode line display is cleared after C-x 2 C-x 1, for
5894 example. */
5895 {
5896 int area_height = WINDOW_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_HEIGHT (w);
5897 int rest = area_height - height;
5898 if (rest > 0 && width > 0)
5899 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
5900 left, top, width, rest);
5901 }
5902
5903 /* Move/size the scroll bar window. */
5904 if (mask)
5905 {
5906 XWindowChanges wc;
5907
5908 wc.x = left;
5909 wc.y = top;
5910 wc.width = width;
5911 wc.height = height;
5912 XConfigureWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), bar->x_window,
5913 mask, &wc);
5914 }
5915
5916 #endif /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
5917
5918 /* Remember new settings. */
5919 bar->left = left;
5920 bar->top = top;
5921 bar->width = width;
5922 bar->height = height;
5923
5924 unblock_input ();
5925 }
5926
5927 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
5928 x_set_toolkit_horizontal_scroll_bar_thumb (bar, portion, position, whole);
5929 #else /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
5930 /* Set the scroll bar's current state, unless we're currently being
5931 dragged. */
5932 if (bar->dragging == -1)
5933 {
5934 int left_range = HORIZONTAL_SCROLL_BAR_LEFT_RANGE (f, width);
5935
5936 if (whole == 0)
5937 x_scroll_bar_set_handle (bar, 0, left_range, 0);
5938 else
5939 {
5940 int start = ((double) position * left_range) / whole;
5941 int end = ((double) (position + portion) * left_range) / whole;
5942 x_scroll_bar_set_handle (bar, start, end, 0);
5943 }
5944 }
5945 #endif /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
5946
5947 XSETVECTOR (barobj, bar);
5948 wset_horizontal_scroll_bar (w, barobj);
5949 }
5950
5951
5952 /* The following three hooks are used when we're doing a thorough
5953 redisplay of the frame. We don't explicitly know which scroll bars
5954 are going to be deleted, because keeping track of when windows go
5955 away is a real pain - "Can you say set-window-configuration, boys
5956 and girls?" Instead, we just assert at the beginning of redisplay
5957 that *all* scroll bars are to be removed, and then save a scroll bar
5958 from the fiery pit when we actually redisplay its window. */
5959
5960 /* Arrange for all scroll bars on FRAME to be removed at the next call
5961 to `*judge_scroll_bars_hook'. A scroll bar may be spared if
5962 `*redeem_scroll_bar_hook' is applied to its window before the judgment. */
5963
5964 static void
5965 XTcondemn_scroll_bars (struct frame *frame)
5966 {
5967 if (!NILP (FRAME_SCROLL_BARS (frame)))
5968 {
5969 if (!NILP (FRAME_CONDEMNED_SCROLL_BARS (frame)))
5970 {
5971 /* Prepend scrollbars to already condemned ones. */
5972 Lisp_Object last = FRAME_SCROLL_BARS (frame);
5973
5974 while (!NILP (XSCROLL_BAR (last)->next))
5975 last = XSCROLL_BAR (last)->next;
5976
5977 XSCROLL_BAR (last)->next = FRAME_CONDEMNED_SCROLL_BARS (frame);
5978 XSCROLL_BAR (FRAME_CONDEMNED_SCROLL_BARS (frame))->prev = last;
5979 }
5980
5981 fset_condemned_scroll_bars (frame, FRAME_SCROLL_BARS (frame));
5982 fset_scroll_bars (frame, Qnil);
5983 }
5984 }
5985
5986
5987 /* Un-mark WINDOW's scroll bar for deletion in this judgment cycle.
5988 Note that WINDOW isn't necessarily condemned at all. */
5989
5990 static void
5991 XTredeem_scroll_bar (struct window *w)
5992 {
5993 struct scroll_bar *bar;
5994 Lisp_Object barobj;
5995 struct frame *f;
5996
5997 /* We can't redeem this window's scroll bar if it doesn't have one. */
5998 if (NILP (w->vertical_scroll_bar) && NILP (w->horizontal_scroll_bar))
5999 emacs_abort ();
6000
6001 if (!NILP (w->vertical_scroll_bar) && WINDOW_HAS_VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR (w))
6002 {
6003 bar = XSCROLL_BAR (w->vertical_scroll_bar);
6004 /* Unlink it from the condemned list. */
6005 f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (w));
6006 if (NILP (bar->prev))
6007 {
6008 /* If the prev pointer is nil, it must be the first in one of
6009 the lists. */
6010 if (EQ (FRAME_SCROLL_BARS (f), w->vertical_scroll_bar))
6011 /* It's not condemned. Everything's fine. */
6012 goto horizontal;
6013 else if (EQ (FRAME_CONDEMNED_SCROLL_BARS (f),
6014 w->vertical_scroll_bar))
6015 fset_condemned_scroll_bars (f, bar->next);
6016 else
6017 /* If its prev pointer is nil, it must be at the front of
6018 one or the other! */
6019 emacs_abort ();
6020 }
6021 else
6022 XSCROLL_BAR (bar->prev)->next = bar->next;
6023
6024 if (! NILP (bar->next))
6025 XSCROLL_BAR (bar->next)->prev = bar->prev;
6026
6027 bar->next = FRAME_SCROLL_BARS (f);
6028 bar->prev = Qnil;
6029 XSETVECTOR (barobj, bar);
6030 fset_scroll_bars (f, barobj);
6031 if (! NILP (bar->next))
6032 XSETVECTOR (XSCROLL_BAR (bar->next)->prev, bar);
6033 }
6034
6035 horizontal:
6036 if (!NILP (w->horizontal_scroll_bar) && WINDOW_HAS_HORIZONTAL_SCROLL_BAR (w))
6037 {
6038 bar = XSCROLL_BAR (w->horizontal_scroll_bar);
6039 /* Unlink it from the condemned list. */
6040 f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (w));
6041 if (NILP (bar->prev))
6042 {
6043 /* If the prev pointer is nil, it must be the first in one of
6044 the lists. */
6045 if (EQ (FRAME_SCROLL_BARS (f), w->horizontal_scroll_bar))
6046 /* It's not condemned. Everything's fine. */
6047 return;
6048 else if (EQ (FRAME_CONDEMNED_SCROLL_BARS (f),
6049 w->horizontal_scroll_bar))
6050 fset_condemned_scroll_bars (f, bar->next);
6051 else
6052 /* If its prev pointer is nil, it must be at the front of
6053 one or the other! */
6054 emacs_abort ();
6055 }
6056 else
6057 XSCROLL_BAR (bar->prev)->next = bar->next;
6058
6059 if (! NILP (bar->next))
6060 XSCROLL_BAR (bar->next)->prev = bar->prev;
6061
6062 bar->next = FRAME_SCROLL_BARS (f);
6063 bar->prev = Qnil;
6064 XSETVECTOR (barobj, bar);
6065 fset_scroll_bars (f, barobj);
6066 if (! NILP (bar->next))
6067 XSETVECTOR (XSCROLL_BAR (bar->next)->prev, bar);
6068 }
6069 }
6070
6071 /* Remove all scroll bars on FRAME that haven't been saved since the
6072 last call to `*condemn_scroll_bars_hook'. */
6073
6074 static void
6075 XTjudge_scroll_bars (struct frame *f)
6076 {
6077 Lisp_Object bar, next;
6078
6079 bar = FRAME_CONDEMNED_SCROLL_BARS (f);
6080
6081 /* Clear out the condemned list now so we won't try to process any
6082 more events on the hapless scroll bars. */
6083 fset_condemned_scroll_bars (f, Qnil);
6084
6085 for (; ! NILP (bar); bar = next)
6086 {
6087 struct scroll_bar *b = XSCROLL_BAR (bar);
6088
6089 x_scroll_bar_remove (b);
6090
6091 next = b->next;
6092 b->next = b->prev = Qnil;
6093 }
6094
6095 /* Now there should be no references to the condemned scroll bars,
6096 and they should get garbage-collected. */
6097 }
6098
6099
6100 #ifndef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
6101 /* Handle an Expose or GraphicsExpose event on a scroll bar. This
6102 is a no-op when using toolkit scroll bars.
6103
6104 This may be called from a signal handler, so we have to ignore GC
6105 mark bits. */
6106
6107 static void
6108 x_scroll_bar_expose (struct scroll_bar *bar, const XEvent *event)
6109 {
6110 Window w = bar->x_window;
6111 struct frame *f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (XWINDOW (bar->window)));
6112 GC gc = f->output_data.x->normal_gc;
6113
6114 block_input ();
6115
6116 x_scroll_bar_set_handle (bar, bar->start, bar->end, 1);
6117
6118 /* Switch to scroll bar foreground color. */
6119 if (f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_foreground_pixel != -1)
6120 XSetForeground (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), gc,
6121 f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_foreground_pixel);
6122
6123 /* Draw a one-pixel border just inside the edges of the scroll bar. */
6124 XDrawRectangle (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), w, gc,
6125 /* x, y, width, height */
6126 0, 0, bar->width - 1, bar->height - 1);
6127
6128 /* Restore the foreground color of the GC if we changed it above. */
6129 if (f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_foreground_pixel != -1)
6130 XSetForeground (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), gc,
6131 FRAME_FOREGROUND_PIXEL (f));
6132
6133 unblock_input ();
6134
6135 }
6136 #endif /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
6137
6138 /* Handle a mouse click on the scroll bar BAR. If *EMACS_EVENT's kind
6139 is set to something other than NO_EVENT, it is enqueued.
6140
6141 This may be called from a signal handler, so we have to ignore GC
6142 mark bits. */
6143
6144
6145 static void
6146 x_scroll_bar_handle_click (struct scroll_bar *bar,
6147 const XEvent *event,
6148 struct input_event *emacs_event)
6149 {
6150 if (! WINDOWP (bar->window))
6151 emacs_abort ();
6152
6153 emacs_event->kind = (bar->horizontal
6154 ? HORIZONTAL_SCROLL_BAR_CLICK_EVENT
6155 : SCROLL_BAR_CLICK_EVENT);
6156 emacs_event->code = event->xbutton.button - Button1;
6157 emacs_event->modifiers
6158 = (x_x_to_emacs_modifiers (FRAME_DISPLAY_INFO
6159 (XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (XWINDOW (bar->window)))),
6160 event->xbutton.state)
6161 | (event->type == ButtonRelease
6162 ? up_modifier
6163 : down_modifier));
6164 emacs_event->frame_or_window = bar->window;
6165 emacs_event->arg = Qnil;
6166 emacs_event->timestamp = event->xbutton.time;
6167 if (bar->horizontal)
6168 {
6169 int left_range
6170 = HORIZONTAL_SCROLL_BAR_LEFT_RANGE (f, bar->width);
6171 int x = event->xbutton.x - HORIZONTAL_SCROLL_BAR_LEFT_BORDER;
6172
6173 if (x < 0) x = 0;
6174 if (x > left_range) x = left_range;
6175
6176 if (x < bar->start)
6177 emacs_event->part = scroll_bar_before_handle;
6178 else if (x < bar->end + HORIZONTAL_SCROLL_BAR_MIN_HANDLE)
6179 emacs_event->part = scroll_bar_horizontal_handle;
6180 else
6181 emacs_event->part = scroll_bar_after_handle;
6182
6183 #ifndef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
6184 /* If the user has released the handle, set it to its final position. */
6185 if (event->type == ButtonRelease && bar->dragging != -1)
6186 {
6187 int new_start = - bar->dragging;
6188 int new_end = new_start + bar->end - bar->start;
6189
6190 x_scroll_bar_set_handle (bar, new_start, new_end, 0);
6191 bar->dragging = -1;
6192 }
6193 #endif
6194
6195 XSETINT (emacs_event->x, left_range);
6196 XSETINT (emacs_event->y, x);
6197 }
6198 else
6199 {
6200 int top_range
6201 = VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_TOP_RANGE (f, bar->height);
6202 int y = event->xbutton.y - VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_TOP_BORDER;
6203
6204 if (y < 0) y = 0;
6205 if (y > top_range) y = top_range;
6206
6207 if (y < bar->start)
6208 emacs_event->part = scroll_bar_above_handle;
6209 else if (y < bar->end + VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_MIN_HANDLE)
6210 emacs_event->part = scroll_bar_handle;
6211 else
6212 emacs_event->part = scroll_bar_below_handle;
6213
6214 #ifndef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
6215 /* If the user has released the handle, set it to its final position. */
6216 if (event->type == ButtonRelease && bar->dragging != -1)
6217 {
6218 int new_start = y - bar->dragging;
6219 int new_end = new_start + bar->end - bar->start;
6220
6221 x_scroll_bar_set_handle (bar, new_start, new_end, 0);
6222 bar->dragging = -1;
6223 }
6224 #endif
6225
6226 XSETINT (emacs_event->x, y);
6227 XSETINT (emacs_event->y, top_range);
6228 }
6229 }
6230
6231 #ifndef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
6232
6233 /* Handle some mouse motion while someone is dragging the scroll bar.
6234
6235 This may be called from a signal handler, so we have to ignore GC
6236 mark bits. */
6237
6238 static void
6239 x_scroll_bar_note_movement (struct scroll_bar *bar,
6240 const XMotionEvent *event)
6241 {
6242 struct frame *f = XFRAME (XWINDOW (bar->window)->frame);
6243 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
6244
6245 dpyinfo->last_mouse_movement_time = event->time;
6246 dpyinfo->last_mouse_scroll_bar = bar;
6247 f->mouse_moved = 1;
6248
6249 /* If we're dragging the bar, display it. */
6250 if (bar->dragging != -1)
6251 {
6252 /* Where should the handle be now? */
6253 int new_start = event->y - bar->dragging;
6254
6255 if (new_start != bar->start)
6256 {
6257 int new_end = new_start + bar->end - bar->start;
6258
6259 x_scroll_bar_set_handle (bar, new_start, new_end, 0);
6260 }
6261 }
6262 }
6263
6264 #endif /* !USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
6265
6266 /* Return information to the user about the current position of the mouse
6267 on the scroll bar. */
6268
6269 static void
6270 x_scroll_bar_report_motion (struct frame **fp, Lisp_Object *bar_window,
6271 enum scroll_bar_part *part, Lisp_Object *x,
6272 Lisp_Object *y, Time *timestamp)
6273 {
6274 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_DISPLAY_INFO (*fp);
6275 struct scroll_bar *bar = dpyinfo->last_mouse_scroll_bar;
6276 Window w = bar->x_window;
6277 struct frame *f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (XWINDOW (bar->window)));
6278 int win_x, win_y;
6279 Window dummy_window;
6280 int dummy_coord;
6281 unsigned int dummy_mask;
6282
6283 block_input ();
6284
6285 /* Get the mouse's position relative to the scroll bar window, and
6286 report that. */
6287 if (XQueryPointer (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), w,
6288
6289 /* Root, child, root x and root y. */
6290 &dummy_window, &dummy_window,
6291 &dummy_coord, &dummy_coord,
6292
6293 /* Position relative to scroll bar. */
6294 &win_x, &win_y,
6295
6296 /* Mouse buttons and modifier keys. */
6297 &dummy_mask))
6298 {
6299 int top_range = VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_TOP_RANGE (f, bar->height);
6300
6301 win_y -= VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_TOP_BORDER;
6302
6303 if (bar->dragging != -1)
6304 win_y -= bar->dragging;
6305
6306 if (win_y < 0)
6307 win_y = 0;
6308 if (win_y > top_range)
6309 win_y = top_range;
6310
6311 *fp = f;
6312 *bar_window = bar->window;
6313
6314 if (bar->dragging != -1)
6315 *part = scroll_bar_handle;
6316 else if (win_y < bar->start)
6317 *part = scroll_bar_above_handle;
6318 else if (win_y < bar->end + VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_MIN_HANDLE)
6319 *part = scroll_bar_handle;
6320 else
6321 *part = scroll_bar_below_handle;
6322
6323 XSETINT (*x, win_y);
6324 XSETINT (*y, top_range);
6325
6326 f->mouse_moved = 0;
6327 dpyinfo->last_mouse_scroll_bar = NULL;
6328 *timestamp = dpyinfo->last_mouse_movement_time;
6329 }
6330
6331 unblock_input ();
6332 }
6333
6334
6335 /* Return information to the user about the current position of the mouse
6336 on the scroll bar. */
6337
6338 static void
6339 x_horizontal_scroll_bar_report_motion (struct frame **fp, Lisp_Object *bar_window,
6340 enum scroll_bar_part *part, Lisp_Object *x,
6341 Lisp_Object *y, Time *timestamp)
6342 {
6343 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_DISPLAY_INFO (*fp);
6344 struct scroll_bar *bar = dpyinfo->last_mouse_scroll_bar;
6345 Window w = bar->x_window;
6346 struct frame *f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (XWINDOW (bar->window)));
6347 int win_x, win_y;
6348 Window dummy_window;
6349 int dummy_coord;
6350 unsigned int dummy_mask;
6351
6352 block_input ();
6353
6354 /* Get the mouse's position relative to the scroll bar window, and
6355 report that. */
6356 if (XQueryPointer (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), w,
6357
6358 /* Root, child, root x and root y. */
6359 &dummy_window, &dummy_window,
6360 &dummy_coord, &dummy_coord,
6361
6362 /* Position relative to scroll bar. */
6363 &win_x, &win_y,
6364
6365 /* Mouse buttons and modifier keys. */
6366 &dummy_mask))
6367 {
6368 int left_range = HORIZONTAL_SCROLL_BAR_LEFT_RANGE (f, bar->width);
6369
6370 win_x -= HORIZONTAL_SCROLL_BAR_LEFT_BORDER;
6371
6372 if (bar->dragging != -1)
6373 win_x -= bar->dragging;
6374
6375 if (win_x < 0)
6376 win_x = 0;
6377 if (win_x > left_range)
6378 win_x = left_range;
6379
6380 *fp = f;
6381 *bar_window = bar->window;
6382
6383 if (bar->dragging != -1)
6384 *part = scroll_bar_horizontal_handle;
6385 else if (win_x < bar->start)
6386 *part = scroll_bar_before_handle;
6387 else if (win_x < bar->end + HORIZONTAL_SCROLL_BAR_MIN_HANDLE)
6388 *part = scroll_bar_handle;
6389 else
6390 *part = scroll_bar_after_handle;
6391
6392 XSETINT (*y, win_x);
6393 XSETINT (*x, left_range);
6394
6395 f->mouse_moved = 0;
6396 dpyinfo->last_mouse_scroll_bar = NULL;
6397 *timestamp = dpyinfo->last_mouse_movement_time;
6398 }
6399
6400 unblock_input ();
6401 }
6402
6403
6404 /* The screen has been cleared so we may have changed foreground or
6405 background colors, and the scroll bars may need to be redrawn.
6406 Clear out the scroll bars, and ask for expose events, so we can
6407 redraw them. */
6408
6409 static void
6410 x_scroll_bar_clear (struct frame *f)
6411 {
6412 #ifndef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
6413 Lisp_Object bar;
6414
6415 /* We can have scroll bars even if this is 0,
6416 if we just turned off scroll bar mode.
6417 But in that case we should not clear them. */
6418 if (FRAME_HAS_VERTICAL_SCROLL_BARS (f))
6419 for (bar = FRAME_SCROLL_BARS (f); VECTORP (bar);
6420 bar = XSCROLL_BAR (bar)->next)
6421 XClearArea (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f),
6422 XSCROLL_BAR (bar)->x_window,
6423 0, 0, 0, 0, True);
6424 #endif /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
6425 }
6426
6427 #ifdef ENABLE_CHECKING
6428
6429 /* Record the last 100 characters stored
6430 to help debug the loss-of-chars-during-GC problem. */
6431
6432 static int temp_index;
6433 static short temp_buffer[100];
6434
6435 #define STORE_KEYSYM_FOR_DEBUG(keysym) \
6436 if (temp_index == ARRAYELTS (temp_buffer)) \
6437 temp_index = 0; \
6438 temp_buffer[temp_index++] = (keysym)
6439
6440 #else /* not ENABLE_CHECKING */
6441
6442 #define STORE_KEYSYM_FOR_DEBUG(keysym) ((void)0)
6443
6444 #endif /* ENABLE_CHECKING */
6445
6446 /* Set this to nonzero to fake an "X I/O error"
6447 on a particular display. */
6448
6449 static struct x_display_info *XTread_socket_fake_io_error;
6450
6451 /* When we find no input here, we occasionally do a no-op command
6452 to verify that the X server is still running and we can still talk with it.
6453 We try all the open displays, one by one.
6454 This variable is used for cycling thru the displays. */
6455
6456 static struct x_display_info *next_noop_dpyinfo;
6457
6458 enum
6459 {
6460 X_EVENT_NORMAL,
6461 X_EVENT_GOTO_OUT,
6462 X_EVENT_DROP
6463 };
6464
6465 /* Filter events for the current X input method.
6466 DPYINFO is the display this event is for.
6467 EVENT is the X event to filter.
6468
6469 Returns non-zero if the event was filtered, caller shall not process
6470 this event further.
6471 Returns zero if event is wasn't filtered. */
6472
6473 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
6474 static int
6475 x_filter_event (struct x_display_info *dpyinfo, XEvent *event)
6476 {
6477 /* XFilterEvent returns non-zero if the input method has
6478 consumed the event. We pass the frame's X window to
6479 XFilterEvent because that's the one for which the IC
6480 was created. */
6481
6482 struct frame *f1 = x_any_window_to_frame (dpyinfo,
6483 event->xclient.window);
6484
6485 return XFilterEvent (event, f1 ? FRAME_X_WINDOW (f1) : None);
6486 }
6487 #endif
6488
6489 #ifdef USE_GTK
6490 static int current_count;
6491 static int current_finish;
6492 static struct input_event *current_hold_quit;
6493
6494 /* This is the filter function invoked by the GTK event loop.
6495 It is invoked before the XEvent is translated to a GdkEvent,
6496 so we have a chance to act on the event before GTK. */
6497 static GdkFilterReturn
6498 event_handler_gdk (GdkXEvent *gxev, GdkEvent *ev, gpointer data)
6499 {
6500 XEvent *xev = (XEvent *) gxev;
6501
6502 block_input ();
6503 if (current_count >= 0)
6504 {
6505 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
6506
6507 dpyinfo = x_display_info_for_display (xev->xany.display);
6508
6509 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
6510 /* Filter events for the current X input method.
6511 GTK calls XFilterEvent but not for key press and release,
6512 so we do it here. */
6513 if ((xev->type == KeyPress || xev->type == KeyRelease)
6514 && dpyinfo
6515 && x_filter_event (dpyinfo, xev))
6516 {
6517 unblock_input ();
6518 return GDK_FILTER_REMOVE;
6519 }
6520 #endif
6521
6522 if (! dpyinfo)
6523 current_finish = X_EVENT_NORMAL;
6524 else
6525 current_count
6526 += handle_one_xevent (dpyinfo, xev, &current_finish,
6527 current_hold_quit);
6528 }
6529 else
6530 current_finish = x_dispatch_event (xev, xev->xany.display);
6531
6532 unblock_input ();
6533
6534 if (current_finish == X_EVENT_GOTO_OUT || current_finish == X_EVENT_DROP)
6535 return GDK_FILTER_REMOVE;
6536
6537 return GDK_FILTER_CONTINUE;
6538 }
6539 #endif /* USE_GTK */
6540
6541
6542 static void xembed_send_message (struct frame *f, Time,
6543 enum xembed_message,
6544 long detail, long data1, long data2);
6545
6546 static void
6547 x_net_wm_state (struct frame *f, Window window)
6548 {
6549 int value = FULLSCREEN_NONE;
6550 Lisp_Object lval = Qnil;
6551 int sticky = 0;
6552
6553 (void)get_current_wm_state (f, window, &value, &sticky);
6554
6555 switch (value)
6556 {
6557 case FULLSCREEN_WIDTH:
6558 lval = Qfullwidth;
6559 break;
6560 case FULLSCREEN_HEIGHT:
6561 lval = Qfullheight;
6562 break;
6563 case FULLSCREEN_BOTH:
6564 lval = Qfullboth;
6565 break;
6566 case FULLSCREEN_MAXIMIZED:
6567 lval = Qmaximized;
6568 break;
6569 }
6570
6571 store_frame_param (f, Qfullscreen, lval);
6572 /** store_frame_param (f, Qsticky, sticky ? Qt : Qnil); **/
6573 }
6574
6575 /* Handles the XEvent EVENT on display DPYINFO.
6576
6577 *FINISH is X_EVENT_GOTO_OUT if caller should stop reading events.
6578 *FINISH is zero if caller should continue reading events.
6579 *FINISH is X_EVENT_DROP if event should not be passed to the toolkit.
6580 *EVENT is unchanged unless we're processing KeyPress event.
6581
6582 We return the number of characters stored into the buffer. */
6583
6584 static int
6585 handle_one_xevent (struct x_display_info *dpyinfo,
6586 const XEvent *event,
6587 int *finish, struct input_event *hold_quit)
6588 {
6589 union {
6590 struct input_event ie;
6591 struct selection_input_event sie;
6592 } inev;
6593 int count = 0;
6594 int do_help = 0;
6595 ptrdiff_t nbytes = 0;
6596 struct frame *any, *f = NULL;
6597 struct coding_system coding;
6598 Mouse_HLInfo *hlinfo = &dpyinfo->mouse_highlight;
6599 /* This holds the state XLookupString needs to implement dead keys
6600 and other tricks known as "compose processing". _X Window System_
6601 says that a portable program can't use this, but Stephen Gildea assures
6602 me that letting the compiler initialize it to zeros will work okay. */
6603 static XComposeStatus compose_status;
6604
6605 USE_SAFE_ALLOCA;
6606
6607 *finish = X_EVENT_NORMAL;
6608
6609 EVENT_INIT (inev.ie);
6610 inev.ie.kind = NO_EVENT;
6611 inev.ie.arg = Qnil;
6612
6613 any = x_any_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event->xany.window);
6614
6615 if (any && any->wait_event_type == event->type)
6616 any->wait_event_type = 0; /* Indicates we got it. */
6617
6618 switch (event->type)
6619 {
6620 case ClientMessage:
6621 {
6622 if (event->xclient.message_type == dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_protocols
6623 && event->xclient.format == 32)
6624 {
6625 if (event->xclient.data.l[0] == dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_take_focus)
6626 {
6627 /* Use the value returned by x_any_window_to_frame
6628 because this could be the shell widget window
6629 if the frame has no title bar. */
6630 f = any;
6631 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
6632 /* Not quite sure this is needed -pd */
6633 if (f && FRAME_XIC (f))
6634 XSetICFocus (FRAME_XIC (f));
6635 #endif
6636 #if 0 /* Emacs sets WM hints whose `input' field is `true'. This
6637 instructs the WM to set the input focus automatically for
6638 Emacs with a call to XSetInputFocus. Setting WM_TAKE_FOCUS
6639 tells the WM to send us a ClientMessage WM_TAKE_FOCUS after
6640 it has set the focus. So, XSetInputFocus below is not
6641 needed.
6642
6643 The call to XSetInputFocus below has also caused trouble. In
6644 cases where the XSetInputFocus done by the WM and the one
6645 below are temporally close (on a fast machine), the call
6646 below can generate additional FocusIn events which confuse
6647 Emacs. */
6648
6649 /* Since we set WM_TAKE_FOCUS, we must call
6650 XSetInputFocus explicitly. But not if f is null,
6651 since that might be an event for a deleted frame. */
6652 if (f)
6653 {
6654 Display *d = event->xclient.display;
6655 /* Catch and ignore errors, in case window has been
6656 iconified by a window manager such as GWM. */
6657 x_catch_errors (d);
6658 XSetInputFocus (d, event->xclient.window,
6659 /* The ICCCM says this is
6660 the only valid choice. */
6661 RevertToParent,
6662 event->xclient.data.l[1]);
6663 /* This is needed to detect the error
6664 if there is an error. */
6665 XSync (d, False);
6666 x_uncatch_errors ();
6667 }
6668 /* Not certain about handling scroll bars here */
6669 #endif /* 0 */
6670 goto done;
6671 }
6672
6673 if (event->xclient.data.l[0] == dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_save_yourself)
6674 {
6675 /* Save state modify the WM_COMMAND property to
6676 something which can reinstate us. This notifies
6677 the session manager, who's looking for such a
6678 PropertyNotify. Can restart processing when
6679 a keyboard or mouse event arrives. */
6680 /* If we have a session manager, don't set this.
6681 KDE will then start two Emacsen, one for the
6682 session manager and one for this. */
6683 #ifdef HAVE_X_SM
6684 if (! x_session_have_connection ())
6685 #endif
6686 {
6687 f = x_top_window_to_frame (dpyinfo,
6688 event->xclient.window);
6689 /* This is just so we only give real data once
6690 for a single Emacs process. */
6691 if (f == SELECTED_FRAME ())
6692 XSetCommand (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f),
6693 event->xclient.window,
6694 initial_argv, initial_argc);
6695 else if (f)
6696 XSetCommand (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f),
6697 event->xclient.window,
6698 0, 0);
6699 }
6700 goto done;
6701 }
6702
6703 if (event->xclient.data.l[0] == dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_delete_window)
6704 {
6705 f = any;
6706 if (!f)
6707 goto OTHER; /* May be a dialog that is to be removed */
6708
6709 inev.ie.kind = DELETE_WINDOW_EVENT;
6710 XSETFRAME (inev.ie.frame_or_window, f);
6711 goto done;
6712 }
6713
6714 goto done;
6715 }
6716
6717 if (event->xclient.message_type == dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_configure_denied)
6718 goto done;
6719
6720 if (event->xclient.message_type == dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_window_moved)
6721 {
6722 int new_x, new_y;
6723 f = x_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event->xclient.window);
6724
6725 new_x = event->xclient.data.s[0];
6726 new_y = event->xclient.data.s[1];
6727
6728 if (f)
6729 {
6730 f->left_pos = new_x;
6731 f->top_pos = new_y;
6732 }
6733 goto done;
6734 }
6735
6736 #ifdef HACK_EDITRES
6737 if (event->xclient.message_type == dpyinfo->Xatom_editres)
6738 {
6739 f = any;
6740 if (f)
6741 _XEditResCheckMessages (f->output_data.x->widget,
6742 NULL, (XEvent *) event, NULL);
6743 goto done;
6744 }
6745 #endif /* HACK_EDITRES */
6746
6747 if (event->xclient.message_type == dpyinfo->Xatom_DONE
6748 || event->xclient.message_type == dpyinfo->Xatom_PAGE)
6749 {
6750 /* Ghostview job completed. Kill it. We could
6751 reply with "Next" if we received "Page", but we
6752 currently never do because we are interested in
6753 images, only, which should have 1 page. */
6754 Pixmap pixmap = (Pixmap) event->xclient.data.l[1];
6755 f = x_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event->xclient.window);
6756 if (!f)
6757 goto OTHER;
6758 x_kill_gs_process (pixmap, f);
6759 expose_frame (f, 0, 0, 0, 0);
6760 goto done;
6761 }
6762
6763 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
6764 /* Scroll bar callbacks send a ClientMessage from which
6765 we construct an input_event. */
6766 if (event->xclient.message_type == dpyinfo->Xatom_Scrollbar)
6767 {
6768 x_scroll_bar_to_input_event (event, &inev.ie);
6769 *finish = X_EVENT_GOTO_OUT;
6770 goto done;
6771 }
6772 else if (event->xclient.message_type == dpyinfo->Xatom_Horizontal_Scrollbar)
6773 {
6774 x_horizontal_scroll_bar_to_input_event (event, &inev.ie);
6775 *finish = X_EVENT_GOTO_OUT;
6776 goto done;
6777 }
6778 #endif /* USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
6779
6780 /* XEmbed messages from the embedder (if any). */
6781 if (event->xclient.message_type == dpyinfo->Xatom_XEMBED)
6782 {
6783 enum xembed_message msg = event->xclient.data.l[1];
6784 if (msg == XEMBED_FOCUS_IN || msg == XEMBED_FOCUS_OUT)
6785 x_detect_focus_change (dpyinfo, any, event, &inev.ie);
6786
6787 *finish = X_EVENT_GOTO_OUT;
6788 goto done;
6789 }
6790
6791 xft_settings_event (dpyinfo, event);
6792
6793 f = any;
6794 if (!f)
6795 goto OTHER;
6796 if (x_handle_dnd_message (f, &event->xclient, dpyinfo, &inev.ie))
6797 *finish = X_EVENT_DROP;
6798 }
6799 break;
6800
6801 case SelectionNotify:
6802 dpyinfo->last_user_time = event->xselection.time;
6803 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
6804 if (! x_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event->xselection.requestor))
6805 goto OTHER;
6806 #endif /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
6807 x_handle_selection_notify (&event->xselection);
6808 break;
6809
6810 case SelectionClear: /* Someone has grabbed ownership. */
6811 dpyinfo->last_user_time = event->xselectionclear.time;
6812 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
6813 if (! x_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event->xselectionclear.window))
6814 goto OTHER;
6815 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
6816 {
6817 const XSelectionClearEvent *eventp = &event->xselectionclear;
6818
6819 inev.ie.kind = SELECTION_CLEAR_EVENT;
6820 SELECTION_EVENT_DPYINFO (&inev.sie) = dpyinfo;
6821 SELECTION_EVENT_SELECTION (&inev.sie) = eventp->selection;
6822 SELECTION_EVENT_TIME (&inev.sie) = eventp->time;
6823 }
6824 break;
6825
6826 case SelectionRequest: /* Someone wants our selection. */
6827 dpyinfo->last_user_time = event->xselectionrequest.time;
6828 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
6829 if (!x_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event->xselectionrequest.owner))
6830 goto OTHER;
6831 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
6832 {
6833 const XSelectionRequestEvent *eventp = &event->xselectionrequest;
6834
6835 inev.ie.kind = SELECTION_REQUEST_EVENT;
6836 SELECTION_EVENT_DPYINFO (&inev.sie) = dpyinfo;
6837 SELECTION_EVENT_REQUESTOR (&inev.sie) = eventp->requestor;
6838 SELECTION_EVENT_SELECTION (&inev.sie) = eventp->selection;
6839 SELECTION_EVENT_TARGET (&inev.sie) = eventp->target;
6840 SELECTION_EVENT_PROPERTY (&inev.sie) = eventp->property;
6841 SELECTION_EVENT_TIME (&inev.sie) = eventp->time;
6842 }
6843 break;
6844
6845 case PropertyNotify:
6846 dpyinfo->last_user_time = event->xproperty.time;
6847 f = x_top_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event->xproperty.window);
6848 if (f && event->xproperty.atom == dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state)
6849 {
6850 if (x_handle_net_wm_state (f, &event->xproperty)
6851 && FRAME_ICONIFIED_P (f)
6852 && f->output_data.x->net_wm_state_hidden_seen)
6853 {
6854 /* Gnome shell does not iconify us when C-z is pressed.
6855 It hides the frame. So if our state says we aren't
6856 hidden anymore, treat it as deiconified. */
6857 SET_FRAME_VISIBLE (f, 1);
6858 SET_FRAME_ICONIFIED (f, 0);
6859 f->output_data.x->has_been_visible = 1;
6860 f->output_data.x->net_wm_state_hidden_seen = 0;
6861 inev.ie.kind = DEICONIFY_EVENT;
6862 XSETFRAME (inev.ie.frame_or_window, f);
6863 }
6864 else if (! FRAME_ICONIFIED_P (f)
6865 && f->output_data.x->net_wm_state_hidden_seen)
6866 {
6867 SET_FRAME_VISIBLE (f, 0);
6868 SET_FRAME_ICONIFIED (f, 1);
6869 inev.ie.kind = ICONIFY_EVENT;
6870 XSETFRAME (inev.ie.frame_or_window, f);
6871 }
6872 }
6873
6874 x_handle_property_notify (&event->xproperty);
6875 xft_settings_event (dpyinfo, event);
6876 goto OTHER;
6877
6878 case ReparentNotify:
6879 f = x_top_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event->xreparent.window);
6880 if (f)
6881 {
6882 f->output_data.x->parent_desc = event->xreparent.parent;
6883 x_real_positions (f, &f->left_pos, &f->top_pos);
6884
6885 /* Perhaps reparented due to a WM restart. Reset this. */
6886 FRAME_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->wm_type = X_WMTYPE_UNKNOWN;
6887 FRAME_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->net_supported_window = 0;
6888
6889 x_set_frame_alpha (f);
6890 }
6891 goto OTHER;
6892
6893 case Expose:
6894 f = x_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event->xexpose.window);
6895 if (f)
6896 {
6897 if (!FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f))
6898 {
6899 SET_FRAME_VISIBLE (f, 1);
6900 SET_FRAME_ICONIFIED (f, 0);
6901 f->output_data.x->has_been_visible = 1;
6902 SET_FRAME_GARBAGED (f);
6903 }
6904 else
6905 {
6906 #ifdef USE_GTK
6907 /* This seems to be needed for GTK 2.6 and later, see
6908 http://debbugs.gnu.org/cgi/bugreport.cgi?bug=15398. */
6909 x_clear_area (event->xexpose.display,
6910 event->xexpose.window,
6911 event->xexpose.x, event->xexpose.y,
6912 event->xexpose.width, event->xexpose.height);
6913 #endif
6914 expose_frame (f, event->xexpose.x, event->xexpose.y,
6915 event->xexpose.width, event->xexpose.height);
6916 }
6917 }
6918 else
6919 {
6920 #ifndef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
6921 struct scroll_bar *bar;
6922 #endif
6923 #if defined USE_LUCID
6924 /* Submenus of the Lucid menu bar aren't widgets
6925 themselves, so there's no way to dispatch events
6926 to them. Recognize this case separately. */
6927 {
6928 Widget widget = x_window_to_menu_bar (event->xexpose.window);
6929 if (widget)
6930 xlwmenu_redisplay (widget);
6931 }
6932 #endif /* USE_LUCID */
6933
6934 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
6935 /* Dispatch event to the widget. */
6936 goto OTHER;
6937 #else /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
6938 bar = x_window_to_scroll_bar (event->xexpose.display,
6939 event->xexpose.window, 2);
6940
6941 if (bar)
6942 x_scroll_bar_expose (bar, event);
6943 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
6944 else
6945 goto OTHER;
6946 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
6947 #endif /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
6948 }
6949 break;
6950
6951 case GraphicsExpose: /* This occurs when an XCopyArea's
6952 source area was obscured or not
6953 available. */
6954 f = x_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event->xgraphicsexpose.drawable);
6955 if (f)
6956 expose_frame (f, event->xgraphicsexpose.x,
6957 event->xgraphicsexpose.y,
6958 event->xgraphicsexpose.width,
6959 event->xgraphicsexpose.height);
6960 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
6961 else
6962 goto OTHER;
6963 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
6964 break;
6965
6966 case NoExpose: /* This occurs when an XCopyArea's
6967 source area was completely
6968 available. */
6969 break;
6970
6971 case UnmapNotify:
6972 /* Redo the mouse-highlight after the tooltip has gone. */
6973 if (event->xunmap.window == tip_window)
6974 {
6975 tip_window = 0;
6976 x_redo_mouse_highlight (dpyinfo);
6977 }
6978
6979 f = x_top_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event->xunmap.window);
6980 if (f) /* F may no longer exist if
6981 the frame was deleted. */
6982 {
6983 bool visible = FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f);
6984 /* While a frame is unmapped, display generation is
6985 disabled; you don't want to spend time updating a
6986 display that won't ever be seen. */
6987 SET_FRAME_VISIBLE (f, 0);
6988 /* We can't distinguish, from the event, whether the window
6989 has become iconified or invisible. So assume, if it
6990 was previously visible, than now it is iconified.
6991 But x_make_frame_invisible clears both
6992 the visible flag and the iconified flag;
6993 and that way, we know the window is not iconified now. */
6994 if (visible || FRAME_ICONIFIED_P (f))
6995 {
6996 SET_FRAME_ICONIFIED (f, 1);
6997 inev.ie.kind = ICONIFY_EVENT;
6998 XSETFRAME (inev.ie.frame_or_window, f);
6999 }
7000 }
7001 goto OTHER;
7002
7003 case MapNotify:
7004 if (event->xmap.window == tip_window)
7005 /* The tooltip has been drawn already. Avoid
7006 the SET_FRAME_GARBAGED below. */
7007 goto OTHER;
7008
7009 /* We use x_top_window_to_frame because map events can
7010 come for sub-windows and they don't mean that the
7011 frame is visible. */
7012 f = x_top_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event->xmap.window);
7013 if (f)
7014 {
7015 bool iconified = FRAME_ICONIFIED_P (f);
7016
7017 /* Check if fullscreen was specified before we where mapped the
7018 first time, i.e. from the command line. */
7019 if (!f->output_data.x->has_been_visible)
7020 x_check_fullscreen (f);
7021
7022 SET_FRAME_VISIBLE (f, 1);
7023 SET_FRAME_ICONIFIED (f, 0);
7024 f->output_data.x->has_been_visible = 1;
7025
7026 if (iconified)
7027 {
7028 inev.ie.kind = DEICONIFY_EVENT;
7029 XSETFRAME (inev.ie.frame_or_window, f);
7030 }
7031 else if (! NILP (Vframe_list) && ! NILP (XCDR (Vframe_list)))
7032 /* Force a redisplay sooner or later to update the
7033 frame titles in case this is the second frame. */
7034 record_asynch_buffer_change ();
7035
7036 #ifdef USE_GTK
7037 xg_frame_resized (f, -1, -1);
7038 #endif
7039 }
7040 goto OTHER;
7041
7042 case KeyPress:
7043
7044 dpyinfo->last_user_time = event->xkey.time;
7045 ignore_next_mouse_click_timeout = 0;
7046
7047 #if defined (USE_X_TOOLKIT) || defined (USE_GTK)
7048 /* Dispatch KeyPress events when in menu. */
7049 if (popup_activated ())
7050 goto OTHER;
7051 #endif
7052
7053 f = any;
7054
7055 #if ! defined (USE_GTK)
7056 /* If mouse-highlight is an integer, input clears out
7057 mouse highlighting. */
7058 if (!hlinfo->mouse_face_hidden && INTEGERP (Vmouse_highlight)
7059 && (f == 0
7060 || !EQ (f->tool_bar_window, hlinfo->mouse_face_window)))
7061 {
7062 clear_mouse_face (hlinfo);
7063 hlinfo->mouse_face_hidden = 1;
7064 }
7065 #endif
7066
7067 #if defined USE_MOTIF && defined USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
7068 if (f == 0)
7069 {
7070 /* Scroll bars consume key events, but we want
7071 the keys to go to the scroll bar's frame. */
7072 Widget widget = XtWindowToWidget (dpyinfo->display,
7073 event->xkey.window);
7074 if (widget && XmIsScrollBar (widget))
7075 {
7076 widget = XtParent (widget);
7077 f = x_any_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, XtWindow (widget));
7078 }
7079 }
7080 #endif /* USE_MOTIF and USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
7081
7082 if (f != 0)
7083 {
7084 KeySym keysym, orig_keysym;
7085 /* al%imercury@uunet.uu.net says that making this 81
7086 instead of 80 fixed a bug whereby meta chars made
7087 his Emacs hang.
7088
7089 It seems that some version of XmbLookupString has
7090 a bug of not returning XBufferOverflow in
7091 status_return even if the input is too long to
7092 fit in 81 bytes. So, we must prepare sufficient
7093 bytes for copy_buffer. 513 bytes (256 chars for
7094 two-byte character set) seems to be a fairly good
7095 approximation. -- 2000.8.10 handa@etl.go.jp */
7096 unsigned char copy_buffer[513];
7097 unsigned char *copy_bufptr = copy_buffer;
7098 int copy_bufsiz = sizeof (copy_buffer);
7099 int modifiers;
7100 Lisp_Object coding_system = Qlatin_1;
7101 Lisp_Object c;
7102 /* Event will be modified. */
7103 XKeyEvent xkey = event->xkey;
7104
7105 #ifdef USE_GTK
7106 /* Don't pass keys to GTK. A Tab will shift focus to the
7107 tool bar in GTK 2.4. Keys will still go to menus and
7108 dialogs because in that case popup_activated is nonzero
7109 (see above). */
7110 *finish = X_EVENT_DROP;
7111 #endif
7112
7113 xkey.state |= x_emacs_to_x_modifiers (FRAME_DISPLAY_INFO (f),
7114 extra_keyboard_modifiers);
7115 modifiers = xkey.state;
7116
7117 /* This will have to go some day... */
7118
7119 /* make_lispy_event turns chars into control chars.
7120 Don't do it here because XLookupString is too eager. */
7121 xkey.state &= ~ControlMask;
7122 xkey.state &= ~(dpyinfo->meta_mod_mask
7123 | dpyinfo->super_mod_mask
7124 | dpyinfo->hyper_mod_mask
7125 | dpyinfo->alt_mod_mask);
7126
7127 /* In case Meta is ComposeCharacter,
7128 clear its status. According to Markus Ehrnsperger
7129 Markus.Ehrnsperger@lehrstuhl-bross.physik.uni-muenchen.de
7130 this enables ComposeCharacter to work whether or
7131 not it is combined with Meta. */
7132 if (modifiers & dpyinfo->meta_mod_mask)
7133 memset (&compose_status, 0, sizeof (compose_status));
7134
7135 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
7136 if (FRAME_XIC (f))
7137 {
7138 Status status_return;
7139
7140 coding_system = Vlocale_coding_system;
7141 nbytes = XmbLookupString (FRAME_XIC (f),
7142 &xkey, (char *) copy_bufptr,
7143 copy_bufsiz, &keysym,
7144 &status_return);
7145 if (status_return == XBufferOverflow)
7146 {
7147 copy_bufsiz = nbytes + 1;
7148 copy_bufptr = alloca (copy_bufsiz);
7149 nbytes = XmbLookupString (FRAME_XIC (f),
7150 &xkey, (char *) copy_bufptr,
7151 copy_bufsiz, &keysym,
7152 &status_return);
7153 }
7154 /* Xutf8LookupString is a new but already deprecated interface. -stef */
7155 if (status_return == XLookupNone)
7156 break;
7157 else if (status_return == XLookupChars)
7158 {
7159 keysym = NoSymbol;
7160 modifiers = 0;
7161 }
7162 else if (status_return != XLookupKeySym
7163 && status_return != XLookupBoth)
7164 emacs_abort ();
7165 }
7166 else
7167 nbytes = XLookupString (&xkey, (char *) copy_bufptr,
7168 copy_bufsiz, &keysym,
7169 &compose_status);
7170 #else
7171 nbytes = XLookupString (&xkey, (char *) copy_bufptr,
7172 copy_bufsiz, &keysym,
7173 &compose_status);
7174 #endif
7175
7176 /* If not using XIM/XIC, and a compose sequence is in progress,
7177 we break here. Otherwise, chars_matched is always 0. */
7178 if (compose_status.chars_matched > 0 && nbytes == 0)
7179 break;
7180
7181 memset (&compose_status, 0, sizeof (compose_status));
7182 orig_keysym = keysym;
7183
7184 /* Common for all keysym input events. */
7185 XSETFRAME (inev.ie.frame_or_window, f);
7186 inev.ie.modifiers
7187 = x_x_to_emacs_modifiers (FRAME_DISPLAY_INFO (f), modifiers);
7188 inev.ie.timestamp = xkey.time;
7189
7190 /* First deal with keysyms which have defined
7191 translations to characters. */
7192 if (keysym >= 32 && keysym < 128)
7193 /* Avoid explicitly decoding each ASCII character. */
7194 {
7195 inev.ie.kind = ASCII_KEYSTROKE_EVENT;
7196 inev.ie.code = keysym;
7197 goto done_keysym;
7198 }
7199
7200 /* Keysyms directly mapped to Unicode characters. */
7201 if (keysym >= 0x01000000 && keysym <= 0x0110FFFF)
7202 {
7203 if (keysym < 0x01000080)
7204 inev.ie.kind = ASCII_KEYSTROKE_EVENT;
7205 else
7206 inev.ie.kind = MULTIBYTE_CHAR_KEYSTROKE_EVENT;
7207 inev.ie.code = keysym & 0xFFFFFF;
7208 goto done_keysym;
7209 }
7210
7211 /* Now non-ASCII. */
7212 if (HASH_TABLE_P (Vx_keysym_table)
7213 && (c = Fgethash (make_number (keysym),
7214 Vx_keysym_table,
7215 Qnil),
7216 NATNUMP (c)))
7217 {
7218 inev.ie.kind = (SINGLE_BYTE_CHAR_P (XFASTINT (c))
7219 ? ASCII_KEYSTROKE_EVENT
7220 : MULTIBYTE_CHAR_KEYSTROKE_EVENT);
7221 inev.ie.code = XFASTINT (c);
7222 goto done_keysym;
7223 }
7224
7225 /* Random non-modifier sorts of keysyms. */
7226 if (((keysym >= XK_BackSpace && keysym <= XK_Escape)
7227 || keysym == XK_Delete
7228 #ifdef XK_ISO_Left_Tab
7229 || (keysym >= XK_ISO_Left_Tab
7230 && keysym <= XK_ISO_Enter)
7231 #endif
7232 || IsCursorKey (keysym) /* 0xff50 <= x < 0xff60 */
7233 || IsMiscFunctionKey (keysym) /* 0xff60 <= x < VARIES */
7234 #ifdef HPUX
7235 /* This recognizes the "extended function
7236 keys". It seems there's no cleaner way.
7237 Test IsModifierKey to avoid handling
7238 mode_switch incorrectly. */
7239 || (XK_Select <= keysym && keysym < XK_KP_Space)
7240 #endif
7241 #ifdef XK_dead_circumflex
7242 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_circumflex
7243 #endif
7244 #ifdef XK_dead_grave
7245 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_grave
7246 #endif
7247 #ifdef XK_dead_tilde
7248 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_tilde
7249 #endif
7250 #ifdef XK_dead_diaeresis
7251 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_diaeresis
7252 #endif
7253 #ifdef XK_dead_macron
7254 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_macron
7255 #endif
7256 #ifdef XK_dead_degree
7257 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_degree
7258 #endif
7259 #ifdef XK_dead_acute
7260 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_acute
7261 #endif
7262 #ifdef XK_dead_cedilla
7263 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_cedilla
7264 #endif
7265 #ifdef XK_dead_breve
7266 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_breve
7267 #endif
7268 #ifdef XK_dead_ogonek
7269 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_ogonek
7270 #endif
7271 #ifdef XK_dead_caron
7272 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_caron
7273 #endif
7274 #ifdef XK_dead_doubleacute
7275 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_doubleacute
7276 #endif
7277 #ifdef XK_dead_abovedot
7278 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_abovedot
7279 #endif
7280 || IsKeypadKey (keysym) /* 0xff80 <= x < 0xffbe */
7281 || IsFunctionKey (keysym) /* 0xffbe <= x < 0xffe1 */
7282 /* Any "vendor-specific" key is ok. */
7283 || (orig_keysym & (1 << 28))
7284 || (keysym != NoSymbol && nbytes == 0))
7285 && ! (IsModifierKey (orig_keysym)
7286 /* The symbols from XK_ISO_Lock
7287 to XK_ISO_Last_Group_Lock
7288 don't have real modifiers but
7289 should be treated similarly to
7290 Mode_switch by Emacs. */
7291 #if defined XK_ISO_Lock && defined XK_ISO_Last_Group_Lock
7292 || (XK_ISO_Lock <= orig_keysym
7293 && orig_keysym <= XK_ISO_Last_Group_Lock)
7294 #endif
7295 ))
7296 {
7297 STORE_KEYSYM_FOR_DEBUG (keysym);
7298 /* make_lispy_event will convert this to a symbolic
7299 key. */
7300 inev.ie.kind = NON_ASCII_KEYSTROKE_EVENT;
7301 inev.ie.code = keysym;
7302 goto done_keysym;
7303 }
7304
7305 { /* Raw bytes, not keysym. */
7306 ptrdiff_t i;
7307 int nchars, len;
7308
7309 for (i = 0, nchars = 0; i < nbytes; i++)
7310 {
7311 if (ASCII_CHAR_P (copy_bufptr[i]))
7312 nchars++;
7313 STORE_KEYSYM_FOR_DEBUG (copy_bufptr[i]);
7314 }
7315
7316 if (nchars < nbytes)
7317 {
7318 /* Decode the input data. */
7319
7320 /* The input should be decoded with `coding_system'
7321 which depends on which X*LookupString function
7322 we used just above and the locale. */
7323 setup_coding_system (coding_system, &coding);
7324 coding.src_multibyte = 0;
7325 coding.dst_multibyte = 1;
7326 /* The input is converted to events, thus we can't
7327 handle composition. Anyway, there's no XIM that
7328 gives us composition information. */
7329 coding.common_flags &= ~CODING_ANNOTATION_MASK;
7330
7331 SAFE_NALLOCA (coding.destination, MAX_MULTIBYTE_LENGTH,
7332 nbytes);
7333 coding.dst_bytes = MAX_MULTIBYTE_LENGTH * nbytes;
7334 coding.mode |= CODING_MODE_LAST_BLOCK;
7335 decode_coding_c_string (&coding, copy_bufptr, nbytes, Qnil);
7336 nbytes = coding.produced;
7337 nchars = coding.produced_char;
7338 copy_bufptr = coding.destination;
7339 }
7340
7341 /* Convert the input data to a sequence of
7342 character events. */
7343 for (i = 0; i < nbytes; i += len)
7344 {
7345 int ch;
7346 if (nchars == nbytes)
7347 ch = copy_bufptr[i], len = 1;
7348 else
7349 ch = STRING_CHAR_AND_LENGTH (copy_bufptr + i, len);
7350 inev.ie.kind = (SINGLE_BYTE_CHAR_P (ch)
7351 ? ASCII_KEYSTROKE_EVENT
7352 : MULTIBYTE_CHAR_KEYSTROKE_EVENT);
7353 inev.ie.code = ch;
7354 kbd_buffer_store_event_hold (&inev.ie, hold_quit);
7355 }
7356
7357 count += nchars;
7358
7359 inev.ie.kind = NO_EVENT; /* Already stored above. */
7360
7361 if (keysym == NoSymbol)
7362 break;
7363 }
7364 /* FIXME: check side effects and remove this. */
7365 ((XEvent *) event)->xkey = xkey;
7366 }
7367 done_keysym:
7368 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
7369 /* Don't dispatch this event since XtDispatchEvent calls
7370 XFilterEvent, and two calls in a row may freeze the
7371 client. */
7372 break;
7373 #else
7374 goto OTHER;
7375 #endif
7376
7377 case KeyRelease:
7378 dpyinfo->last_user_time = event->xkey.time;
7379 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
7380 /* Don't dispatch this event since XtDispatchEvent calls
7381 XFilterEvent, and two calls in a row may freeze the
7382 client. */
7383 break;
7384 #else
7385 goto OTHER;
7386 #endif
7387
7388 case EnterNotify:
7389 dpyinfo->last_user_time = event->xcrossing.time;
7390 x_detect_focus_change (dpyinfo, any, event, &inev.ie);
7391
7392 f = any;
7393
7394 if (f && x_mouse_click_focus_ignore_position)
7395 ignore_next_mouse_click_timeout = event->xmotion.time + 200;
7396
7397 /* EnterNotify counts as mouse movement,
7398 so update things that depend on mouse position. */
7399 if (f && !f->output_data.x->hourglass_p)
7400 note_mouse_movement (f, &event->xmotion);
7401 #ifdef USE_GTK
7402 /* We may get an EnterNotify on the buttons in the toolbar. In that
7403 case we moved out of any highlighted area and need to note this. */
7404 if (!f && dpyinfo->last_mouse_glyph_frame)
7405 note_mouse_movement (dpyinfo->last_mouse_glyph_frame, &event->xmotion);
7406 #endif
7407 goto OTHER;
7408
7409 case FocusIn:
7410 x_detect_focus_change (dpyinfo, any, event, &inev.ie);
7411 goto OTHER;
7412
7413 case LeaveNotify:
7414 dpyinfo->last_user_time = event->xcrossing.time;
7415 x_detect_focus_change (dpyinfo, any, event, &inev.ie);
7416
7417 f = x_top_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event->xcrossing.window);
7418 if (f)
7419 {
7420 if (f == hlinfo->mouse_face_mouse_frame)
7421 {
7422 /* If we move outside the frame, then we're
7423 certainly no longer on any text in the frame. */
7424 clear_mouse_face (hlinfo);
7425 hlinfo->mouse_face_mouse_frame = 0;
7426 }
7427
7428 /* Generate a nil HELP_EVENT to cancel a help-echo.
7429 Do it only if there's something to cancel.
7430 Otherwise, the startup message is cleared when
7431 the mouse leaves the frame. */
7432 if (any_help_event_p)
7433 do_help = -1;
7434 }
7435 #ifdef USE_GTK
7436 /* See comment in EnterNotify above */
7437 else if (dpyinfo->last_mouse_glyph_frame)
7438 note_mouse_movement (dpyinfo->last_mouse_glyph_frame, &event->xmotion);
7439 #endif
7440 goto OTHER;
7441
7442 case FocusOut:
7443 x_detect_focus_change (dpyinfo, any, event, &inev.ie);
7444 goto OTHER;
7445
7446 case MotionNotify:
7447 {
7448 dpyinfo->last_user_time = event->xmotion.time;
7449 previous_help_echo_string = help_echo_string;
7450 help_echo_string = Qnil;
7451
7452 f = (x_mouse_grabbed (dpyinfo) ? dpyinfo->last_mouse_frame
7453 : x_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event->xmotion.window));
7454
7455 if (hlinfo->mouse_face_hidden)
7456 {
7457 hlinfo->mouse_face_hidden = 0;
7458 clear_mouse_face (hlinfo);
7459 }
7460
7461 #ifdef USE_GTK
7462 if (f && xg_event_is_for_scrollbar (f, event))
7463 f = 0;
7464 #endif
7465 if (f)
7466 {
7467
7468 /* Generate SELECT_WINDOW_EVENTs when needed.
7469 Don't let popup menus influence things (bug#1261). */
7470 if (!NILP (Vmouse_autoselect_window) && !popup_activated ())
7471 {
7472 static Lisp_Object last_mouse_window;
7473 Lisp_Object window = window_from_coordinates
7474 (f, event->xmotion.x, event->xmotion.y, 0, 0);
7475
7476 /* Window will be selected only when it is not selected now and
7477 last mouse movement event was not in it. Minibuffer window
7478 will be selected only when it is active. */
7479 if (WINDOWP (window)
7480 && !EQ (window, last_mouse_window)
7481 && !EQ (window, selected_window)
7482 /* For click-to-focus window managers
7483 create event iff we don't leave the
7484 selected frame. */
7485 && (focus_follows_mouse
7486 || (EQ (XWINDOW (window)->frame,
7487 XWINDOW (selected_window)->frame))))
7488 {
7489 inev.ie.kind = SELECT_WINDOW_EVENT;
7490 inev.ie.frame_or_window = window;
7491 }
7492 /* Remember the last window where we saw the mouse. */
7493 last_mouse_window = window;
7494 }
7495 if (!note_mouse_movement (f, &event->xmotion))
7496 help_echo_string = previous_help_echo_string;
7497 }
7498 else
7499 {
7500 #ifndef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
7501 struct scroll_bar *bar
7502 = x_window_to_scroll_bar (event->xmotion.display,
7503 event->xmotion.window, 2);
7504
7505 if (bar)
7506 x_scroll_bar_note_movement (bar, &event->xmotion);
7507 #endif /* USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
7508
7509 /* If we move outside the frame, then we're
7510 certainly no longer on any text in the frame. */
7511 clear_mouse_face (hlinfo);
7512 }
7513
7514 /* If the contents of the global variable help_echo_string
7515 has changed, generate a HELP_EVENT. */
7516 if (!NILP (help_echo_string)
7517 || !NILP (previous_help_echo_string))
7518 do_help = 1;
7519 goto OTHER;
7520 }
7521
7522 case ConfigureNotify:
7523 f = x_top_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event->xconfigure.window);
7524 #ifdef USE_GTK
7525 if (!f
7526 && (f = any)
7527 && event->xconfigure.window == FRAME_X_WINDOW (f))
7528 {
7529 xg_frame_resized (f, event->xconfigure.width,
7530 event->xconfigure.height);
7531 f = 0;
7532 }
7533 #endif
7534 if (f)
7535 {
7536 x_net_wm_state (f, event->xconfigure.window);
7537
7538 #ifndef USE_X_TOOLKIT
7539 #ifndef USE_GTK
7540 int width = FRAME_PIXEL_TO_TEXT_WIDTH (f, event->xconfigure.width);
7541 int height = FRAME_PIXEL_TO_TEXT_HEIGHT (f, event->xconfigure.height);
7542
7543 /* In the toolkit version, change_frame_size
7544 is called by the code that handles resizing
7545 of the EmacsFrame widget. */
7546
7547 /* Even if the number of character rows and columns has
7548 not changed, the font size may have changed, so we need
7549 to check the pixel dimensions as well. */
7550 if (width != FRAME_TEXT_WIDTH (f)
7551 || height != FRAME_TEXT_HEIGHT (f)
7552 || event->xconfigure.width != FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f)
7553 || event->xconfigure.height != FRAME_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f))
7554 {
7555 change_frame_size (f, width, height, 0, 1, 0, 1);
7556 x_clear_under_internal_border (f);
7557 SET_FRAME_GARBAGED (f);
7558 cancel_mouse_face (f);
7559 }
7560
7561 /** FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f) = event->xconfigure.width; **/
7562 /** FRAME_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f) = event->xconfigure.height; **/
7563 #endif /* not USE_GTK */
7564 #endif
7565
7566 #ifdef USE_GTK
7567 /* GTK creates windows but doesn't map them.
7568 Only get real positions when mapped. */
7569 if (FRAME_GTK_OUTER_WIDGET (f)
7570 && gtk_widget_get_mapped (FRAME_GTK_OUTER_WIDGET (f)))
7571 #endif
7572 x_real_positions (f, &f->left_pos, &f->top_pos);
7573
7574 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
7575 if (FRAME_XIC (f) && (FRAME_XIC_STYLE (f) & XIMStatusArea))
7576 xic_set_statusarea (f);
7577 #endif
7578
7579 }
7580 goto OTHER;
7581
7582 case ButtonRelease:
7583 case ButtonPress:
7584 {
7585 /* If we decide we want to generate an event to be seen
7586 by the rest of Emacs, we put it here. */
7587 bool tool_bar_p = 0;
7588
7589 memset (&compose_status, 0, sizeof (compose_status));
7590 dpyinfo->last_mouse_glyph_frame = NULL;
7591 dpyinfo->last_user_time = event->xbutton.time;
7592
7593 f = (x_mouse_grabbed (dpyinfo) ? dpyinfo->last_mouse_frame
7594 : x_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event->xbutton.window));
7595
7596 #ifdef USE_GTK
7597 if (f && xg_event_is_for_scrollbar (f, event))
7598 f = 0;
7599 #endif
7600 if (f)
7601 {
7602 #if ! defined (USE_GTK)
7603 /* Is this in the tool-bar? */
7604 if (WINDOWP (f->tool_bar_window)
7605 && WINDOW_TOTAL_LINES (XWINDOW (f->tool_bar_window)))
7606 {
7607 Lisp_Object window;
7608 int x = event->xbutton.x;
7609 int y = event->xbutton.y;
7610
7611 window = window_from_coordinates (f, x, y, 0, 1);
7612 tool_bar_p = EQ (window, f->tool_bar_window);
7613
7614 if (tool_bar_p && event->xbutton.button < 4)
7615 handle_tool_bar_click
7616 (f, x, y, event->xbutton.type == ButtonPress,
7617 x_x_to_emacs_modifiers (dpyinfo, event->xbutton.state));
7618 }
7619 #endif /* !USE_GTK */
7620
7621 if (!tool_bar_p)
7622 #if defined (USE_X_TOOLKIT) || defined (USE_GTK)
7623 if (! popup_activated ())
7624 #endif
7625 {
7626 if (ignore_next_mouse_click_timeout)
7627 {
7628 if (event->type == ButtonPress
7629 && event->xbutton.time > ignore_next_mouse_click_timeout)
7630 {
7631 ignore_next_mouse_click_timeout = 0;
7632 construct_mouse_click (&inev.ie, &event->xbutton, f);
7633 }
7634 if (event->type == ButtonRelease)
7635 ignore_next_mouse_click_timeout = 0;
7636 }
7637 else
7638 construct_mouse_click (&inev.ie, &event->xbutton, f);
7639 }
7640 if (FRAME_X_EMBEDDED_P (f))
7641 xembed_send_message (f, event->xbutton.time,
7642 XEMBED_REQUEST_FOCUS, 0, 0, 0);
7643 }
7644 else
7645 {
7646 struct scroll_bar *bar
7647 = x_window_to_scroll_bar (event->xbutton.display,
7648 event->xbutton.window, 2);
7649
7650 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
7651 /* Make the "Ctrl-Mouse-2 splits window" work for toolkit
7652 scroll bars. */
7653 if (bar && event->xbutton.state & ControlMask)
7654 {
7655 x_scroll_bar_handle_click (bar, event, &inev.ie);
7656 *finish = X_EVENT_DROP;
7657 }
7658 #else /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
7659 if (bar)
7660 x_scroll_bar_handle_click (bar, event, &inev.ie);
7661 #endif /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
7662 }
7663
7664 if (event->type == ButtonPress)
7665 {
7666 dpyinfo->grabbed |= (1 << event->xbutton.button);
7667 dpyinfo->last_mouse_frame = f;
7668 #if ! defined (USE_GTK)
7669 if (f && !tool_bar_p)
7670 f->last_tool_bar_item = -1;
7671 #endif /* not USE_GTK */
7672 }
7673 else
7674 dpyinfo->grabbed &= ~(1 << event->xbutton.button);
7675
7676 /* Ignore any mouse motion that happened before this event;
7677 any subsequent mouse-movement Emacs events should reflect
7678 only motion after the ButtonPress/Release. */
7679 if (f != 0)
7680 f->mouse_moved = 0;
7681
7682 #if defined (USE_X_TOOLKIT) || defined (USE_GTK)
7683 f = x_menubar_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event);
7684 /* For a down-event in the menu bar,
7685 don't pass it to Xt right now.
7686 Instead, save it away
7687 and we will pass it to Xt from kbd_buffer_get_event.
7688 That way, we can run some Lisp code first. */
7689 if (! popup_activated ()
7690 #ifdef USE_GTK
7691 /* Gtk+ menus only react to the first three buttons. */
7692 && event->xbutton.button < 3
7693 #endif
7694 && f && event->type == ButtonPress
7695 /* Verify the event is really within the menu bar
7696 and not just sent to it due to grabbing. */
7697 && event->xbutton.x >= 0
7698 && event->xbutton.x < FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f)
7699 && event->xbutton.y >= 0
7700 && event->xbutton.y < FRAME_MENUBAR_HEIGHT (f)
7701 && event->xbutton.same_screen)
7702 {
7703 if (!f->output_data.x->saved_menu_event)
7704 f->output_data.x->saved_menu_event = xmalloc (sizeof *event);
7705 *f->output_data.x->saved_menu_event = *event;
7706 inev.ie.kind = MENU_BAR_ACTIVATE_EVENT;
7707 XSETFRAME (inev.ie.frame_or_window, f);
7708 *finish = X_EVENT_DROP;
7709 }
7710 else
7711 goto OTHER;
7712 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT || USE_GTK */
7713 }
7714 break;
7715
7716 case CirculateNotify:
7717 goto OTHER;
7718
7719 case CirculateRequest:
7720 goto OTHER;
7721
7722 case VisibilityNotify:
7723 goto OTHER;
7724
7725 case MappingNotify:
7726 /* Someone has changed the keyboard mapping - update the
7727 local cache. */
7728 switch (event->xmapping.request)
7729 {
7730 case MappingModifier:
7731 x_find_modifier_meanings (dpyinfo);
7732 /* This is meant to fall through. */
7733 case MappingKeyboard:
7734 XRefreshKeyboardMapping ((XMappingEvent *) &event->xmapping);
7735 }
7736 goto OTHER;
7737
7738 case DestroyNotify:
7739 xft_settings_event (dpyinfo, event);
7740 break;
7741
7742 default:
7743 OTHER:
7744 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
7745 block_input ();
7746 if (*finish != X_EVENT_DROP)
7747 XtDispatchEvent ((XEvent *) event);
7748 unblock_input ();
7749 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
7750 break;
7751 }
7752
7753 done:
7754 if (inev.ie.kind != NO_EVENT)
7755 {
7756 kbd_buffer_store_event_hold (&inev.ie, hold_quit);
7757 count++;
7758 }
7759
7760 if (do_help
7761 && !(hold_quit && hold_quit->kind != NO_EVENT))
7762 {
7763 Lisp_Object frame;
7764
7765 if (f)
7766 XSETFRAME (frame, f);
7767 else
7768 frame = Qnil;
7769
7770 if (do_help > 0)
7771 {
7772 any_help_event_p = 1;
7773 gen_help_event (help_echo_string, frame, help_echo_window,
7774 help_echo_object, help_echo_pos);
7775 }
7776 else
7777 {
7778 help_echo_string = Qnil;
7779 gen_help_event (Qnil, frame, Qnil, Qnil, 0);
7780 }
7781 count++;
7782 }
7783
7784 SAFE_FREE ();
7785 return count;
7786 }
7787
7788 /* Handles the XEvent EVENT on display DISPLAY.
7789 This is used for event loops outside the normal event handling,
7790 i.e. looping while a popup menu or a dialog is posted.
7791
7792 Returns the value handle_one_xevent sets in the finish argument. */
7793 int
7794 x_dispatch_event (XEvent *event, Display *display)
7795 {
7796 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
7797 int finish = X_EVENT_NORMAL;
7798
7799 dpyinfo = x_display_info_for_display (display);
7800
7801 if (dpyinfo)
7802 handle_one_xevent (dpyinfo, event, &finish, 0);
7803
7804 return finish;
7805 }
7806
7807 /* Read events coming from the X server.
7808 Return as soon as there are no more events to be read.
7809
7810 Return the number of characters stored into the buffer,
7811 thus pretending to be `read' (except the characters we store
7812 in the keyboard buffer can be multibyte, so are not necessarily
7813 C chars). */
7814
7815 static int
7816 XTread_socket (struct terminal *terminal, struct input_event *hold_quit)
7817 {
7818 int count = 0;
7819 int event_found = 0;
7820 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = terminal->display_info.x;
7821
7822 block_input ();
7823
7824 /* For debugging, this gives a way to fake an I/O error. */
7825 if (dpyinfo == XTread_socket_fake_io_error)
7826 {
7827 XTread_socket_fake_io_error = 0;
7828 x_io_error_quitter (dpyinfo->display);
7829 }
7830
7831 #ifndef USE_GTK
7832 while (XPending (dpyinfo->display))
7833 {
7834 int finish;
7835 XEvent event;
7836
7837 XNextEvent (dpyinfo->display, &event);
7838
7839 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
7840 /* Filter events for the current X input method. */
7841 if (x_filter_event (dpyinfo, &event))
7842 continue;
7843 #endif
7844 event_found = 1;
7845
7846 count += handle_one_xevent (dpyinfo, &event, &finish, hold_quit);
7847
7848 if (finish == X_EVENT_GOTO_OUT)
7849 break;
7850 }
7851
7852 #else /* USE_GTK */
7853
7854 /* For GTK we must use the GTK event loop. But XEvents gets passed
7855 to our filter function above, and then to the big event switch.
7856 We use a bunch of globals to communicate with our filter function,
7857 that is kind of ugly, but it works.
7858
7859 There is no way to do one display at the time, GTK just does events
7860 from all displays. */
7861
7862 while (gtk_events_pending ())
7863 {
7864 current_count = count;
7865 current_hold_quit = hold_quit;
7866
7867 gtk_main_iteration ();
7868
7869 count = current_count;
7870 current_count = -1;
7871 current_hold_quit = 0;
7872
7873 if (current_finish == X_EVENT_GOTO_OUT)
7874 break;
7875 }
7876 #endif /* USE_GTK */
7877
7878 /* On some systems, an X bug causes Emacs to get no more events
7879 when the window is destroyed. Detect that. (1994.) */
7880 if (! event_found)
7881 {
7882 /* Emacs and the X Server eats up CPU time if XNoOp is done every time.
7883 One XNOOP in 100 loops will make Emacs terminate.
7884 B. Bretthauer, 1994 */
7885 x_noop_count++;
7886 if (x_noop_count >= 100)
7887 {
7888 x_noop_count=0;
7889
7890 if (next_noop_dpyinfo == 0)
7891 next_noop_dpyinfo = x_display_list;
7892
7893 XNoOp (next_noop_dpyinfo->display);
7894
7895 /* Each time we get here, cycle through the displays now open. */
7896 next_noop_dpyinfo = next_noop_dpyinfo->next;
7897 }
7898 }
7899
7900 /* If the focus was just given to an auto-raising frame,
7901 raise it now. FIXME: handle more than one such frame. */
7902 if (dpyinfo->x_pending_autoraise_frame)
7903 {
7904 x_raise_frame (dpyinfo->x_pending_autoraise_frame);
7905 dpyinfo->x_pending_autoraise_frame = NULL;
7906 }
7907
7908 unblock_input ();
7909
7910 return count;
7911 }
7912
7913
7914
7915 \f
7916 /***********************************************************************
7917 Text Cursor
7918 ***********************************************************************/
7919
7920 /* Set clipping for output in glyph row ROW. W is the window in which
7921 we operate. GC is the graphics context to set clipping in.
7922
7923 ROW may be a text row or, e.g., a mode line. Text rows must be
7924 clipped to the interior of the window dedicated to text display,
7925 mode lines must be clipped to the whole window. */
7926
7927 static void
7928 x_clip_to_row (struct window *w, struct glyph_row *row,
7929 enum glyph_row_area area, GC gc)
7930 {
7931 struct frame *f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (w));
7932 XRectangle clip_rect;
7933 int window_x, window_y, window_width;
7934
7935 window_box (w, area, &window_x, &window_y, &window_width, 0);
7936
7937 clip_rect.x = window_x;
7938 clip_rect.y = WINDOW_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_Y (w, max (0, row->y));
7939 clip_rect.y = max (clip_rect.y, window_y);
7940 clip_rect.width = window_width;
7941 clip_rect.height = row->visible_height;
7942
7943 XSetClipRectangles (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), gc, 0, 0, &clip_rect, 1, Unsorted);
7944 }
7945
7946
7947 /* Draw a hollow box cursor on window W in glyph row ROW. */
7948
7949 static void
7950 x_draw_hollow_cursor (struct window *w, struct glyph_row *row)
7951 {
7952 struct frame *f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (w));
7953 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
7954 Display *dpy = FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f);
7955 int x, y, wd, h;
7956 XGCValues xgcv;
7957 struct glyph *cursor_glyph;
7958 GC gc;
7959
7960 /* Get the glyph the cursor is on. If we can't tell because
7961 the current matrix is invalid or such, give up. */
7962 cursor_glyph = get_phys_cursor_glyph (w);
7963 if (cursor_glyph == NULL)
7964 return;
7965
7966 /* Compute frame-relative coordinates for phys cursor. */
7967 get_phys_cursor_geometry (w, row, cursor_glyph, &x, &y, &h);
7968 wd = w->phys_cursor_width;
7969
7970 /* The foreground of cursor_gc is typically the same as the normal
7971 background color, which can cause the cursor box to be invisible. */
7972 xgcv.foreground = f->output_data.x->cursor_pixel;
7973 if (dpyinfo->scratch_cursor_gc)
7974 XChangeGC (dpy, dpyinfo->scratch_cursor_gc, GCForeground, &xgcv);
7975 else
7976 dpyinfo->scratch_cursor_gc = XCreateGC (dpy, FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
7977 GCForeground, &xgcv);
7978 gc = dpyinfo->scratch_cursor_gc;
7979
7980 /* When on R2L character, show cursor at the right edge of the
7981 glyph, unless the cursor box is as wide as the glyph or wider
7982 (the latter happens when x-stretch-cursor is non-nil). */
7983 if ((cursor_glyph->resolved_level & 1) != 0
7984 && cursor_glyph->pixel_width > w->phys_cursor_width)
7985 {
7986 x += cursor_glyph->pixel_width - w->phys_cursor_width;
7987 wd -= 1;
7988 }
7989 /* Set clipping, draw the rectangle, and reset clipping again. */
7990 x_clip_to_row (w, row, TEXT_AREA, gc);
7991 XDrawRectangle (dpy, FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), gc, x, y, wd, h - 1);
7992 XSetClipMask (dpy, gc, None);
7993 }
7994
7995
7996 /* Draw a bar cursor on window W in glyph row ROW.
7997
7998 Implementation note: One would like to draw a bar cursor with an
7999 angle equal to the one given by the font property XA_ITALIC_ANGLE.
8000 Unfortunately, I didn't find a font yet that has this property set.
8001 --gerd. */
8002
8003 static void
8004 x_draw_bar_cursor (struct window *w, struct glyph_row *row, int width, enum text_cursor_kinds kind)
8005 {
8006 struct frame *f = XFRAME (w->frame);
8007 struct glyph *cursor_glyph;
8008
8009 /* If cursor is out of bounds, don't draw garbage. This can happen
8010 in mini-buffer windows when switching between echo area glyphs
8011 and mini-buffer. */
8012 cursor_glyph = get_phys_cursor_glyph (w);
8013 if (cursor_glyph == NULL)
8014 return;
8015
8016 /* If on an image, draw like a normal cursor. That's usually better
8017 visible than drawing a bar, esp. if the image is large so that
8018 the bar might not be in the window. */
8019 if (cursor_glyph->type == IMAGE_GLYPH)
8020 {
8021 struct glyph_row *r;
8022 r = MATRIX_ROW (w->current_matrix, w->phys_cursor.vpos);
8023 draw_phys_cursor_glyph (w, r, DRAW_CURSOR);
8024 }
8025 else
8026 {
8027 Display *dpy = FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f);
8028 Window window = FRAME_X_WINDOW (f);
8029 GC gc = FRAME_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->scratch_cursor_gc;
8030 unsigned long mask = GCForeground | GCBackground | GCGraphicsExposures;
8031 struct face *face = FACE_FROM_ID (f, cursor_glyph->face_id);
8032 XGCValues xgcv;
8033
8034 /* If the glyph's background equals the color we normally draw
8035 the bars cursor in, the bar cursor in its normal color is
8036 invisible. Use the glyph's foreground color instead in this
8037 case, on the assumption that the glyph's colors are chosen so
8038 that the glyph is legible. */
8039 if (face->background == f->output_data.x->cursor_pixel)
8040 xgcv.background = xgcv.foreground = face->foreground;
8041 else
8042 xgcv.background = xgcv.foreground = f->output_data.x->cursor_pixel;
8043 xgcv.graphics_exposures = 0;
8044
8045 if (gc)
8046 XChangeGC (dpy, gc, mask, &xgcv);
8047 else
8048 {
8049 gc = XCreateGC (dpy, window, mask, &xgcv);
8050 FRAME_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->scratch_cursor_gc = gc;
8051 }
8052
8053 x_clip_to_row (w, row, TEXT_AREA, gc);
8054
8055 if (kind == BAR_CURSOR)
8056 {
8057 int x = WINDOW_TEXT_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_X (w, w->phys_cursor.x);
8058
8059 if (width < 0)
8060 width = FRAME_CURSOR_WIDTH (f);
8061 width = min (cursor_glyph->pixel_width, width);
8062
8063 w->phys_cursor_width = width;
8064
8065 /* If the character under cursor is R2L, draw the bar cursor
8066 on the right of its glyph, rather than on the left. */
8067 if ((cursor_glyph->resolved_level & 1) != 0)
8068 x += cursor_glyph->pixel_width - width;
8069
8070 XFillRectangle (dpy, window, gc, x,
8071 WINDOW_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_Y (w, w->phys_cursor.y),
8072 width, row->height);
8073 }
8074 else /* HBAR_CURSOR */
8075 {
8076 int dummy_x, dummy_y, dummy_h;
8077 int x = WINDOW_TEXT_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_X (w, w->phys_cursor.x);
8078
8079 if (width < 0)
8080 width = row->height;
8081
8082 width = min (row->height, width);
8083
8084 get_phys_cursor_geometry (w, row, cursor_glyph, &dummy_x,
8085 &dummy_y, &dummy_h);
8086
8087 if ((cursor_glyph->resolved_level & 1) != 0
8088 && cursor_glyph->pixel_width > w->phys_cursor_width)
8089 x += cursor_glyph->pixel_width - w->phys_cursor_width;
8090 XFillRectangle (dpy, window, gc, x,
8091 WINDOW_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_Y (w, w->phys_cursor.y +
8092 row->height - width),
8093 w->phys_cursor_width, width);
8094 }
8095
8096 XSetClipMask (dpy, gc, None);
8097 }
8098 }
8099
8100
8101 /* RIF: Define cursor CURSOR on frame F. */
8102
8103 static void
8104 x_define_frame_cursor (struct frame *f, Cursor cursor)
8105 {
8106 if (!f->pointer_invisible
8107 && f->output_data.x->current_cursor != cursor)
8108 XDefineCursor (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), cursor);
8109 f->output_data.x->current_cursor = cursor;
8110 }
8111
8112
8113 /* RIF: Clear area on frame F. */
8114
8115 static void
8116 x_clear_frame_area (struct frame *f, int x, int y, int width, int height)
8117 {
8118 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), x, y, width, height);
8119 #ifdef USE_GTK
8120 /* Must queue a redraw, because scroll bars might have been cleared. */
8121 if (FRAME_GTK_WIDGET (f))
8122 gtk_widget_queue_draw (FRAME_GTK_WIDGET (f));
8123 #endif
8124 }
8125
8126
8127 /* RIF: Draw cursor on window W. */
8128
8129 static void
8130 x_draw_window_cursor (struct window *w, struct glyph_row *glyph_row, int x,
8131 int y, enum text_cursor_kinds cursor_type,
8132 int cursor_width, bool on_p, bool active_p)
8133 {
8134 struct frame *f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (w));
8135
8136 if (on_p)
8137 {
8138 w->phys_cursor_type = cursor_type;
8139 w->phys_cursor_on_p = 1;
8140
8141 if (glyph_row->exact_window_width_line_p
8142 && (glyph_row->reversed_p
8143 ? (w->phys_cursor.hpos < 0)
8144 : (w->phys_cursor.hpos >= glyph_row->used[TEXT_AREA])))
8145 {
8146 glyph_row->cursor_in_fringe_p = 1;
8147 draw_fringe_bitmap (w, glyph_row, glyph_row->reversed_p);
8148 }
8149 else
8150 {
8151 switch (cursor_type)
8152 {
8153 case HOLLOW_BOX_CURSOR:
8154 x_draw_hollow_cursor (w, glyph_row);
8155 break;
8156
8157 case FILLED_BOX_CURSOR:
8158 draw_phys_cursor_glyph (w, glyph_row, DRAW_CURSOR);
8159 break;
8160
8161 case BAR_CURSOR:
8162 x_draw_bar_cursor (w, glyph_row, cursor_width, BAR_CURSOR);
8163 break;
8164
8165 case HBAR_CURSOR:
8166 x_draw_bar_cursor (w, glyph_row, cursor_width, HBAR_CURSOR);
8167 break;
8168
8169 case NO_CURSOR:
8170 w->phys_cursor_width = 0;
8171 break;
8172
8173 default:
8174 emacs_abort ();
8175 }
8176 }
8177
8178 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
8179 if (w == XWINDOW (f->selected_window))
8180 if (FRAME_XIC (f) && (FRAME_XIC_STYLE (f) & XIMPreeditPosition))
8181 xic_set_preeditarea (w, x, y);
8182 #endif
8183 }
8184
8185 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
8186 }
8187
8188 \f
8189 /* Icons. */
8190
8191 /* Make the x-window of frame F use the gnu icon bitmap. */
8192
8193 int
8194 x_bitmap_icon (struct frame *f, Lisp_Object file)
8195 {
8196 ptrdiff_t bitmap_id;
8197
8198 if (FRAME_X_WINDOW (f) == 0)
8199 return 1;
8200
8201 /* Free up our existing icon bitmap and mask if any. */
8202 if (f->output_data.x->icon_bitmap > 0)
8203 x_destroy_bitmap (f, f->output_data.x->icon_bitmap);
8204 f->output_data.x->icon_bitmap = 0;
8205
8206 if (STRINGP (file))
8207 {
8208 #ifdef USE_GTK
8209 /* Use gtk_window_set_icon_from_file () if available,
8210 It's not restricted to bitmaps */
8211 if (xg_set_icon (f, file))
8212 return 0;
8213 #endif /* USE_GTK */
8214 bitmap_id = x_create_bitmap_from_file (f, file);
8215 x_create_bitmap_mask (f, bitmap_id);
8216 }
8217 else
8218 {
8219 /* Create the GNU bitmap and mask if necessary. */
8220 if (FRAME_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->icon_bitmap_id < 0)
8221 {
8222 ptrdiff_t rc = -1;
8223
8224 #ifdef USE_GTK
8225
8226 if (FRAME_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->icon_bitmap_id == -2
8227 || xg_set_icon (f, xg_default_icon_file)
8228 || xg_set_icon_from_xpm_data (f, gnu_xpm_bits))
8229 {
8230 FRAME_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->icon_bitmap_id = -2;
8231 return 0;
8232 }
8233
8234 #elif defined (HAVE_XPM) && defined (HAVE_X_WINDOWS)
8235
8236 rc = x_create_bitmap_from_xpm_data (f, gnu_xpm_bits);
8237 if (rc != -1)
8238 FRAME_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->icon_bitmap_id = rc;
8239
8240 #endif
8241
8242 /* If all else fails, use the (black and white) xbm image. */
8243 if (rc == -1)
8244 {
8245 rc = x_create_bitmap_from_data (f, (char *) gnu_xbm_bits,
8246 gnu_xbm_width, gnu_xbm_height);
8247 if (rc == -1)
8248 return 1;
8249
8250 FRAME_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->icon_bitmap_id = rc;
8251 x_create_bitmap_mask (f, FRAME_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->icon_bitmap_id);
8252 }
8253 }
8254
8255 /* The first time we create the GNU bitmap and mask,
8256 this increments the ref-count one extra time.
8257 As a result, the GNU bitmap and mask are never freed.
8258 That way, we don't have to worry about allocating it again. */
8259 x_reference_bitmap (f, FRAME_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->icon_bitmap_id);
8260
8261 bitmap_id = FRAME_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->icon_bitmap_id;
8262 }
8263
8264 x_wm_set_icon_pixmap (f, bitmap_id);
8265 f->output_data.x->icon_bitmap = bitmap_id;
8266
8267 return 0;
8268 }
8269
8270
8271 /* Make the x-window of frame F use a rectangle with text.
8272 Use ICON_NAME as the text. */
8273
8274 int
8275 x_text_icon (struct frame *f, const char *icon_name)
8276 {
8277 if (FRAME_X_WINDOW (f) == 0)
8278 return 1;
8279
8280 {
8281 XTextProperty text;
8282 text.value = (unsigned char *) icon_name;
8283 text.encoding = XA_STRING;
8284 text.format = 8;
8285 text.nitems = strlen (icon_name);
8286 XSetWMIconName (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f), &text);
8287 }
8288
8289 if (f->output_data.x->icon_bitmap > 0)
8290 x_destroy_bitmap (f, f->output_data.x->icon_bitmap);
8291 f->output_data.x->icon_bitmap = 0;
8292 x_wm_set_icon_pixmap (f, 0);
8293
8294 return 0;
8295 }
8296 \f
8297 #define X_ERROR_MESSAGE_SIZE 200
8298
8299 /* If non-nil, this should be a string.
8300 It means catch X errors and store the error message in this string.
8301
8302 The reason we use a stack is that x_catch_error/x_uncatch_error can
8303 be called from a signal handler.
8304 */
8305
8306 struct x_error_message_stack {
8307 char string[X_ERROR_MESSAGE_SIZE];
8308 Display *dpy;
8309 struct x_error_message_stack *prev;
8310 };
8311 static struct x_error_message_stack *x_error_message;
8312
8313 /* An X error handler which stores the error message in
8314 *x_error_message. This is called from x_error_handler if
8315 x_catch_errors is in effect. */
8316
8317 static void
8318 x_error_catcher (Display *display, XErrorEvent *event)
8319 {
8320 XGetErrorText (display, event->error_code,
8321 x_error_message->string,
8322 X_ERROR_MESSAGE_SIZE);
8323 }
8324
8325 /* Begin trapping X errors for display DPY. Actually we trap X errors
8326 for all displays, but DPY should be the display you are actually
8327 operating on.
8328
8329 After calling this function, X protocol errors no longer cause
8330 Emacs to exit; instead, they are recorded in the string
8331 stored in *x_error_message.
8332
8333 Calling x_check_errors signals an Emacs error if an X error has
8334 occurred since the last call to x_catch_errors or x_check_errors.
8335
8336 Calling x_uncatch_errors resumes the normal error handling. */
8337
8338 void
8339 x_catch_errors (Display *dpy)
8340 {
8341 struct x_error_message_stack *data = xmalloc (sizeof *data);
8342
8343 /* Make sure any errors from previous requests have been dealt with. */
8344 XSync (dpy, False);
8345
8346 data->dpy = dpy;
8347 data->string[0] = 0;
8348 data->prev = x_error_message;
8349 x_error_message = data;
8350 }
8351
8352 /* Undo the last x_catch_errors call.
8353 DPY should be the display that was passed to x_catch_errors. */
8354
8355 void
8356 x_uncatch_errors (void)
8357 {
8358 struct x_error_message_stack *tmp;
8359
8360 block_input ();
8361
8362 /* The display may have been closed before this function is called.
8363 Check if it is still open before calling XSync. */
8364 if (x_display_info_for_display (x_error_message->dpy) != 0)
8365 XSync (x_error_message->dpy, False);
8366
8367 tmp = x_error_message;
8368 x_error_message = x_error_message->prev;
8369 xfree (tmp);
8370 unblock_input ();
8371 }
8372
8373 /* If any X protocol errors have arrived since the last call to
8374 x_catch_errors or x_check_errors, signal an Emacs error using
8375 sprintf (a buffer, FORMAT, the x error message text) as the text. */
8376
8377 void
8378 x_check_errors (Display *dpy, const char *format)
8379 {
8380 /* Make sure to catch any errors incurred so far. */
8381 XSync (dpy, False);
8382
8383 if (x_error_message->string[0])
8384 {
8385 char string[X_ERROR_MESSAGE_SIZE];
8386 memcpy (string, x_error_message->string, X_ERROR_MESSAGE_SIZE);
8387 x_uncatch_errors ();
8388 error (format, string);
8389 }
8390 }
8391
8392 /* Nonzero if we had any X protocol errors
8393 since we did x_catch_errors on DPY. */
8394
8395 bool
8396 x_had_errors_p (Display *dpy)
8397 {
8398 /* Make sure to catch any errors incurred so far. */
8399 XSync (dpy, False);
8400
8401 return x_error_message->string[0] != 0;
8402 }
8403
8404 /* Forget about any errors we have had, since we did x_catch_errors on DPY. */
8405
8406 void
8407 x_clear_errors (Display *dpy)
8408 {
8409 x_error_message->string[0] = 0;
8410 }
8411
8412 #if 0 /* See comment in unwind_to_catch why calling this is a bad
8413 * idea. --lorentey */
8414 /* Close off all unclosed x_catch_errors calls. */
8415
8416 void
8417 x_fully_uncatch_errors (void)
8418 {
8419 while (x_error_message)
8420 x_uncatch_errors ();
8421 }
8422 #endif
8423
8424 #if 0
8425 static unsigned int x_wire_count;
8426 x_trace_wire (void)
8427 {
8428 fprintf (stderr, "Lib call: %d\n", ++x_wire_count);
8429 }
8430 #endif /* ! 0 */
8431
8432 \f
8433 /************************************************************************
8434 Handling X errors
8435 ************************************************************************/
8436
8437 /* Error message passed to x_connection_closed. */
8438
8439 static char *error_msg;
8440
8441 /* Handle the loss of connection to display DPY. ERROR_MESSAGE is
8442 the text of an error message that lead to the connection loss. */
8443
8444 static void
8445 x_connection_closed (Display *dpy, const char *error_message)
8446 {
8447 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = x_display_info_for_display (dpy);
8448 Lisp_Object frame, tail;
8449 ptrdiff_t idx = SPECPDL_INDEX ();
8450
8451 error_msg = alloca (strlen (error_message) + 1);
8452 strcpy (error_msg, error_message);
8453
8454 /* Inhibit redisplay while frames are being deleted. */
8455 specbind (Qinhibit_redisplay, Qt);
8456
8457 if (dpyinfo)
8458 {
8459 /* Protect display from being closed when we delete the last
8460 frame on it. */
8461 dpyinfo->reference_count++;
8462 dpyinfo->terminal->reference_count++;
8463 }
8464
8465 /* First delete frames whose mini-buffers are on frames
8466 that are on the dead display. */
8467 FOR_EACH_FRAME (tail, frame)
8468 {
8469 Lisp_Object minibuf_frame;
8470 minibuf_frame
8471 = WINDOW_FRAME (XWINDOW (FRAME_MINIBUF_WINDOW (XFRAME (frame))));
8472 if (FRAME_X_P (XFRAME (frame))
8473 && FRAME_X_P (XFRAME (minibuf_frame))
8474 && ! EQ (frame, minibuf_frame)
8475 && FRAME_DISPLAY_INFO (XFRAME (minibuf_frame)) == dpyinfo)
8476 delete_frame (frame, Qnoelisp);
8477 }
8478
8479 /* Now delete all remaining frames on the dead display.
8480 We are now sure none of these is used as the mini-buffer
8481 for another frame that we need to delete. */
8482 FOR_EACH_FRAME (tail, frame)
8483 if (FRAME_X_P (XFRAME (frame))
8484 && FRAME_DISPLAY_INFO (XFRAME (frame)) == dpyinfo)
8485 {
8486 /* Set this to t so that delete_frame won't get confused
8487 trying to find a replacement. */
8488 kset_default_minibuffer_frame (FRAME_KBOARD (XFRAME (frame)), Qt);
8489 delete_frame (frame, Qnoelisp);
8490 }
8491
8492 /* If DPYINFO is null, this means we didn't open the display in the
8493 first place, so don't try to close it. */
8494 if (dpyinfo)
8495 {
8496 /* We can not call XtCloseDisplay here because it calls XSync.
8497 XSync inside the error handler apparently hangs Emacs. On
8498 current Xt versions, this isn't needed either. */
8499 #ifdef USE_GTK
8500 /* A long-standing GTK bug prevents proper disconnect handling
8501 (https://bugzilla.gnome.org/show_bug.cgi?id=85715). Once,
8502 the resulting Glib error message loop filled a user's disk.
8503 To avoid this, kill Emacs unconditionally on disconnect. */
8504 shut_down_emacs (0, Qnil);
8505 fprintf (stderr, "%s\n\
8506 When compiled with GTK, Emacs cannot recover from X disconnects.\n\
8507 This is a GTK bug: https://bugzilla.gnome.org/show_bug.cgi?id=85715\n\
8508 For details, see etc/PROBLEMS.\n",
8509 error_msg);
8510 emacs_abort ();
8511 #endif /* USE_GTK */
8512
8513 /* Indicate that this display is dead. */
8514 dpyinfo->display = 0;
8515
8516 dpyinfo->reference_count--;
8517 dpyinfo->terminal->reference_count--;
8518 if (dpyinfo->reference_count != 0)
8519 /* We have just closed all frames on this display. */
8520 emacs_abort ();
8521
8522 {
8523 Lisp_Object tmp;
8524 XSETTERMINAL (tmp, dpyinfo->terminal);
8525 Fdelete_terminal (tmp, Qnoelisp);
8526 }
8527 }
8528
8529 if (terminal_list == 0)
8530 {
8531 fprintf (stderr, "%s\n", error_msg);
8532 Fkill_emacs (make_number (70));
8533 /* NOTREACHED */
8534 }
8535
8536 totally_unblock_input ();
8537
8538 unbind_to (idx, Qnil);
8539 clear_waiting_for_input ();
8540
8541 /* Tell GCC not to suggest attribute 'noreturn' for this function. */
8542 IF_LINT (if (! terminal_list) return; )
8543
8544 /* Here, we absolutely have to use a non-local exit (e.g. signal, throw,
8545 longjmp), because returning from this function would get us back into
8546 Xlib's code which will directly call `exit'. */
8547 error ("%s", error_msg);
8548 }
8549
8550 /* We specifically use it before defining it, so that gcc doesn't inline it,
8551 otherwise gdb doesn't know how to properly put a breakpoint on it. */
8552 static void x_error_quitter (Display *, XErrorEvent *);
8553
8554 /* This is the first-level handler for X protocol errors.
8555 It calls x_error_quitter or x_error_catcher. */
8556
8557 static int
8558 x_error_handler (Display *display, XErrorEvent *event)
8559 {
8560 #if defined USE_GTK && defined HAVE_GTK3
8561 if ((event->error_code == BadMatch || event->error_code == BadWindow)
8562 && event->request_code == X_SetInputFocus)
8563 {
8564 return 0;
8565 }
8566 #endif
8567
8568 if (x_error_message)
8569 x_error_catcher (display, event);
8570 else
8571 x_error_quitter (display, event);
8572 return 0;
8573 }
8574
8575 /* This is the usual handler for X protocol errors.
8576 It kills all frames on the display that we got the error for.
8577 If that was the only one, it prints an error message and kills Emacs. */
8578
8579 /* .gdbinit puts a breakpoint here, so make sure it is not inlined. */
8580
8581 /* On older GCC versions, just putting x_error_quitter
8582 after x_error_handler prevents inlining into the former. */
8583
8584 static void NO_INLINE
8585 x_error_quitter (Display *display, XErrorEvent *event)
8586 {
8587 char buf[256], buf1[356];
8588
8589 /* Ignore BadName errors. They can happen because of fonts
8590 or colors that are not defined. */
8591
8592 if (event->error_code == BadName)
8593 return;
8594
8595 /* Note that there is no real way portable across R3/R4 to get the
8596 original error handler. */
8597
8598 XGetErrorText (display, event->error_code, buf, sizeof (buf));
8599 sprintf (buf1, "X protocol error: %s on protocol request %d",
8600 buf, event->request_code);
8601 x_connection_closed (display, buf1);
8602 }
8603
8604
8605 /* This is the handler for X IO errors, always.
8606 It kills all frames on the display that we lost touch with.
8607 If that was the only one, it prints an error message and kills Emacs. */
8608
8609 static int
8610 x_io_error_quitter (Display *display)
8611 {
8612 char buf[256];
8613
8614 snprintf (buf, sizeof buf, "Connection lost to X server `%s'",
8615 DisplayString (display));
8616 x_connection_closed (display, buf);
8617 return 0;
8618 }
8619 \f
8620 /* Changing the font of the frame. */
8621
8622 /* Give frame F the font FONT-OBJECT as its default font. The return
8623 value is FONT-OBJECT. FONTSET is an ID of the fontset for the
8624 frame. If it is negative, generate a new fontset from
8625 FONT-OBJECT. */
8626
8627 Lisp_Object
8628 x_new_font (struct frame *f, Lisp_Object font_object, int fontset)
8629 {
8630 struct font *font = XFONT_OBJECT (font_object);
8631 int unit;
8632
8633 if (fontset < 0)
8634 fontset = fontset_from_font (font_object);
8635 FRAME_FONTSET (f) = fontset;
8636 if (FRAME_FONT (f) == font)
8637 /* This font is already set in frame F. There's nothing more to
8638 do. */
8639 return font_object;
8640
8641 FRAME_FONT (f) = font;
8642 FRAME_BASELINE_OFFSET (f) = font->baseline_offset;
8643 FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (f) = font->average_width;
8644 FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (f) = FONT_HEIGHT (font);
8645
8646 #ifndef USE_X_TOOLKIT \
8647 /** FRAME_TOOL_BAR_HEIGHT (f) = FRAME_TOOL_BAR_LINES (f) * FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (f); **/
8648 FRAME_MENU_BAR_HEIGHT (f) = FRAME_MENU_BAR_LINES (f) * FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (f);
8649 #endif
8650
8651 /* Compute character columns occupied by scrollbar.
8652
8653 Don't do things differently for non-toolkit scrollbars
8654 (Bug#17163). */
8655 unit = FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (f);
8656 if (FRAME_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH (f) > 0)
8657 FRAME_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_COLS (f)
8658 = (FRAME_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH (f) + unit - 1) / unit;
8659 else
8660 FRAME_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_COLS (f) = (14 + unit - 1) / unit;
8661
8662 if (FRAME_X_WINDOW (f) != 0)
8663 {
8664 /* Don't change the size of a tip frame; there's no point in
8665 doing it because it's done in Fx_show_tip, and it leads to
8666 problems because the tip frame has no widget. */
8667 if (NILP (tip_frame) || XFRAME (tip_frame) != f)
8668 x_set_window_size (f, 0, FRAME_COLS (f) * FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (f),
8669 FRAME_LINES (f) * FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (f), 1);
8670 }
8671
8672 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
8673 if (FRAME_XIC (f)
8674 && (FRAME_XIC_STYLE (f) & (XIMPreeditPosition | XIMStatusArea)))
8675 {
8676 block_input ();
8677 xic_set_xfontset (f, SSDATA (fontset_ascii (fontset)));
8678 unblock_input ();
8679 }
8680 #endif
8681
8682 return font_object;
8683 }
8684
8685 \f
8686 /***********************************************************************
8687 X Input Methods
8688 ***********************************************************************/
8689
8690 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
8691
8692 #ifdef HAVE_X11R6
8693
8694 /* XIM destroy callback function, which is called whenever the
8695 connection to input method XIM dies. CLIENT_DATA contains a
8696 pointer to the x_display_info structure corresponding to XIM. */
8697
8698 static void
8699 xim_destroy_callback (XIM xim, XPointer client_data, XPointer call_data)
8700 {
8701 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = (struct x_display_info *) client_data;
8702 Lisp_Object frame, tail;
8703
8704 block_input ();
8705
8706 /* No need to call XDestroyIC.. */
8707 FOR_EACH_FRAME (tail, frame)
8708 {
8709 struct frame *f = XFRAME (frame);
8710 if (FRAME_X_P (f) && FRAME_DISPLAY_INFO (f) == dpyinfo)
8711 {
8712 FRAME_XIC (f) = NULL;
8713 xic_free_xfontset (f);
8714 }
8715 }
8716
8717 /* No need to call XCloseIM. */
8718 dpyinfo->xim = NULL;
8719 XFree (dpyinfo->xim_styles);
8720 unblock_input ();
8721 }
8722
8723 #endif /* HAVE_X11R6 */
8724
8725 /* Open the connection to the XIM server on display DPYINFO.
8726 RESOURCE_NAME is the resource name Emacs uses. */
8727
8728 static void
8729 xim_open_dpy (struct x_display_info *dpyinfo, char *resource_name)
8730 {
8731 XIM xim;
8732
8733 #ifdef HAVE_XIM
8734 if (use_xim)
8735 {
8736 if (dpyinfo->xim)
8737 XCloseIM (dpyinfo->xim);
8738 xim = XOpenIM (dpyinfo->display, dpyinfo->xrdb, resource_name,
8739 emacs_class);
8740 dpyinfo->xim = xim;
8741
8742 if (xim)
8743 {
8744 #ifdef HAVE_X11R6
8745 XIMCallback destroy;
8746 #endif
8747
8748 /* Get supported styles and XIM values. */
8749 XGetIMValues (xim, XNQueryInputStyle, &dpyinfo->xim_styles, NULL);
8750
8751 #ifdef HAVE_X11R6
8752 destroy.callback = xim_destroy_callback;
8753 destroy.client_data = (XPointer)dpyinfo;
8754 XSetIMValues (xim, XNDestroyCallback, &destroy, NULL);
8755 #endif
8756 }
8757 }
8758
8759 else
8760 #endif /* HAVE_XIM */
8761 dpyinfo->xim = NULL;
8762 }
8763
8764
8765 #ifdef HAVE_X11R6_XIM
8766
8767 /* XIM instantiate callback function, which is called whenever an XIM
8768 server is available. DISPLAY is the display of the XIM.
8769 CLIENT_DATA contains a pointer to an xim_inst_t structure created
8770 when the callback was registered. */
8771
8772 static void
8773 xim_instantiate_callback (Display *display, XPointer client_data, XPointer call_data)
8774 {
8775 struct xim_inst_t *xim_inst = (struct xim_inst_t *) client_data;
8776 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = xim_inst->dpyinfo;
8777
8778 /* We don't support multiple XIM connections. */
8779 if (dpyinfo->xim)
8780 return;
8781
8782 xim_open_dpy (dpyinfo, xim_inst->resource_name);
8783
8784 /* Create XIC for the existing frames on the same display, as long
8785 as they have no XIC. */
8786 if (dpyinfo->xim && dpyinfo->reference_count > 0)
8787 {
8788 Lisp_Object tail, frame;
8789
8790 block_input ();
8791 FOR_EACH_FRAME (tail, frame)
8792 {
8793 struct frame *f = XFRAME (frame);
8794
8795 if (FRAME_X_P (f)
8796 && FRAME_DISPLAY_INFO (f) == xim_inst->dpyinfo)
8797 if (FRAME_XIC (f) == NULL)
8798 {
8799 create_frame_xic (f);
8800 if (FRAME_XIC_STYLE (f) & XIMStatusArea)
8801 xic_set_statusarea (f);
8802 if (FRAME_XIC_STYLE (f) & XIMPreeditPosition)
8803 {
8804 struct window *w = XWINDOW (f->selected_window);
8805 xic_set_preeditarea (w, w->cursor.x, w->cursor.y);
8806 }
8807 }
8808 }
8809
8810 unblock_input ();
8811 }
8812 }
8813
8814 #endif /* HAVE_X11R6_XIM */
8815
8816
8817 /* Open a connection to the XIM server on display DPYINFO.
8818 RESOURCE_NAME is the resource name for Emacs. On X11R5, open the
8819 connection only at the first time. On X11R6, open the connection
8820 in the XIM instantiate callback function. */
8821
8822 static void
8823 xim_initialize (struct x_display_info *dpyinfo, char *resource_name)
8824 {
8825 dpyinfo->xim = NULL;
8826 #ifdef HAVE_XIM
8827 if (use_xim)
8828 {
8829 #ifdef HAVE_X11R6_XIM
8830 struct xim_inst_t *xim_inst = xmalloc (sizeof *xim_inst);
8831 Bool ret;
8832
8833 dpyinfo->xim_callback_data = xim_inst;
8834 xim_inst->dpyinfo = dpyinfo;
8835 xim_inst->resource_name = xstrdup (resource_name);
8836 ret = XRegisterIMInstantiateCallback
8837 (dpyinfo->display, dpyinfo->xrdb, xim_inst->resource_name,
8838 emacs_class, xim_instantiate_callback,
8839 /* This is XPointer in XFree86 but (XPointer *)
8840 on Tru64, at least, hence the configure test. */
8841 (XRegisterIMInstantiateCallback_arg6) xim_inst);
8842 eassert (ret == True);
8843 #else /* not HAVE_X11R6_XIM */
8844 xim_open_dpy (dpyinfo, resource_name);
8845 #endif /* not HAVE_X11R6_XIM */
8846 }
8847 #endif /* HAVE_XIM */
8848 }
8849
8850
8851 /* Close the connection to the XIM server on display DPYINFO. */
8852
8853 static void
8854 xim_close_dpy (struct x_display_info *dpyinfo)
8855 {
8856 #ifdef HAVE_XIM
8857 if (use_xim)
8858 {
8859 #ifdef HAVE_X11R6_XIM
8860 struct xim_inst_t *xim_inst = dpyinfo->xim_callback_data;
8861
8862 if (dpyinfo->display)
8863 {
8864 Bool ret = XUnregisterIMInstantiateCallback
8865 (dpyinfo->display, dpyinfo->xrdb, xim_inst->resource_name,
8866 emacs_class, xim_instantiate_callback,
8867 (XRegisterIMInstantiateCallback_arg6) xim_inst);
8868 eassert (ret == True);
8869 }
8870 xfree (xim_inst->resource_name);
8871 xfree (xim_inst);
8872 #endif /* HAVE_X11R6_XIM */
8873 if (dpyinfo->display)
8874 XCloseIM (dpyinfo->xim);
8875 dpyinfo->xim = NULL;
8876 XFree (dpyinfo->xim_styles);
8877 }
8878 #endif /* HAVE_XIM */
8879 }
8880
8881 #endif /* not HAVE_X11R6_XIM */
8882
8883
8884 \f
8885 /* Calculate the absolute position in frame F
8886 from its current recorded position values and gravity. */
8887
8888 static void
8889 x_calc_absolute_position (struct frame *f)
8890 {
8891 int flags = f->size_hint_flags;
8892
8893 /* We have nothing to do if the current position
8894 is already for the top-left corner. */
8895 if (! ((flags & XNegative) || (flags & YNegative)))
8896 return;
8897
8898 /* Treat negative positions as relative to the leftmost bottommost
8899 position that fits on the screen. */
8900 if (flags & XNegative)
8901 f->left_pos = x_display_pixel_width (FRAME_DISPLAY_INFO (f))
8902 - FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f) + f->left_pos;
8903
8904 {
8905 int height = FRAME_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f);
8906
8907 #if defined USE_X_TOOLKIT && defined USE_MOTIF
8908 /* Something is fishy here. When using Motif, starting Emacs with
8909 `-g -0-0', the frame appears too low by a few pixels.
8910
8911 This seems to be so because initially, while Emacs is starting,
8912 the column widget's height and the frame's pixel height are
8913 different. The column widget's height is the right one. In
8914 later invocations, when Emacs is up, the frame's pixel height
8915 is right, though.
8916
8917 It's not obvious where the initial small difference comes from.
8918 2000-12-01, gerd. */
8919
8920 XtVaGetValues (f->output_data.x->column_widget, XtNheight, &height, NULL);
8921 #endif
8922
8923 if (flags & YNegative)
8924 f->top_pos = x_display_pixel_height (FRAME_DISPLAY_INFO (f))
8925 - height + f->top_pos;
8926 }
8927
8928 /* The left_pos and top_pos
8929 are now relative to the top and left screen edges,
8930 so the flags should correspond. */
8931 f->size_hint_flags &= ~ (XNegative | YNegative);
8932 }
8933
8934 /* CHANGE_GRAVITY is 1 when calling from Fset_frame_position,
8935 to really change the position, and 0 when calling from
8936 x_make_frame_visible (in that case, XOFF and YOFF are the current
8937 position values). It is -1 when calling from x_set_frame_parameters,
8938 which means, do adjust for borders but don't change the gravity. */
8939
8940 void
8941 x_set_offset (struct frame *f, register int xoff, register int yoff, int change_gravity)
8942 {
8943 int modified_top, modified_left;
8944
8945 if (change_gravity > 0)
8946 {
8947 f->top_pos = yoff;
8948 f->left_pos = xoff;
8949 f->size_hint_flags &= ~ (XNegative | YNegative);
8950 if (xoff < 0)
8951 f->size_hint_flags |= XNegative;
8952 if (yoff < 0)
8953 f->size_hint_flags |= YNegative;
8954 f->win_gravity = NorthWestGravity;
8955 }
8956 x_calc_absolute_position (f);
8957
8958 block_input ();
8959 x_wm_set_size_hint (f, 0, 0);
8960
8961 modified_left = f->left_pos;
8962 modified_top = f->top_pos;
8963
8964 if (change_gravity != 0 && FRAME_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->wm_type == X_WMTYPE_A)
8965 {
8966 /* Some WMs (twm, wmaker at least) has an offset that is smaller
8967 than the WM decorations. So we use the calculated offset instead
8968 of the WM decoration sizes here (x/y_pixels_outer_diff). */
8969 modified_left += FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->move_offset_left;
8970 modified_top += FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->move_offset_top;
8971 }
8972
8973 XMoveWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f),
8974 modified_left, modified_top);
8975
8976 x_sync_with_move (f, f->left_pos, f->top_pos,
8977 FRAME_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->wm_type == X_WMTYPE_UNKNOWN
8978 ? 1 : 0);
8979
8980 /* change_gravity is non-zero when this function is called from Lisp to
8981 programmatically move a frame. In that case, we call
8982 x_check_expected_move to discover if we have a "Type A" or "Type B"
8983 window manager, and, for a "Type A" window manager, adjust the position
8984 of the frame.
8985
8986 We call x_check_expected_move if a programmatic move occurred, and
8987 either the window manager type (A/B) is unknown or it is Type A but we
8988 need to compute the top/left offset adjustment for this frame. */
8989
8990 if (change_gravity != 0 &&
8991 (FRAME_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->wm_type == X_WMTYPE_UNKNOWN
8992 || (FRAME_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->wm_type == X_WMTYPE_A
8993 && (FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->move_offset_left == 0
8994 && FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->move_offset_top == 0))))
8995 x_check_expected_move (f, modified_left, modified_top);
8996
8997 unblock_input ();
8998 }
8999
9000 /* Return non-zero if _NET_SUPPORTING_WM_CHECK window exists and _NET_SUPPORTED
9001 on the root window for frame F contains ATOMNAME.
9002 This is how a WM check shall be done according to the Window Manager
9003 Specification/Extended Window Manager Hints at
9004 http://freedesktop.org/wiki/Specifications/wm-spec. */
9005
9006 static int
9007 wm_supports (struct frame *f, Atom want_atom)
9008 {
9009 Atom actual_type;
9010 unsigned long actual_size, bytes_remaining;
9011 int i, rc, actual_format;
9012 Window wmcheck_window;
9013 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
9014 Window target_window = dpyinfo->root_window;
9015 long max_len = 65536;
9016 Display *dpy = FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f);
9017 unsigned char *tmp_data = NULL;
9018 Atom target_type = XA_WINDOW;
9019
9020 block_input ();
9021
9022 x_catch_errors (dpy);
9023 rc = XGetWindowProperty (dpy, target_window,
9024 dpyinfo->Xatom_net_supporting_wm_check,
9025 0, max_len, False, target_type,
9026 &actual_type, &actual_format, &actual_size,
9027 &bytes_remaining, &tmp_data);
9028
9029 if (rc != Success || actual_type != XA_WINDOW || x_had_errors_p (dpy))
9030 {
9031 if (tmp_data) XFree (tmp_data);
9032 x_uncatch_errors ();
9033 unblock_input ();
9034 return 0;
9035 }
9036
9037 wmcheck_window = *(Window *) tmp_data;
9038 XFree (tmp_data);
9039
9040 /* Check if window exists. */
9041 XSelectInput (dpy, wmcheck_window, StructureNotifyMask);
9042 x_sync (f);
9043 if (x_had_errors_p (dpy))
9044 {
9045 x_uncatch_errors ();
9046 unblock_input ();
9047 return 0;
9048 }
9049
9050 if (dpyinfo->net_supported_window != wmcheck_window)
9051 {
9052 /* Window changed, reload atoms */
9053 if (dpyinfo->net_supported_atoms != NULL)
9054 XFree (dpyinfo->net_supported_atoms);
9055 dpyinfo->net_supported_atoms = NULL;
9056 dpyinfo->nr_net_supported_atoms = 0;
9057 dpyinfo->net_supported_window = 0;
9058
9059 target_type = XA_ATOM;
9060 tmp_data = NULL;
9061 rc = XGetWindowProperty (dpy, target_window,
9062 dpyinfo->Xatom_net_supported,
9063 0, max_len, False, target_type,
9064 &actual_type, &actual_format, &actual_size,
9065 &bytes_remaining, &tmp_data);
9066
9067 if (rc != Success || actual_type != XA_ATOM || x_had_errors_p (dpy))
9068 {
9069 if (tmp_data) XFree (tmp_data);
9070 x_uncatch_errors ();
9071 unblock_input ();
9072 return 0;
9073 }
9074
9075 dpyinfo->net_supported_atoms = (Atom *)tmp_data;
9076 dpyinfo->nr_net_supported_atoms = actual_size;
9077 dpyinfo->net_supported_window = wmcheck_window;
9078 }
9079
9080 rc = 0;
9081
9082 for (i = 0; rc == 0 && i < dpyinfo->nr_net_supported_atoms; ++i)
9083 rc = dpyinfo->net_supported_atoms[i] == want_atom;
9084
9085 x_uncatch_errors ();
9086 unblock_input ();
9087
9088 return rc;
9089 }
9090
9091 static void
9092 set_wm_state (Lisp_Object frame, int add, Atom atom, Atom value)
9093 {
9094 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_DISPLAY_INFO (XFRAME (frame));
9095
9096 x_send_client_event (frame, make_number (0), frame,
9097 dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state,
9098 make_number (32),
9099 /* 1 = add, 0 = remove */
9100 Fcons
9101 (make_number (add ? 1 : 0),
9102 Fcons
9103 (make_fixnum_or_float (atom),
9104 (value != 0
9105 ? list1 (make_fixnum_or_float (value))
9106 : Qnil))));
9107 }
9108
9109 void
9110 x_set_sticky (struct frame *f, Lisp_Object new_value, Lisp_Object old_value)
9111 {
9112 Lisp_Object frame;
9113 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
9114
9115 XSETFRAME (frame, f);
9116
9117 set_wm_state (frame, NILP (new_value) ? 0 : 1,
9118 dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_sticky, None);
9119 }
9120
9121 /* Return the current _NET_WM_STATE.
9122 SIZE_STATE is set to one of the FULLSCREEN_* values.
9123 STICKY is set to 1 if the sticky state is set, 0 if not.
9124
9125 Return non-zero if we are not hidden, zero if we are. */
9126
9127 static int
9128 get_current_wm_state (struct frame *f,
9129 Window window,
9130 int *size_state,
9131 int *sticky)
9132 {
9133 Atom actual_type;
9134 unsigned long actual_size, bytes_remaining;
9135 int i, rc, actual_format, is_hidden = 0;
9136 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
9137 long max_len = 65536;
9138 Display *dpy = FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f);
9139 unsigned char *tmp_data = NULL;
9140 Atom target_type = XA_ATOM;
9141
9142 *sticky = 0;
9143 *size_state = FULLSCREEN_NONE;
9144
9145 block_input ();
9146 x_catch_errors (dpy);
9147 rc = XGetWindowProperty (dpy, window, dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state,
9148 0, max_len, False, target_type,
9149 &actual_type, &actual_format, &actual_size,
9150 &bytes_remaining, &tmp_data);
9151
9152 if (rc != Success || actual_type != target_type || x_had_errors_p (dpy))
9153 {
9154 if (tmp_data) XFree (tmp_data);
9155 x_uncatch_errors ();
9156 unblock_input ();
9157 return !FRAME_ICONIFIED_P (f);
9158 }
9159
9160 x_uncatch_errors ();
9161
9162 for (i = 0; i < actual_size; ++i)
9163 {
9164 Atom a = ((Atom*)tmp_data)[i];
9165 if (a == dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_hidden)
9166 {
9167 is_hidden = 1;
9168 f->output_data.x->net_wm_state_hidden_seen = 1;
9169 }
9170 else if (a == dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_maximized_horz)
9171 {
9172 if (*size_state == FULLSCREEN_HEIGHT)
9173 *size_state = FULLSCREEN_MAXIMIZED;
9174 else
9175 *size_state = FULLSCREEN_WIDTH;
9176 }
9177 else if (a == dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_maximized_vert)
9178 {
9179 if (*size_state == FULLSCREEN_WIDTH)
9180 *size_state = FULLSCREEN_MAXIMIZED;
9181 else
9182 *size_state = FULLSCREEN_HEIGHT;
9183 }
9184 else if (a == dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_fullscreen)
9185 *size_state = FULLSCREEN_BOTH;
9186 else if (a == dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_sticky)
9187 *sticky = 1;
9188 }
9189
9190 if (tmp_data) XFree (tmp_data);
9191 unblock_input ();
9192 return ! is_hidden;
9193 }
9194
9195 /* Do fullscreen as specified in extended window manager hints */
9196
9197 static int
9198 do_ewmh_fullscreen (struct frame *f)
9199 {
9200 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
9201 int have_net_atom = wm_supports (f, dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state);
9202 int cur, dummy;
9203
9204 (void)get_current_wm_state (f, FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f), &cur, &dummy);
9205
9206 /* Some window managers don't say they support _NET_WM_STATE, but they do say
9207 they support _NET_WM_STATE_FULLSCREEN. Try that also. */
9208 if (!have_net_atom)
9209 have_net_atom = wm_supports (f, dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_fullscreen);
9210
9211 if (have_net_atom && cur != f->want_fullscreen)
9212 {
9213 Lisp_Object frame;
9214
9215 XSETFRAME (frame, f);
9216
9217 /* Keep number of calls to set_wm_state as low as possible.
9218 Some window managers, or possible Gtk+, hangs when too many
9219 are sent at once. */
9220 switch (f->want_fullscreen)
9221 {
9222 case FULLSCREEN_BOTH:
9223 if (cur == FULLSCREEN_WIDTH || cur == FULLSCREEN_MAXIMIZED
9224 || cur == FULLSCREEN_HEIGHT)
9225 set_wm_state (frame, 0, dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_maximized_horz,
9226 dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_maximized_vert);
9227 set_wm_state (frame, 1, dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_fullscreen, None);
9228 break;
9229 case FULLSCREEN_WIDTH:
9230 if (cur == FULLSCREEN_BOTH || cur == FULLSCREEN_HEIGHT
9231 || cur == FULLSCREEN_MAXIMIZED)
9232 set_wm_state (frame, 0, dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_fullscreen,
9233 dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_maximized_vert);
9234 if (cur != FULLSCREEN_MAXIMIZED)
9235 set_wm_state (frame, 1, dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_maximized_horz, None);
9236 break;
9237 case FULLSCREEN_HEIGHT:
9238 if (cur == FULLSCREEN_BOTH || cur == FULLSCREEN_WIDTH
9239 || cur == FULLSCREEN_MAXIMIZED)
9240 set_wm_state (frame, 0, dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_fullscreen,
9241 dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_maximized_horz);
9242 if (cur != FULLSCREEN_MAXIMIZED)
9243 set_wm_state (frame, 1, dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_maximized_vert, None);
9244 break;
9245 case FULLSCREEN_MAXIMIZED:
9246 if (cur == FULLSCREEN_BOTH)
9247 set_wm_state (frame, 0, dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_fullscreen, None);
9248 set_wm_state (frame, 1, dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_maximized_horz,
9249 dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_maximized_vert);
9250 break;
9251 case FULLSCREEN_NONE:
9252 if (cur == FULLSCREEN_BOTH)
9253 set_wm_state (frame, 0, dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_fullscreen, None);
9254 else
9255 set_wm_state (frame, 0, dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_maximized_horz,
9256 dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_maximized_vert);
9257 }
9258
9259 f->want_fullscreen = FULLSCREEN_NONE;
9260
9261 }
9262
9263 return have_net_atom;
9264 }
9265
9266 static void
9267 XTfullscreen_hook (struct frame *f)
9268 {
9269 if (FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f))
9270 {
9271 block_input ();
9272 x_check_fullscreen (f);
9273 x_sync (f);
9274 unblock_input ();
9275 }
9276 }
9277
9278
9279 static int
9280 x_handle_net_wm_state (struct frame *f, const XPropertyEvent *event)
9281 {
9282 int value = FULLSCREEN_NONE;
9283 Lisp_Object lval;
9284 int sticky = 0;
9285 int not_hidden = get_current_wm_state (f, event->window, &value, &sticky);
9286
9287 lval = Qnil;
9288 switch (value)
9289 {
9290 case FULLSCREEN_WIDTH:
9291 lval = Qfullwidth;
9292 break;
9293 case FULLSCREEN_HEIGHT:
9294 lval = Qfullheight;
9295 break;
9296 case FULLSCREEN_BOTH:
9297 lval = Qfullboth;
9298 break;
9299 case FULLSCREEN_MAXIMIZED:
9300 lval = Qmaximized;
9301 break;
9302 }
9303
9304 store_frame_param (f, Qfullscreen, lval);
9305 store_frame_param (f, Qsticky, sticky ? Qt : Qnil);
9306
9307 return not_hidden;
9308 }
9309
9310 /* Check if we need to resize the frame due to a fullscreen request.
9311 If so needed, resize the frame. */
9312 static void
9313 x_check_fullscreen (struct frame *f)
9314 {
9315 if (do_ewmh_fullscreen (f))
9316 return;
9317
9318 if (f->output_data.x->parent_desc != FRAME_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->root_window)
9319 return; /* Only fullscreen without WM or with EWM hints (above). */
9320
9321 /* Setting fullscreen to nil doesn't do anything. We could save the
9322 last non-fullscreen size and restore it, but it seems like a
9323 lot of work for this unusual case (no window manager running). */
9324
9325 if (f->want_fullscreen != FULLSCREEN_NONE)
9326 {
9327 int width = FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f), height = FRAME_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f);
9328 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
9329
9330 switch (f->want_fullscreen)
9331 {
9332 /* No difference between these two when there is no WM */
9333 case FULLSCREEN_BOTH:
9334 case FULLSCREEN_MAXIMIZED:
9335 width = x_display_pixel_width (dpyinfo);
9336 height = x_display_pixel_height (dpyinfo);
9337 break;
9338 case FULLSCREEN_WIDTH:
9339 width = x_display_pixel_width (dpyinfo);
9340 break;
9341 case FULLSCREEN_HEIGHT:
9342 height = x_display_pixel_height (dpyinfo);
9343 }
9344
9345 XResizeWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f),
9346 width, height);
9347 }
9348 }
9349
9350 /* This function is called by x_set_offset to determine whether the window
9351 manager interfered with the positioning of the frame. Type A window
9352 managers position the surrounding window manager decorations a small
9353 amount above and left of the user-supplied position. Type B window
9354 managers position the surrounding window manager decorations at the
9355 user-specified position. If we detect a Type A window manager, we
9356 compensate by moving the window right and down by the proper amount. */
9357
9358 static void
9359 x_check_expected_move (struct frame *f, int expected_left, int expected_top)
9360 {
9361 int current_left = 0, current_top = 0;
9362
9363 /* x_real_positions returns the left and top offsets of the outermost
9364 window manager window around the frame. */
9365
9366 x_real_positions (f, &current_left, &current_top);
9367
9368 if (current_left != expected_left || current_top != expected_top)
9369 {
9370 /* It's a "Type A" window manager. */
9371
9372 int adjusted_left;
9373 int adjusted_top;
9374
9375 FRAME_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->wm_type = X_WMTYPE_A;
9376 FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->move_offset_left = expected_left - current_left;
9377 FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->move_offset_top = expected_top - current_top;
9378
9379 /* Now fix the mispositioned frame's location. */
9380
9381 adjusted_left = expected_left + FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->move_offset_left;
9382 adjusted_top = expected_top + FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->move_offset_top;
9383
9384 XMoveWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f),
9385 adjusted_left, adjusted_top);
9386
9387 x_sync_with_move (f, expected_left, expected_top, 0);
9388 }
9389 else
9390 /* It's a "Type B" window manager. We don't have to adjust the
9391 frame's position. */
9392
9393 FRAME_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->wm_type = X_WMTYPE_B;
9394 }
9395
9396
9397 /* Wait for XGetGeometry to return up-to-date position information for a
9398 recently-moved frame. Call this immediately after calling XMoveWindow.
9399 If FUZZY is non-zero, then LEFT and TOP are just estimates of where the
9400 frame has been moved to, so we use a fuzzy position comparison instead
9401 of an exact comparison. */
9402
9403 static void
9404 x_sync_with_move (struct frame *f, int left, int top, int fuzzy)
9405 {
9406 int count = 0;
9407
9408 while (count++ < 50)
9409 {
9410 int current_left = 0, current_top = 0;
9411
9412 /* In theory, this call to XSync only needs to happen once, but in
9413 practice, it doesn't seem to work, hence the need for the surrounding
9414 loop. */
9415
9416 XSync (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), False);
9417 x_real_positions (f, &current_left, &current_top);
9418
9419 if (fuzzy)
9420 {
9421 /* The left fuzz-factor is 10 pixels. The top fuzz-factor is 40
9422 pixels. */
9423
9424 if (eabs (current_left - left) <= 10
9425 && eabs (current_top - top) <= 40)
9426 return;
9427 }
9428 else if (current_left == left && current_top == top)
9429 return;
9430 }
9431
9432 /* As a last resort, just wait 0.5 seconds and hope that XGetGeometry
9433 will then return up-to-date position info. */
9434
9435 wait_reading_process_output (0, 500000000, 0, 0, Qnil, NULL, 0);
9436 }
9437
9438
9439 /* Wait for an event on frame F matching EVENTTYPE. */
9440 void
9441 x_wait_for_event (struct frame *f, int eventtype)
9442 {
9443 int level = interrupt_input_blocked;
9444
9445 fd_set fds;
9446 struct timespec tmo, tmo_at, time_now;
9447 int fd = ConnectionNumber (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
9448
9449 f->wait_event_type = eventtype;
9450
9451 /* Set timeout to 0.1 second. Hopefully not noticeable.
9452 Maybe it should be configurable. */
9453 tmo = make_timespec (0, 100 * 1000 * 1000);
9454 tmo_at = timespec_add (current_timespec (), tmo);
9455
9456 while (f->wait_event_type)
9457 {
9458 pending_signals = 1;
9459 totally_unblock_input ();
9460 /* XTread_socket is called after unblock. */
9461 block_input ();
9462 interrupt_input_blocked = level;
9463
9464 FD_ZERO (&fds);
9465 FD_SET (fd, &fds);
9466
9467 time_now = current_timespec ();
9468 if (timespec_cmp (tmo_at, time_now) < 0)
9469 break;
9470
9471 tmo = timespec_sub (tmo_at, time_now);
9472 if (pselect (fd + 1, &fds, NULL, NULL, &tmo, NULL) == 0)
9473 break; /* Timeout */
9474 }
9475
9476 f->wait_event_type = 0;
9477 }
9478
9479
9480 /* Change the size of frame F's X window to WIDTH/HEIGHT in the case F
9481 doesn't have a widget. If CHANGE_GRAVITY is 1, we change to
9482 top-left-corner window gravity for this size change and subsequent
9483 size changes. Otherwise we leave the window gravity unchanged. */
9484
9485 static void
9486 x_set_window_size_1 (struct frame *f, int change_gravity, int width, int height, bool pixelwise)
9487 {
9488 int pixelwidth, pixelheight;
9489
9490 /** if (pixelwise) **/
9491 /** { **/
9492 /** pixelwidth = FRAME_TEXT_TO_PIXEL_WIDTH (f, width); **/
9493 /** pixelheight = FRAME_TEXT_TO_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f, height); **/
9494 /** } **/
9495 /** else **/
9496 /** { **/
9497 /** pixelwidth = FRAME_TEXT_COLS_TO_PIXEL_WIDTH (f, width); **/
9498 /** pixelheight = FRAME_TEXT_LINES_TO_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f, height); **/
9499 /** } **/
9500
9501 /** FRAME_TOOL_BAR_HEIGHT (f) = FRAME_TOOLBAR_HEIGHT (f); **/
9502 pixelwidth = (pixelwise
9503 ? FRAME_TEXT_TO_PIXEL_WIDTH (f, width)
9504 : FRAME_TEXT_COLS_TO_PIXEL_WIDTH (f, width));
9505 pixelheight = ((pixelwise
9506 ? FRAME_TEXT_TO_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f, height)
9507 : FRAME_TEXT_LINES_TO_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f, height)));
9508
9509 /** pixelwidth = ((pixelwise ? width : (width * FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (f))) **/
9510 /** + FRAME_SCROLL_BAR_AREA_WIDTH (f) **/
9511 /** + FRAME_TOTAL_FRINGE_WIDTH (f) **/
9512 /** + 2 * FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f)); **/
9513
9514 /** pixelheight = ((pixelwise ? height : (height * FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (f))) **/
9515 /** + FRAME_TOOLBAR_HEIGHT (f) **/
9516 /** + FRAME_SCROLL_BAR_AREA_HEIGHT (f) **/
9517 /** + 2 * FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f)); **/
9518
9519 if (change_gravity) f->win_gravity = NorthWestGravity;
9520 x_wm_set_size_hint (f, 0, 0);
9521 XResizeWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f),
9522 pixelwidth, pixelheight + FRAME_MENUBAR_HEIGHT (f));
9523
9524
9525 /* We've set {FRAME,PIXEL}_{WIDTH,HEIGHT} to the values we hope to
9526 receive in the ConfigureNotify event; if we get what we asked
9527 for, then the event won't cause the screen to become garbaged, so
9528 we have to make sure to do it here. */
9529 SET_FRAME_GARBAGED (f);
9530
9531 /* Now, strictly speaking, we can't be sure that this is accurate,
9532 but the window manager will get around to dealing with the size
9533 change request eventually, and we'll hear how it went when the
9534 ConfigureNotify event gets here.
9535
9536 We could just not bother storing any of this information here,
9537 and let the ConfigureNotify event set everything up, but that
9538 might be kind of confusing to the Lisp code, since size changes
9539 wouldn't be reported in the frame parameters until some random
9540 point in the future when the ConfigureNotify event arrives.
9541
9542 We pass 1 for DELAY since we can't run Lisp code inside of
9543 a BLOCK_INPUT. */
9544
9545 /* But the ConfigureNotify may in fact never arrive, and then this is
9546 not right if the frame is visible. Instead wait (with timeout)
9547 for the ConfigureNotify. */
9548 if (FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f))
9549 x_wait_for_event (f, ConfigureNotify);
9550 else
9551 {
9552 change_frame_size (f, pixelwidth, pixelheight, 0, 1, 0, 1);
9553 x_sync (f);
9554 }
9555 }
9556
9557
9558 /* Call this to change the size of frame F's x-window.
9559 If CHANGE_GRAVITY is 1, we change to top-left-corner window gravity
9560 for this size change and subsequent size changes.
9561 Otherwise we leave the window gravity unchanged. */
9562
9563 void
9564 x_set_window_size (struct frame *f, int change_gravity, int width, int height, bool pixelwise)
9565 {
9566 block_input ();
9567
9568 /* The following breaks our calculations. If it's really needed,
9569 think of something else. */
9570 #if 0
9571 if (NILP (tip_frame) || XFRAME (tip_frame) != f)
9572 {
9573 int text_width, text_height;
9574
9575 /* When the frame is maximized/fullscreen or running under for
9576 example Xmonad, x_set_window_size_1 will be a no-op.
9577 In that case, the right thing to do is extend rows/width to
9578 the current frame size. We do that first if x_set_window_size_1
9579 turns out to not be a no-op (there is no way to know).
9580 The size will be adjusted again if the frame gets a
9581 ConfigureNotify event as a result of x_set_window_size. */
9582 int pixelh = FRAME_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f);
9583 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
9584 /* The menu bar is not part of text lines. The tool bar
9585 is however. */
9586 pixelh -= FRAME_MENUBAR_HEIGHT (f);
9587 #endif
9588 text_width = FRAME_PIXEL_TO_TEXT_WIDTH (f, FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f));
9589 text_height = FRAME_PIXEL_TO_TEXT_HEIGHT (f, pixelh);
9590
9591 change_frame_size (f, text_width, text_height, 0, 1, 0, 1);
9592 }
9593 #endif
9594
9595 #ifdef USE_GTK
9596 if (FRAME_GTK_WIDGET (f))
9597 if (! pixelwise)
9598 xg_frame_set_char_size (f, width * FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (f),
9599 height * FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (f));
9600 else
9601 xg_frame_set_char_size (f, width, height);
9602 else
9603 x_set_window_size_1 (f, change_gravity, width, height, pixelwise);
9604 #else /* not USE_GTK */
9605
9606 x_set_window_size_1 (f, change_gravity, width, height, pixelwise);
9607 x_clear_under_internal_border (f);
9608
9609 #endif /* not USE_GTK */
9610
9611 /* If cursor was outside the new size, mark it as off. */
9612 mark_window_cursors_off (XWINDOW (f->root_window));
9613
9614 /* Clear out any recollection of where the mouse highlighting was,
9615 since it might be in a place that's outside the new frame size.
9616 Actually checking whether it is outside is a pain in the neck,
9617 so don't try--just let the highlighting be done afresh with new size. */
9618 cancel_mouse_face (f);
9619
9620 unblock_input ();
9621
9622 do_pending_window_change (0);
9623 }
9624
9625 /* Move the mouse to position pixel PIX_X, PIX_Y relative to frame F. */
9626
9627 void
9628 frame_set_mouse_pixel_position (struct frame *f, int pix_x, int pix_y)
9629 {
9630 block_input ();
9631
9632 XWarpPointer (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), None, FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
9633 0, 0, 0, 0, pix_x, pix_y);
9634 unblock_input ();
9635 }
9636 \f
9637 /* Raise frame F. */
9638
9639 void
9640 x_raise_frame (struct frame *f)
9641 {
9642 block_input ();
9643 if (FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f))
9644 XRaiseWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f));
9645 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
9646 unblock_input ();
9647 }
9648
9649 /* Lower frame F. */
9650
9651 static void
9652 x_lower_frame (struct frame *f)
9653 {
9654 if (FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f))
9655 {
9656 block_input ();
9657 XLowerWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f));
9658 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
9659 unblock_input ();
9660 }
9661 }
9662
9663 /* Request focus with XEmbed */
9664
9665 void
9666 xembed_request_focus (struct frame *f)
9667 {
9668 /* See XEmbed Protocol Specification at
9669 http://freedesktop.org/wiki/Specifications/xembed-spec */
9670 if (FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f))
9671 xembed_send_message (f, CurrentTime,
9672 XEMBED_REQUEST_FOCUS, 0, 0, 0);
9673 }
9674
9675 /* Activate frame with Extended Window Manager Hints */
9676
9677 void
9678 x_ewmh_activate_frame (struct frame *f)
9679 {
9680 /* See Window Manager Specification/Extended Window Manager Hints at
9681 http://freedesktop.org/wiki/Specifications/wm-spec */
9682
9683 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
9684
9685 if (FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f) && wm_supports (f, dpyinfo->Xatom_net_active_window))
9686 {
9687 Lisp_Object frame;
9688 XSETFRAME (frame, f);
9689 x_send_client_event (frame, make_number (0), frame,
9690 dpyinfo->Xatom_net_active_window,
9691 make_number (32),
9692 list2i (1, dpyinfo->last_user_time));
9693 }
9694 }
9695
9696 static void
9697 XTframe_raise_lower (struct frame *f, int raise_flag)
9698 {
9699 if (raise_flag)
9700 x_raise_frame (f);
9701 else
9702 x_lower_frame (f);
9703 }
9704 \f
9705 /* XEmbed implementation. */
9706
9707 #if defined USE_X_TOOLKIT || ! defined USE_GTK
9708
9709 /* XEmbed implementation. */
9710
9711 #define XEMBED_VERSION 0
9712
9713 static void
9714 xembed_set_info (struct frame *f, enum xembed_info flags)
9715 {
9716 unsigned long data[2];
9717 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
9718
9719 data[0] = XEMBED_VERSION;
9720 data[1] = flags;
9721
9722 XChangeProperty (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f),
9723 dpyinfo->Xatom_XEMBED_INFO, dpyinfo->Xatom_XEMBED_INFO,
9724 32, PropModeReplace, (unsigned char *) data, 2);
9725 }
9726 #endif /* defined USE_X_TOOLKIT || ! defined USE_GTK */
9727
9728 static void
9729 xembed_send_message (struct frame *f, Time t, enum xembed_message msg,
9730 long int detail, long int data1, long int data2)
9731 {
9732 XEvent event;
9733
9734 event.xclient.type = ClientMessage;
9735 event.xclient.window = FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->parent_desc;
9736 event.xclient.message_type = FRAME_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->Xatom_XEMBED;
9737 event.xclient.format = 32;
9738 event.xclient.data.l[0] = t;
9739 event.xclient.data.l[1] = msg;
9740 event.xclient.data.l[2] = detail;
9741 event.xclient.data.l[3] = data1;
9742 event.xclient.data.l[4] = data2;
9743
9744 XSendEvent (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->parent_desc,
9745 False, NoEventMask, &event);
9746 XSync (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), False);
9747 }
9748 \f
9749 /* Change of visibility. */
9750
9751 /* This tries to wait until the frame is really visible.
9752 However, if the window manager asks the user where to position
9753 the frame, this will return before the user finishes doing that.
9754 The frame will not actually be visible at that time,
9755 but it will become visible later when the window manager
9756 finishes with it. */
9757
9758 void
9759 x_make_frame_visible (struct frame *f)
9760 {
9761 int original_top, original_left;
9762 int tries = 0;
9763
9764 block_input ();
9765
9766 x_set_bitmap_icon (f);
9767
9768 if (! FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f))
9769 {
9770 /* We test FRAME_GARBAGED_P here to make sure we don't
9771 call x_set_offset a second time
9772 if we get to x_make_frame_visible a second time
9773 before the window gets really visible. */
9774 if (! FRAME_ICONIFIED_P (f)
9775 && ! FRAME_X_EMBEDDED_P (f)
9776 && ! f->output_data.x->asked_for_visible)
9777 x_set_offset (f, f->left_pos, f->top_pos, 0);
9778
9779 f->output_data.x->asked_for_visible = 1;
9780
9781 if (! EQ (Vx_no_window_manager, Qt))
9782 x_wm_set_window_state (f, NormalState);
9783 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
9784 if (FRAME_X_EMBEDDED_P (f))
9785 xembed_set_info (f, XEMBED_MAPPED);
9786 else
9787 {
9788 /* This was XtPopup, but that did nothing for an iconified frame. */
9789 XtMapWidget (f->output_data.x->widget);
9790 }
9791 #else /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
9792 #ifdef USE_GTK
9793 gtk_widget_show_all (FRAME_GTK_OUTER_WIDGET (f));
9794 gtk_window_deiconify (GTK_WINDOW (FRAME_GTK_OUTER_WIDGET (f)));
9795 #else
9796 if (FRAME_X_EMBEDDED_P (f))
9797 xembed_set_info (f, XEMBED_MAPPED);
9798 else
9799 XMapRaised (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f));
9800 #endif /* not USE_GTK */
9801 #endif /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
9802 }
9803
9804 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
9805
9806 /* Synchronize to ensure Emacs knows the frame is visible
9807 before we do anything else. We do this loop with input not blocked
9808 so that incoming events are handled. */
9809 {
9810 Lisp_Object frame;
9811 /* This must be before UNBLOCK_INPUT
9812 since events that arrive in response to the actions above
9813 will set it when they are handled. */
9814 int previously_visible = f->output_data.x->has_been_visible;
9815
9816 original_left = f->left_pos;
9817 original_top = f->top_pos;
9818
9819 /* This must come after we set COUNT. */
9820 unblock_input ();
9821
9822 /* We unblock here so that arriving X events are processed. */
9823
9824 /* Now move the window back to where it was "supposed to be".
9825 But don't do it if the gravity is negative.
9826 When the gravity is negative, this uses a position
9827 that is 3 pixels too low. Perhaps that's really the border width.
9828
9829 Don't do this if the window has never been visible before,
9830 because the window manager may choose the position
9831 and we don't want to override it. */
9832
9833 if (! FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f)
9834 && ! FRAME_ICONIFIED_P (f)
9835 && ! FRAME_X_EMBEDDED_P (f)
9836 && f->win_gravity == NorthWestGravity
9837 && previously_visible)
9838 {
9839 Drawable rootw;
9840 int x, y;
9841 unsigned int width, height, border, depth;
9842
9843 block_input ();
9844
9845 /* On some window managers (such as FVWM) moving an existing
9846 window, even to the same place, causes the window manager
9847 to introduce an offset. This can cause the window to move
9848 to an unexpected location. Check the geometry (a little
9849 slow here) and then verify that the window is in the right
9850 place. If the window is not in the right place, move it
9851 there, and take the potential window manager hit. */
9852 XGetGeometry (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f),
9853 &rootw, &x, &y, &width, &height, &border, &depth);
9854
9855 if (original_left != x || original_top != y)
9856 XMoveWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f),
9857 original_left, original_top);
9858
9859 unblock_input ();
9860 }
9861
9862 XSETFRAME (frame, f);
9863
9864 /* Process X events until a MapNotify event has been seen. */
9865 while (!FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f))
9866 {
9867 /* Force processing of queued events. */
9868 x_sync (f);
9869
9870 /* If on another desktop, the deiconify/map may be ignored and the
9871 frame never becomes visible. XMonad does this.
9872 Prevent an endless loop. */
9873 if (FRAME_ICONIFIED_P (f) && ++tries > 100)
9874 break;
9875
9876 /* This hack is still in use at least for Cygwin. See
9877 http://lists.gnu.org/archive/html/emacs-devel/2013-12/msg00351.html.
9878
9879 Machines that do polling rather than SIGIO have been
9880 observed to go into a busy-wait here. So we'll fake an
9881 alarm signal to let the handler know that there's something
9882 to be read. We used to raise a real alarm, but it seems
9883 that the handler isn't always enabled here. This is
9884 probably a bug. */
9885 if (input_polling_used ())
9886 {
9887 /* It could be confusing if a real alarm arrives while
9888 processing the fake one. Turn it off and let the
9889 handler reset it. */
9890 int old_poll_suppress_count = poll_suppress_count;
9891 poll_suppress_count = 1;
9892 poll_for_input_1 ();
9893 poll_suppress_count = old_poll_suppress_count;
9894 }
9895
9896 if (XPending (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f)))
9897 {
9898 XEvent xev;
9899 XNextEvent (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), &xev);
9900 x_dispatch_event (&xev, FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
9901 }
9902 }
9903 }
9904 }
9905
9906 /* Change from mapped state to withdrawn state. */
9907
9908 /* Make the frame visible (mapped and not iconified). */
9909
9910 void
9911 x_make_frame_invisible (struct frame *f)
9912 {
9913 Window window;
9914
9915 /* Use the frame's outermost window, not the one we normally draw on. */
9916 window = FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f);
9917
9918 /* Don't keep the highlight on an invisible frame. */
9919 if (FRAME_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->x_highlight_frame == f)
9920 FRAME_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->x_highlight_frame = 0;
9921
9922 block_input ();
9923
9924 /* Before unmapping the window, update the WM_SIZE_HINTS property to claim
9925 that the current position of the window is user-specified, rather than
9926 program-specified, so that when the window is mapped again, it will be
9927 placed at the same location, without forcing the user to position it
9928 by hand again (they have already done that once for this window.) */
9929 x_wm_set_size_hint (f, 0, 1);
9930
9931 #ifdef USE_GTK
9932 if (FRAME_GTK_OUTER_WIDGET (f))
9933 gtk_widget_hide (FRAME_GTK_OUTER_WIDGET (f));
9934 else
9935 #else
9936 if (FRAME_X_EMBEDDED_P (f))
9937 xembed_set_info (f, 0);
9938 else
9939 #endif
9940 {
9941
9942 if (! XWithdrawWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), window,
9943 DefaultScreen (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f))))
9944 {
9945 unblock_input ();
9946 error ("Can't notify window manager of window withdrawal");
9947 }
9948 }
9949
9950 /* We can't distinguish this from iconification
9951 just by the event that we get from the server.
9952 So we can't win using the usual strategy of letting
9953 FRAME_SAMPLE_VISIBILITY set this. So do it by hand,
9954 and synchronize with the server to make sure we agree. */
9955 SET_FRAME_VISIBLE (f, 0);
9956 SET_FRAME_ICONIFIED (f, 0);
9957
9958 x_sync (f);
9959
9960 unblock_input ();
9961 }
9962
9963 /* Change window state from mapped to iconified. */
9964
9965 void
9966 x_iconify_frame (struct frame *f)
9967 {
9968 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
9969 int result;
9970 #endif
9971
9972 /* Don't keep the highlight on an invisible frame. */
9973 if (FRAME_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->x_highlight_frame == f)
9974 FRAME_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->x_highlight_frame = 0;
9975
9976 if (FRAME_ICONIFIED_P (f))
9977 return;
9978
9979 block_input ();
9980
9981 x_set_bitmap_icon (f);
9982
9983 #if defined (USE_GTK)
9984 if (FRAME_GTK_OUTER_WIDGET (f))
9985 {
9986 if (! FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f))
9987 gtk_widget_show_all (FRAME_GTK_OUTER_WIDGET (f));
9988
9989 gtk_window_iconify (GTK_WINDOW (FRAME_GTK_OUTER_WIDGET (f)));
9990 SET_FRAME_VISIBLE (f, 0);
9991 SET_FRAME_ICONIFIED (f, 1);
9992 unblock_input ();
9993 return;
9994 }
9995 #endif
9996
9997 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
9998
9999 if (! FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f))
10000 {
10001 if (! EQ (Vx_no_window_manager, Qt))
10002 x_wm_set_window_state (f, IconicState);
10003 /* This was XtPopup, but that did nothing for an iconified frame. */
10004 XtMapWidget (f->output_data.x->widget);
10005 /* The server won't give us any event to indicate
10006 that an invisible frame was changed to an icon,
10007 so we have to record it here. */
10008 SET_FRAME_VISIBLE (f, 0);
10009 SET_FRAME_ICONIFIED (f, 1);
10010 unblock_input ();
10011 return;
10012 }
10013
10014 result = XIconifyWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f),
10015 XtWindow (f->output_data.x->widget),
10016 DefaultScreen (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f)));
10017 unblock_input ();
10018
10019 if (!result)
10020 error ("Can't notify window manager of iconification");
10021
10022 SET_FRAME_ICONIFIED (f, 1);
10023 SET_FRAME_VISIBLE (f, 0);
10024
10025 block_input ();
10026 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
10027 unblock_input ();
10028 #else /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
10029
10030 /* Make sure the X server knows where the window should be positioned,
10031 in case the user deiconifies with the window manager. */
10032 if (! FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f)
10033 && ! FRAME_ICONIFIED_P (f)
10034 && ! FRAME_X_EMBEDDED_P (f))
10035 x_set_offset (f, f->left_pos, f->top_pos, 0);
10036
10037 /* Since we don't know which revision of X we're running, we'll use both
10038 the X11R3 and X11R4 techniques. I don't know if this is a good idea. */
10039
10040 /* X11R4: send a ClientMessage to the window manager using the
10041 WM_CHANGE_STATE type. */
10042 {
10043 XEvent msg;
10044
10045 msg.xclient.window = FRAME_X_WINDOW (f);
10046 msg.xclient.type = ClientMessage;
10047 msg.xclient.message_type = FRAME_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->Xatom_wm_change_state;
10048 msg.xclient.format = 32;
10049 msg.xclient.data.l[0] = IconicState;
10050
10051 if (! XSendEvent (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f),
10052 DefaultRootWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f)),
10053 False,
10054 SubstructureRedirectMask | SubstructureNotifyMask,
10055 &msg))
10056 {
10057 unblock_input ();
10058 error ("Can't notify window manager of iconification");
10059 }
10060 }
10061
10062 /* X11R3: set the initial_state field of the window manager hints to
10063 IconicState. */
10064 x_wm_set_window_state (f, IconicState);
10065
10066 if (!FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f))
10067 {
10068 /* If the frame was withdrawn, before, we must map it. */
10069 XMapRaised (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f));
10070 }
10071
10072 SET_FRAME_ICONIFIED (f, 1);
10073 SET_FRAME_VISIBLE (f, 0);
10074
10075 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
10076 unblock_input ();
10077 #endif /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
10078 }
10079
10080 \f
10081 /* Free X resources of frame F. */
10082
10083 void
10084 x_free_frame_resources (struct frame *f)
10085 {
10086 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
10087 Mouse_HLInfo *hlinfo = &dpyinfo->mouse_highlight;
10088 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
10089 Lisp_Object bar;
10090 struct scroll_bar *b;
10091 #endif
10092
10093 block_input ();
10094
10095 /* If a display connection is dead, don't try sending more
10096 commands to the X server. */
10097 if (dpyinfo->display)
10098 {
10099 /* Always exit with visible pointer to avoid weird issue
10100 with Xfixes (Bug#17609). */
10101 if (f->pointer_invisible)
10102 FRAME_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->toggle_visible_pointer (f, 0);
10103
10104 /* We must free faces before destroying windows because some
10105 font-driver (e.g. xft) access a window while finishing a
10106 face. */
10107 free_frame_faces (f);
10108
10109 if (f->output_data.x->icon_desc)
10110 XDestroyWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), f->output_data.x->icon_desc);
10111
10112 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
10113 /* Explicitly destroy the scroll bars of the frame. Without
10114 this, we get "BadDrawable" errors from the toolkit later on,
10115 presumably from expose events generated for the disappearing
10116 toolkit scroll bars. */
10117 for (bar = FRAME_SCROLL_BARS (f); !NILP (bar); bar = b->next)
10118 {
10119 b = XSCROLL_BAR (bar);
10120 x_scroll_bar_remove (b);
10121 }
10122 #endif
10123
10124 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
10125 if (FRAME_XIC (f))
10126 free_frame_xic (f);
10127 #endif
10128
10129 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
10130 if (f->output_data.x->widget)
10131 {
10132 XtDestroyWidget (f->output_data.x->widget);
10133 f->output_data.x->widget = NULL;
10134 }
10135 /* Tooltips don't have widgets, only a simple X window, even if
10136 we are using a toolkit. */
10137 else if (FRAME_X_WINDOW (f))
10138 XDestroyWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f));
10139
10140 free_frame_menubar (f);
10141
10142 if (f->shell_position)
10143 xfree (f->shell_position);
10144 #else /* !USE_X_TOOLKIT */
10145
10146 #ifdef USE_GTK
10147 xg_free_frame_widgets (f);
10148 #endif /* USE_GTK */
10149
10150 if (FRAME_X_WINDOW (f))
10151 XDestroyWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f));
10152 #endif /* !USE_X_TOOLKIT */
10153
10154 unload_color (f, FRAME_FOREGROUND_PIXEL (f));
10155 unload_color (f, FRAME_BACKGROUND_PIXEL (f));
10156 unload_color (f, f->output_data.x->cursor_pixel);
10157 unload_color (f, f->output_data.x->cursor_foreground_pixel);
10158 unload_color (f, f->output_data.x->border_pixel);
10159 unload_color (f, f->output_data.x->mouse_pixel);
10160
10161 if (f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_background_pixel != -1)
10162 unload_color (f, f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_background_pixel);
10163 if (f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_foreground_pixel != -1)
10164 unload_color (f, f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_foreground_pixel);
10165 #if defined (USE_LUCID) && defined (USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS)
10166 /* Scrollbar shadow colors. */
10167 if (f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_top_shadow_pixel != -1)
10168 unload_color (f, f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_top_shadow_pixel);
10169 if (f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_bottom_shadow_pixel != -1)
10170 unload_color (f, f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_bottom_shadow_pixel);
10171 #endif /* USE_LUCID && USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
10172 if (f->output_data.x->white_relief.pixel != -1)
10173 unload_color (f, f->output_data.x->white_relief.pixel);
10174 if (f->output_data.x->black_relief.pixel != -1)
10175 unload_color (f, f->output_data.x->black_relief.pixel);
10176
10177 x_free_gcs (f);
10178
10179 /* Free extra GCs allocated by x_setup_relief_colors. */
10180 if (f->output_data.x->white_relief.gc)
10181 {
10182 XFreeGC (dpyinfo->display, f->output_data.x->white_relief.gc);
10183 f->output_data.x->white_relief.gc = 0;
10184 }
10185 if (f->output_data.x->black_relief.gc)
10186 {
10187 XFreeGC (dpyinfo->display, f->output_data.x->black_relief.gc);
10188 f->output_data.x->black_relief.gc = 0;
10189 }
10190
10191 /* Free cursors. */
10192 if (f->output_data.x->text_cursor != 0)
10193 XFreeCursor (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), f->output_data.x->text_cursor);
10194 if (f->output_data.x->nontext_cursor != 0)
10195 XFreeCursor (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), f->output_data.x->nontext_cursor);
10196 if (f->output_data.x->modeline_cursor != 0)
10197 XFreeCursor (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), f->output_data.x->modeline_cursor);
10198 if (f->output_data.x->hand_cursor != 0)
10199 XFreeCursor (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), f->output_data.x->hand_cursor);
10200 if (f->output_data.x->hourglass_cursor != 0)
10201 XFreeCursor (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), f->output_data.x->hourglass_cursor);
10202 if (f->output_data.x->horizontal_drag_cursor != 0)
10203 XFreeCursor (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), f->output_data.x->horizontal_drag_cursor);
10204 if (f->output_data.x->vertical_drag_cursor != 0)
10205 XFreeCursor (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), f->output_data.x->vertical_drag_cursor);
10206
10207 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
10208 }
10209
10210 xfree (f->output_data.x->saved_menu_event);
10211 xfree (f->output_data.x);
10212 f->output_data.x = NULL;
10213
10214 if (f == dpyinfo->x_focus_frame)
10215 dpyinfo->x_focus_frame = 0;
10216 if (f == dpyinfo->x_focus_event_frame)
10217 dpyinfo->x_focus_event_frame = 0;
10218 if (f == dpyinfo->x_highlight_frame)
10219 dpyinfo->x_highlight_frame = 0;
10220 if (f == hlinfo->mouse_face_mouse_frame)
10221 reset_mouse_highlight (hlinfo);
10222
10223 unblock_input ();
10224 }
10225
10226
10227 /* Destroy the X window of frame F. */
10228
10229 static void
10230 x_destroy_window (struct frame *f)
10231 {
10232 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
10233
10234 /* If a display connection is dead, don't try sending more
10235 commands to the X server. */
10236 if (dpyinfo->display != 0)
10237 x_free_frame_resources (f);
10238
10239 dpyinfo->reference_count--;
10240 }
10241
10242 \f
10243 /* Setting window manager hints. */
10244
10245 /* Set the normal size hints for the window manager, for frame F.
10246 FLAGS is the flags word to use--or 0 meaning preserve the flags
10247 that the window now has.
10248 If USER_POSITION, set the USPosition
10249 flag (this is useful when FLAGS is 0).
10250 The GTK version is in gtkutils.c. */
10251
10252 #ifndef USE_GTK
10253 void
10254 x_wm_set_size_hint (struct frame *f, long flags, bool user_position)
10255 {
10256 XSizeHints size_hints;
10257 Window window = FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f);
10258
10259 if (!window)
10260 return;
10261
10262 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
10263 if (f->output_data.x->widget)
10264 {
10265 widget_update_wm_size_hints (f->output_data.x->widget);
10266 return;
10267 }
10268 #endif
10269
10270 /* Setting PMaxSize caused various problems. */
10271 size_hints.flags = PResizeInc | PMinSize /* | PMaxSize */;
10272
10273 size_hints.x = f->left_pos;
10274 size_hints.y = f->top_pos;
10275
10276 size_hints.height = FRAME_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f);
10277 size_hints.width = FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f);
10278
10279 size_hints.width_inc = frame_resize_pixelwise ? 1 : FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (f);
10280 size_hints.height_inc = frame_resize_pixelwise ? 1 : FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (f);
10281
10282 size_hints.max_width = x_display_pixel_width (FRAME_DISPLAY_INFO (f))
10283 - FRAME_TEXT_COLS_TO_PIXEL_WIDTH (f, 0);
10284 size_hints.max_height = x_display_pixel_height (FRAME_DISPLAY_INFO (f))
10285 - FRAME_TEXT_LINES_TO_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f, 0);
10286
10287 /* Calculate the base and minimum sizes. */
10288 {
10289 int base_width, base_height;
10290 int min_rows = 0, min_cols = 0;
10291
10292 base_width = FRAME_TEXT_COLS_TO_PIXEL_WIDTH (f, 0);
10293 base_height = FRAME_TEXT_LINES_TO_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f, 0);
10294
10295 if (frame_resize_pixelwise)
10296 /* Needed to prevent a bad protocol error crash when making the
10297 frame size very small. */
10298 {
10299 min_cols = 2 * min_cols;
10300 min_rows = 2 * min_rows;
10301 }
10302
10303 /* The window manager uses the base width hints to calculate the
10304 current number of rows and columns in the frame while
10305 resizing; min_width and min_height aren't useful for this
10306 purpose, since they might not give the dimensions for a
10307 zero-row, zero-column frame.
10308
10309 We use the base_width and base_height members if we have
10310 them; otherwise, we set the min_width and min_height members
10311 to the size for a zero x zero frame. */
10312
10313 size_hints.flags |= PBaseSize;
10314 size_hints.base_width = base_width;
10315 size_hints.base_height = base_height + FRAME_MENUBAR_HEIGHT (f);
10316 size_hints.min_width = base_width + min_cols * FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (f);
10317 size_hints.min_height = base_height + min_rows * FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (f);
10318 }
10319
10320 /* If we don't need the old flags, we don't need the old hint at all. */
10321 if (flags)
10322 {
10323 size_hints.flags |= flags;
10324 goto no_read;
10325 }
10326
10327 {
10328 XSizeHints hints; /* Sometimes I hate X Windows... */
10329 long supplied_return;
10330 int value;
10331
10332 value = XGetWMNormalHints (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), window, &hints,
10333 &supplied_return);
10334
10335 if (flags)
10336 size_hints.flags |= flags;
10337 else
10338 {
10339 if (value == 0)
10340 hints.flags = 0;
10341 if (hints.flags & PSize)
10342 size_hints.flags |= PSize;
10343 if (hints.flags & PPosition)
10344 size_hints.flags |= PPosition;
10345 if (hints.flags & USPosition)
10346 size_hints.flags |= USPosition;
10347 if (hints.flags & USSize)
10348 size_hints.flags |= USSize;
10349 }
10350 }
10351
10352 no_read:
10353
10354 #ifdef PWinGravity
10355 size_hints.win_gravity = f->win_gravity;
10356 size_hints.flags |= PWinGravity;
10357
10358 if (user_position)
10359 {
10360 size_hints.flags &= ~ PPosition;
10361 size_hints.flags |= USPosition;
10362 }
10363 #endif /* PWinGravity */
10364
10365 XSetWMNormalHints (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), window, &size_hints);
10366 }
10367 #endif /* not USE_GTK */
10368
10369 /* Used for IconicState or NormalState */
10370
10371 static void
10372 x_wm_set_window_state (struct frame *f, int state)
10373 {
10374 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
10375 Arg al[1];
10376
10377 XtSetArg (al[0], XtNinitialState, state);
10378 XtSetValues (f->output_data.x->widget, al, 1);
10379 #else /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
10380 Window window = FRAME_X_WINDOW (f);
10381
10382 f->output_data.x->wm_hints.flags |= StateHint;
10383 f->output_data.x->wm_hints.initial_state = state;
10384
10385 XSetWMHints (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), window, &f->output_data.x->wm_hints);
10386 #endif /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
10387 }
10388
10389 static void
10390 x_wm_set_icon_pixmap (struct frame *f, ptrdiff_t pixmap_id)
10391 {
10392 Pixmap icon_pixmap, icon_mask;
10393
10394 #if !defined USE_X_TOOLKIT && !defined USE_GTK
10395 Window window = FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f);
10396 #endif
10397
10398 if (pixmap_id > 0)
10399 {
10400 icon_pixmap = x_bitmap_pixmap (f, pixmap_id);
10401 f->output_data.x->wm_hints.icon_pixmap = icon_pixmap;
10402 icon_mask = x_bitmap_mask (f, pixmap_id);
10403 f->output_data.x->wm_hints.icon_mask = icon_mask;
10404 }
10405 else
10406 {
10407 /* It seems there is no way to turn off use of an icon
10408 pixmap. */
10409 return;
10410 }
10411
10412
10413 #ifdef USE_GTK
10414 {
10415 xg_set_frame_icon (f, icon_pixmap, icon_mask);
10416 return;
10417 }
10418
10419 #elif defined (USE_X_TOOLKIT) /* same as in x_wm_set_window_state. */
10420
10421 {
10422 Arg al[1];
10423 XtSetArg (al[0], XtNiconPixmap, icon_pixmap);
10424 XtSetValues (f->output_data.x->widget, al, 1);
10425 XtSetArg (al[0], XtNiconMask, icon_mask);
10426 XtSetValues (f->output_data.x->widget, al, 1);
10427 }
10428
10429 #else /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT && not USE_GTK */
10430
10431 f->output_data.x->wm_hints.flags |= (IconPixmapHint | IconMaskHint);
10432 XSetWMHints (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), window, &f->output_data.x->wm_hints);
10433
10434 #endif /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT && not USE_GTK */
10435 }
10436
10437 void
10438 x_wm_set_icon_position (struct frame *f, int icon_x, int icon_y)
10439 {
10440 Window window = FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f);
10441
10442 f->output_data.x->wm_hints.flags |= IconPositionHint;
10443 f->output_data.x->wm_hints.icon_x = icon_x;
10444 f->output_data.x->wm_hints.icon_y = icon_y;
10445
10446 XSetWMHints (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), window, &f->output_data.x->wm_hints);
10447 }
10448
10449 \f
10450 /***********************************************************************
10451 Fonts
10452 ***********************************************************************/
10453
10454 #ifdef GLYPH_DEBUG
10455
10456 /* Check that FONT is valid on frame F. It is if it can be found in F's
10457 font table. */
10458
10459 static void
10460 x_check_font (struct frame *f, struct font *font)
10461 {
10462 eassert (font != NULL && ! NILP (font->props[FONT_TYPE_INDEX]));
10463 if (font->driver->check)
10464 eassert (font->driver->check (f, font) == 0);
10465 }
10466
10467 #endif /* GLYPH_DEBUG */
10468
10469 \f
10470 /***********************************************************************
10471 Initialization
10472 ***********************************************************************/
10473
10474 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
10475 static XrmOptionDescRec emacs_options[] = {
10476 {"-geometry", ".geometry", XrmoptionSepArg, NULL},
10477 {"-iconic", ".iconic", XrmoptionNoArg, (XtPointer) "yes"},
10478
10479 {"-internal-border-width", "*EmacsScreen.internalBorderWidth",
10480 XrmoptionSepArg, NULL},
10481 {"-ib", "*EmacsScreen.internalBorderWidth", XrmoptionSepArg, NULL},
10482
10483 {"-T", "*EmacsShell.title", XrmoptionSepArg, (XtPointer) NULL},
10484 {"-wn", "*EmacsShell.title", XrmoptionSepArg, (XtPointer) NULL},
10485 {"-title", "*EmacsShell.title", XrmoptionSepArg, (XtPointer) NULL},
10486 {"-iconname", "*EmacsShell.iconName", XrmoptionSepArg, (XtPointer) NULL},
10487 {"-in", "*EmacsShell.iconName", XrmoptionSepArg, (XtPointer) NULL},
10488 {"-mc", "*pointerColor", XrmoptionSepArg, (XtPointer) NULL},
10489 {"-cr", "*cursorColor", XrmoptionSepArg, (XtPointer) NULL}
10490 };
10491
10492 /* Whether atimer for Xt timeouts is activated or not. */
10493
10494 static int x_timeout_atimer_activated_flag;
10495
10496 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
10497
10498 static int x_initialized;
10499
10500 /* Test whether two display-name strings agree up to the dot that separates
10501 the screen number from the server number. */
10502 static int
10503 same_x_server (const char *name1, const char *name2)
10504 {
10505 int seen_colon = 0;
10506 const char *system_name = SSDATA (Vsystem_name);
10507 ptrdiff_t system_name_length = SBYTES (Vsystem_name);
10508 ptrdiff_t length_until_period = 0;
10509
10510 while (system_name[length_until_period] != 0
10511 && system_name[length_until_period] != '.')
10512 length_until_period++;
10513
10514 /* Treat `unix' like an empty host name. */
10515 if (! strncmp (name1, "unix:", 5))
10516 name1 += 4;
10517 if (! strncmp (name2, "unix:", 5))
10518 name2 += 4;
10519 /* Treat this host's name like an empty host name. */
10520 if (! strncmp (name1, system_name, system_name_length)
10521 && name1[system_name_length] == ':')
10522 name1 += system_name_length;
10523 if (! strncmp (name2, system_name, system_name_length)
10524 && name2[system_name_length] == ':')
10525 name2 += system_name_length;
10526 /* Treat this host's domainless name like an empty host name. */
10527 if (! strncmp (name1, system_name, length_until_period)
10528 && name1[length_until_period] == ':')
10529 name1 += length_until_period;
10530 if (! strncmp (name2, system_name, length_until_period)
10531 && name2[length_until_period] == ':')
10532 name2 += length_until_period;
10533
10534 for (; *name1 != '\0' && *name1 == *name2; name1++, name2++)
10535 {
10536 if (*name1 == ':')
10537 seen_colon = 1;
10538 if (seen_colon && *name1 == '.')
10539 return 1;
10540 }
10541 return (seen_colon
10542 && (*name1 == '.' || *name1 == '\0')
10543 && (*name2 == '.' || *name2 == '\0'));
10544 }
10545
10546 /* Count number of set bits in mask and number of bits to shift to
10547 get to the first bit. With MASK 0x7e0, *BITS is set to 6, and *OFFSET
10548 to 5. */
10549 static void
10550 get_bits_and_offset (unsigned long mask, int *bits, int *offset)
10551 {
10552 int nr = 0;
10553 int off = 0;
10554
10555 while (!(mask & 1))
10556 {
10557 off++;
10558 mask >>= 1;
10559 }
10560
10561 while (mask & 1)
10562 {
10563 nr++;
10564 mask >>= 1;
10565 }
10566
10567 *offset = off;
10568 *bits = nr;
10569 }
10570
10571 /* Return 1 if display DISPLAY is available for use, 0 otherwise.
10572 But don't permanently open it, just test its availability. */
10573
10574 bool
10575 x_display_ok (const char *display)
10576 {
10577 Display *dpy = XOpenDisplay (display);
10578 return dpy ? (XCloseDisplay (dpy), 1) : 0;
10579 }
10580
10581 #ifdef USE_GTK
10582 static void
10583 my_log_handler (const gchar *log_domain, GLogLevelFlags log_level,
10584 const gchar *msg, gpointer user_data)
10585 {
10586 if (!strstr (msg, "g_set_prgname"))
10587 fprintf (stderr, "%s-WARNING **: %s\n", log_domain, msg);
10588 }
10589 #endif
10590
10591 /* Create invisible cursor on X display referred by DPYINFO. */
10592
10593 static Cursor
10594 make_invisible_cursor (struct x_display_info *dpyinfo)
10595 {
10596 Display *dpy = dpyinfo->display;
10597 static char const no_data[] = { 0 };
10598 Pixmap pix;
10599 XColor col;
10600 Cursor c = 0;
10601
10602 x_catch_errors (dpy);
10603 pix = XCreateBitmapFromData (dpy, dpyinfo->root_window, no_data, 1, 1);
10604 if (! x_had_errors_p (dpy) && pix != None)
10605 {
10606 Cursor pixc;
10607 col.pixel = 0;
10608 col.red = col.green = col.blue = 0;
10609 col.flags = DoRed | DoGreen | DoBlue;
10610 pixc = XCreatePixmapCursor (dpy, pix, pix, &col, &col, 0, 0);
10611 if (! x_had_errors_p (dpy) && pixc != None)
10612 c = pixc;
10613 XFreePixmap (dpy, pix);
10614 }
10615
10616 x_uncatch_errors ();
10617
10618 return c;
10619 }
10620
10621 /* True if DPY supports Xfixes extension >= 4. */
10622
10623 static bool
10624 x_probe_xfixes_extension (Display *dpy)
10625 {
10626 #ifdef HAVE_XFIXES
10627 int major, minor;
10628 return XFixesQueryVersion (dpy, &major, &minor) && major >= 4;
10629 #else
10630 return false;
10631 #endif /* HAVE_XFIXES */
10632 }
10633
10634 /* Toggle mouse pointer visibility on frame F by using Xfixes functions. */
10635
10636 static void
10637 xfixes_toggle_visible_pointer (struct frame *f, bool invisible)
10638 {
10639 #ifdef HAVE_XFIXES
10640 if (invisible)
10641 XFixesHideCursor (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f));
10642 else
10643 XFixesShowCursor (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f));
10644 f->pointer_invisible = invisible;
10645 #else
10646 emacs_abort ();
10647 #endif /* HAVE_XFIXES */
10648 }
10649
10650 /* Toggle mouse pointer visibility on frame F by using invisible cursor. */
10651
10652 static void
10653 x_toggle_visible_pointer (struct frame *f, bool invisible)
10654 {
10655 eassert (FRAME_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->invisible_cursor != 0);
10656 if (invisible)
10657 XDefineCursor (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
10658 FRAME_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->invisible_cursor);
10659 else
10660 XDefineCursor (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
10661 f->output_data.x->current_cursor);
10662 f->pointer_invisible = invisible;
10663 }
10664
10665 /* Setup pointer blanking, prefer Xfixes if available. */
10666
10667 static void
10668 x_setup_pointer_blanking (struct x_display_info *dpyinfo)
10669 {
10670 /* FIXME: the brave tester should set EMACS_XFIXES because we're suspecting
10671 X server bug, see http://debbugs.gnu.org/cgi/bugreport.cgi?bug=17609. */
10672 if (egetenv ("EMACS_XFIXES") && x_probe_xfixes_extension (dpyinfo->display))
10673 dpyinfo->toggle_visible_pointer = xfixes_toggle_visible_pointer;
10674 else
10675 {
10676 dpyinfo->toggle_visible_pointer = x_toggle_visible_pointer;
10677 dpyinfo->invisible_cursor = make_invisible_cursor (dpyinfo);
10678 }
10679 }
10680
10681 /* Current X display connection identifier. Incremented for each next
10682 connection established. */
10683 static unsigned x_display_id;
10684
10685 /* Open a connection to X display DISPLAY_NAME, and return
10686 the structure that describes the open display.
10687 If we cannot contact the display, return null. */
10688
10689 struct x_display_info *
10690 x_term_init (Lisp_Object display_name, char *xrm_option, char *resource_name)
10691 {
10692 Display *dpy;
10693 struct terminal *terminal;
10694 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
10695 XrmDatabase xrdb;
10696 ptrdiff_t lim;
10697
10698 block_input ();
10699
10700 if (!x_initialized)
10701 {
10702 x_initialize ();
10703 ++x_initialized;
10704 }
10705
10706 if (! x_display_ok (SSDATA (display_name)))
10707 error ("Display %s can't be opened", SSDATA (display_name));
10708
10709 #ifdef USE_GTK
10710 {
10711 #define NUM_ARGV 10
10712 int argc;
10713 char *argv[NUM_ARGV];
10714 char **argv2 = argv;
10715 guint id;
10716
10717 if (x_initialized++ > 1)
10718 {
10719 xg_display_open (SSDATA (display_name), &dpy);
10720 }
10721 else
10722 {
10723 static char display_opt[] = "--display";
10724 static char name_opt[] = "--name";
10725
10726 for (argc = 0; argc < NUM_ARGV; ++argc)
10727 argv[argc] = 0;
10728
10729 argc = 0;
10730 argv[argc++] = initial_argv[0];
10731
10732 if (! NILP (display_name))
10733 {
10734 argv[argc++] = display_opt;
10735 argv[argc++] = SSDATA (display_name);
10736 }
10737
10738 argv[argc++] = name_opt;
10739 argv[argc++] = resource_name;
10740
10741 XSetLocaleModifiers ("");
10742
10743 /* Emacs can only handle core input events, so make sure
10744 Gtk doesn't use Xinput or Xinput2 extensions. */
10745 xputenv ("GDK_CORE_DEVICE_EVENTS=1");
10746
10747 /* Work around GLib bug that outputs a faulty warning. See
10748 https://bugzilla.gnome.org/show_bug.cgi?id=563627. */
10749 id = g_log_set_handler ("GLib", G_LOG_LEVEL_WARNING | G_LOG_FLAG_FATAL
10750 | G_LOG_FLAG_RECURSION, my_log_handler, NULL);
10751
10752 /* NULL window -> events for all windows go to our function.
10753 Call before gtk_init so Gtk+ event filters comes after our. */
10754 gdk_window_add_filter (NULL, event_handler_gdk, NULL);
10755
10756 /* gtk_init does set_locale. Fix locale before and after. */
10757 fixup_locale ();
10758 gtk_init (&argc, &argv2);
10759 fixup_locale ();
10760
10761 g_log_remove_handler ("GLib", id);
10762
10763 xg_initialize ();
10764
10765 dpy = DEFAULT_GDK_DISPLAY ();
10766
10767 #if ! GTK_CHECK_VERSION (2, 90, 0)
10768 /* Load our own gtkrc if it exists. */
10769 {
10770 const char *file = "~/.emacs.d/gtkrc";
10771 Lisp_Object s, abs_file;
10772
10773 s = build_string (file);
10774 abs_file = Fexpand_file_name (s, Qnil);
10775
10776 if (! NILP (abs_file) && !NILP (Ffile_readable_p (abs_file)))
10777 gtk_rc_parse (SSDATA (abs_file));
10778 }
10779 #endif
10780
10781 XSetErrorHandler (x_error_handler);
10782 XSetIOErrorHandler (x_io_error_quitter);
10783 }
10784 }
10785 #else /* not USE_GTK */
10786 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
10787 /* weiner@footloose.sps.mot.com reports that this causes
10788 errors with X11R5:
10789 X protocol error: BadAtom (invalid Atom parameter)
10790 on protocol request 18skiloaf.
10791 So let's not use it until R6. */
10792 #ifdef HAVE_X11XTR6
10793 XtSetLanguageProc (NULL, NULL, NULL);
10794 #endif
10795
10796 {
10797 int argc = 0;
10798 char *argv[3];
10799
10800 argv[0] = "";
10801 argc = 1;
10802 if (xrm_option)
10803 {
10804 argv[argc++] = "-xrm";
10805 argv[argc++] = xrm_option;
10806 }
10807 turn_on_atimers (0);
10808 dpy = XtOpenDisplay (Xt_app_con, SSDATA (display_name),
10809 resource_name, EMACS_CLASS,
10810 emacs_options, XtNumber (emacs_options),
10811 &argc, argv);
10812 turn_on_atimers (1);
10813
10814 #ifdef HAVE_X11XTR6
10815 /* I think this is to compensate for XtSetLanguageProc. */
10816 fixup_locale ();
10817 #endif
10818 }
10819
10820 #else /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
10821 XSetLocaleModifiers ("");
10822 dpy = XOpenDisplay (SSDATA (display_name));
10823 #endif /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
10824 #endif /* not USE_GTK*/
10825
10826 /* Detect failure. */
10827 if (dpy == 0)
10828 {
10829 unblock_input ();
10830 return 0;
10831 }
10832
10833 /* We have definitely succeeded. Record the new connection. */
10834
10835 dpyinfo = xzalloc (sizeof *dpyinfo);
10836 terminal = x_create_terminal (dpyinfo);
10837
10838 {
10839 struct x_display_info *share;
10840
10841 for (share = x_display_list; share; share = share->next)
10842 if (same_x_server (SSDATA (XCAR (share->name_list_element)),
10843 SSDATA (display_name)))
10844 break;
10845 if (share)
10846 terminal->kboard = share->terminal->kboard;
10847 else
10848 {
10849 terminal->kboard = allocate_kboard (Qx);
10850
10851 if (!EQ (XSYMBOL (Qvendor_specific_keysyms)->function, Qunbound))
10852 {
10853 char *vendor = ServerVendor (dpy);
10854
10855 /* Protect terminal from GC before removing it from the
10856 list of terminals. */
10857 struct gcpro gcpro1;
10858 Lisp_Object gcpro_term;
10859 XSETTERMINAL (gcpro_term, terminal);
10860 GCPRO1 (gcpro_term);
10861
10862 /* Temporarily hide the partially initialized terminal. */
10863 terminal_list = terminal->next_terminal;
10864 unblock_input ();
10865 kset_system_key_alist
10866 (terminal->kboard,
10867 call1 (Qvendor_specific_keysyms,
10868 vendor ? build_string (vendor) : empty_unibyte_string));
10869 block_input ();
10870 terminal->next_terminal = terminal_list;
10871 terminal_list = terminal;
10872 UNGCPRO;
10873 }
10874
10875 /* Don't let the initial kboard remain current longer than necessary.
10876 That would cause problems if a file loaded on startup tries to
10877 prompt in the mini-buffer. */
10878 if (current_kboard == initial_kboard)
10879 current_kboard = terminal->kboard;
10880 }
10881 terminal->kboard->reference_count++;
10882 }
10883
10884 /* Put this display on the chain. */
10885 dpyinfo->next = x_display_list;
10886 x_display_list = dpyinfo;
10887
10888 dpyinfo->name_list_element = Fcons (display_name, Qnil);
10889 dpyinfo->display = dpy;
10890 dpyinfo->connection = ConnectionNumber (dpyinfo->display);
10891
10892 /* Set the name of the terminal. */
10893 terminal->name = xlispstrdup (display_name);
10894
10895 #if 0
10896 XSetAfterFunction (x_current_display, x_trace_wire);
10897 #endif /* ! 0 */
10898
10899 lim = min (PTRDIFF_MAX, SIZE_MAX) - sizeof "@";
10900 if (lim - SBYTES (Vinvocation_name) < SBYTES (Vsystem_name))
10901 memory_full (SIZE_MAX);
10902 dpyinfo->x_id = ++x_display_id;
10903 dpyinfo->x_id_name = xmalloc (SBYTES (Vinvocation_name)
10904 + SBYTES (Vsystem_name) + 2);
10905 char *nametail = lispstpcpy (dpyinfo->x_id_name, Vinvocation_name);
10906 *nametail++ = '@';
10907 lispstpcpy (nametail, Vsystem_name);
10908
10909 /* Figure out which modifier bits mean what. */
10910 x_find_modifier_meanings (dpyinfo);
10911
10912 /* Get the scroll bar cursor. */
10913 #ifdef USE_GTK
10914 /* We must create a GTK cursor, it is required for GTK widgets. */
10915 dpyinfo->xg_cursor = xg_create_default_cursor (dpyinfo->display);
10916 #endif /* USE_GTK */
10917
10918 dpyinfo->vertical_scroll_bar_cursor
10919 = XCreateFontCursor (dpyinfo->display, XC_sb_v_double_arrow);
10920
10921 dpyinfo->horizontal_scroll_bar_cursor
10922 = XCreateFontCursor (dpyinfo->display, XC_sb_h_double_arrow);
10923
10924 xrdb = x_load_resources (dpyinfo->display, xrm_option,
10925 resource_name, EMACS_CLASS);
10926 #ifdef HAVE_XRMSETDATABASE
10927 XrmSetDatabase (dpyinfo->display, xrdb);
10928 #else
10929 dpyinfo->display->db = xrdb;
10930 #endif
10931 /* Put the rdb where we can find it in a way that works on
10932 all versions. */
10933 dpyinfo->xrdb = xrdb;
10934
10935 dpyinfo->screen = ScreenOfDisplay (dpyinfo->display,
10936 DefaultScreen (dpyinfo->display));
10937 select_visual (dpyinfo);
10938 dpyinfo->cmap = DefaultColormapOfScreen (dpyinfo->screen);
10939 dpyinfo->root_window = RootWindowOfScreen (dpyinfo->screen);
10940 dpyinfo->icon_bitmap_id = -1;
10941 dpyinfo->wm_type = X_WMTYPE_UNKNOWN;
10942
10943 reset_mouse_highlight (&dpyinfo->mouse_highlight);
10944
10945 /* See if we can construct pixel values from RGB values. */
10946 if (dpyinfo->visual->class == TrueColor)
10947 {
10948 get_bits_and_offset (dpyinfo->visual->red_mask,
10949 &dpyinfo->red_bits, &dpyinfo->red_offset);
10950 get_bits_and_offset (dpyinfo->visual->blue_mask,
10951 &dpyinfo->blue_bits, &dpyinfo->blue_offset);
10952 get_bits_and_offset (dpyinfo->visual->green_mask,
10953 &dpyinfo->green_bits, &dpyinfo->green_offset);
10954 }
10955
10956 /* See if a private colormap is requested. */
10957 if (dpyinfo->visual == DefaultVisualOfScreen (dpyinfo->screen))
10958 {
10959 if (dpyinfo->visual->class == PseudoColor)
10960 {
10961 Lisp_Object value;
10962 value = display_x_get_resource
10963 (dpyinfo, build_local_string ("privateColormap"),
10964 build_local_string ("PrivateColormap"), Qnil, Qnil);
10965 if (STRINGP (value)
10966 && (!strcmp (SSDATA (value), "true")
10967 || !strcmp (SSDATA (value), "on")))
10968 dpyinfo->cmap = XCopyColormapAndFree (dpyinfo->display, dpyinfo->cmap);
10969 }
10970 }
10971 else
10972 dpyinfo->cmap = XCreateColormap (dpyinfo->display, dpyinfo->root_window,
10973 dpyinfo->visual, AllocNone);
10974
10975 #ifdef HAVE_XFT
10976 {
10977 /* If we are using Xft, the following precautions should be made:
10978
10979 1. Make sure that the Xrender extension is added before the Xft one.
10980 Otherwise, the close-display hook set by Xft is called after the one
10981 for Xrender, and the former tries to re-add the latter. This results
10982 in inconsistency of internal states and leads to X protocol error when
10983 one reconnects to the same X server (Bug#1696).
10984
10985 2. Check dpi value in X resources. It is better we use it as well,
10986 since Xft will use it, as will all Gnome applications. If our real DPI
10987 is smaller or larger than the one Xft uses, our font will look smaller
10988 or larger than other for other applications, even if it is the same
10989 font name (monospace-10 for example). */
10990
10991 int event_base, error_base;
10992 char *v;
10993 double d;
10994
10995 XRenderQueryExtension (dpyinfo->display, &event_base, &error_base);
10996
10997 v = XGetDefault (dpyinfo->display, "Xft", "dpi");
10998 if (v != NULL && sscanf (v, "%lf", &d) == 1)
10999 dpyinfo->resy = dpyinfo->resx = d;
11000 }
11001 #endif
11002
11003 if (dpyinfo->resy < 1)
11004 {
11005 int screen_number = XScreenNumberOfScreen (dpyinfo->screen);
11006 double pixels = DisplayHeight (dpyinfo->display, screen_number);
11007 double mm = DisplayHeightMM (dpyinfo->display, screen_number);
11008 /* Mac OS X 10.3's Xserver sometimes reports 0.0mm. */
11009 dpyinfo->resy = (mm < 1) ? 100 : pixels * 25.4 / mm;
11010 pixels = DisplayWidth (dpyinfo->display, screen_number);
11011 mm = DisplayWidthMM (dpyinfo->display, screen_number);
11012 /* Mac OS X 10.3's Xserver sometimes reports 0.0mm. */
11013 dpyinfo->resx = (mm < 1) ? 100 : pixels * 25.4 / mm;
11014 }
11015
11016 {
11017 static const struct
11018 {
11019 const char *name;
11020 int offset;
11021 } atom_refs[] = {
11022 #define ATOM_REFS_INIT(string, member) \
11023 { string, offsetof (struct x_display_info, member) },
11024 ATOM_REFS_INIT ("WM_PROTOCOLS", Xatom_wm_protocols)
11025 ATOM_REFS_INIT ("WM_TAKE_FOCUS", Xatom_wm_take_focus)
11026 ATOM_REFS_INIT ("WM_SAVE_YOURSELF", Xatom_wm_save_yourself)
11027 ATOM_REFS_INIT ("WM_DELETE_WINDOW", Xatom_wm_delete_window)
11028 ATOM_REFS_INIT ("WM_CHANGE_STATE", Xatom_wm_change_state)
11029 ATOM_REFS_INIT ("WM_CONFIGURE_DENIED", Xatom_wm_configure_denied)
11030 ATOM_REFS_INIT ("WM_MOVED", Xatom_wm_window_moved)
11031 ATOM_REFS_INIT ("WM_CLIENT_LEADER", Xatom_wm_client_leader)
11032 ATOM_REFS_INIT ("Editres", Xatom_editres)
11033 ATOM_REFS_INIT ("CLIPBOARD", Xatom_CLIPBOARD)
11034 ATOM_REFS_INIT ("TIMESTAMP", Xatom_TIMESTAMP)
11035 ATOM_REFS_INIT ("TEXT", Xatom_TEXT)
11036 ATOM_REFS_INIT ("COMPOUND_TEXT", Xatom_COMPOUND_TEXT)
11037 ATOM_REFS_INIT ("UTF8_STRING", Xatom_UTF8_STRING)
11038 ATOM_REFS_INIT ("DELETE", Xatom_DELETE)
11039 ATOM_REFS_INIT ("MULTIPLE", Xatom_MULTIPLE)
11040 ATOM_REFS_INIT ("INCR", Xatom_INCR)
11041 ATOM_REFS_INIT ("_EMACS_TMP_", Xatom_EMACS_TMP)
11042 ATOM_REFS_INIT ("TARGETS", Xatom_TARGETS)
11043 ATOM_REFS_INIT ("NULL", Xatom_NULL)
11044 ATOM_REFS_INIT ("ATOM", Xatom_ATOM)
11045 ATOM_REFS_INIT ("ATOM_PAIR", Xatom_ATOM_PAIR)
11046 ATOM_REFS_INIT ("CLIPBOARD_MANAGER", Xatom_CLIPBOARD_MANAGER)
11047 ATOM_REFS_INIT ("_XEMBED_INFO", Xatom_XEMBED_INFO)
11048 /* For properties of font. */
11049 ATOM_REFS_INIT ("PIXEL_SIZE", Xatom_PIXEL_SIZE)
11050 ATOM_REFS_INIT ("AVERAGE_WIDTH", Xatom_AVERAGE_WIDTH)
11051 ATOM_REFS_INIT ("_MULE_BASELINE_OFFSET", Xatom_MULE_BASELINE_OFFSET)
11052 ATOM_REFS_INIT ("_MULE_RELATIVE_COMPOSE", Xatom_MULE_RELATIVE_COMPOSE)
11053 ATOM_REFS_INIT ("_MULE_DEFAULT_ASCENT", Xatom_MULE_DEFAULT_ASCENT)
11054 /* Ghostscript support. */
11055 ATOM_REFS_INIT ("DONE", Xatom_DONE)
11056 ATOM_REFS_INIT ("PAGE", Xatom_PAGE)
11057 ATOM_REFS_INIT ("SCROLLBAR", Xatom_Scrollbar)
11058 ATOM_REFS_INIT ("HORIZONTAL_SCROLLBAR", Xatom_Horizontal_Scrollbar)
11059 ATOM_REFS_INIT ("_XEMBED", Xatom_XEMBED)
11060 /* EWMH */
11061 ATOM_REFS_INIT ("_NET_WM_STATE", Xatom_net_wm_state)
11062 ATOM_REFS_INIT ("_NET_WM_STATE_FULLSCREEN", Xatom_net_wm_state_fullscreen)
11063 ATOM_REFS_INIT ("_NET_WM_STATE_MAXIMIZED_HORZ",
11064 Xatom_net_wm_state_maximized_horz)
11065 ATOM_REFS_INIT ("_NET_WM_STATE_MAXIMIZED_VERT",
11066 Xatom_net_wm_state_maximized_vert)
11067 ATOM_REFS_INIT ("_NET_WM_STATE_STICKY", Xatom_net_wm_state_sticky)
11068 ATOM_REFS_INIT ("_NET_WM_STATE_HIDDEN", Xatom_net_wm_state_hidden)
11069 ATOM_REFS_INIT ("_NET_WM_WINDOW_TYPE", Xatom_net_window_type)
11070 ATOM_REFS_INIT ("_NET_WM_WINDOW_TYPE_TOOLTIP",
11071 Xatom_net_window_type_tooltip)
11072 ATOM_REFS_INIT ("_NET_WM_ICON_NAME", Xatom_net_wm_icon_name)
11073 ATOM_REFS_INIT ("_NET_WM_NAME", Xatom_net_wm_name)
11074 ATOM_REFS_INIT ("_NET_SUPPORTED", Xatom_net_supported)
11075 ATOM_REFS_INIT ("_NET_SUPPORTING_WM_CHECK", Xatom_net_supporting_wm_check)
11076 ATOM_REFS_INIT ("_NET_WM_WINDOW_OPACITY", Xatom_net_wm_window_opacity)
11077 ATOM_REFS_INIT ("_NET_ACTIVE_WINDOW", Xatom_net_active_window)
11078 ATOM_REFS_INIT ("_NET_FRAME_EXTENTS", Xatom_net_frame_extents)
11079 ATOM_REFS_INIT ("_NET_CURRENT_DESKTOP", Xatom_net_current_desktop)
11080 ATOM_REFS_INIT ("_NET_WORKAREA", Xatom_net_workarea)
11081 /* Session management */
11082 ATOM_REFS_INIT ("SM_CLIENT_ID", Xatom_SM_CLIENT_ID)
11083 ATOM_REFS_INIT ("_XSETTINGS_SETTINGS", Xatom_xsettings_prop)
11084 ATOM_REFS_INIT ("MANAGER", Xatom_xsettings_mgr)
11085 };
11086
11087 int i;
11088 const int atom_count = ARRAYELTS (atom_refs);
11089 /* 1 for _XSETTINGS_SN */
11090 const int total_atom_count = 1 + atom_count;
11091 Atom *atoms_return = xmalloc (total_atom_count * sizeof *atoms_return);
11092 char **atom_names = xmalloc (total_atom_count * sizeof *atom_names);
11093 static char const xsettings_fmt[] = "_XSETTINGS_S%d";
11094 char xsettings_atom_name[sizeof xsettings_fmt - 2
11095 + INT_STRLEN_BOUND (int)];
11096
11097 for (i = 0; i < atom_count; i++)
11098 atom_names[i] = (char *) atom_refs[i].name;
11099
11100 /* Build _XSETTINGS_SN atom name */
11101 sprintf (xsettings_atom_name, xsettings_fmt,
11102 XScreenNumberOfScreen (dpyinfo->screen));
11103 atom_names[i] = xsettings_atom_name;
11104
11105 XInternAtoms (dpyinfo->display, atom_names, total_atom_count,
11106 False, atoms_return);
11107
11108 for (i = 0; i < atom_count; i++)
11109 *(Atom *) ((char *) dpyinfo + atom_refs[i].offset) = atoms_return[i];
11110
11111 /* Manual copy of last atom */
11112 dpyinfo->Xatom_xsettings_sel = atoms_return[i];
11113
11114 xfree (atom_names);
11115 xfree (atoms_return);
11116 }
11117
11118 dpyinfo->x_dnd_atoms_size = 8;
11119 dpyinfo->x_dnd_atoms = xmalloc (sizeof *dpyinfo->x_dnd_atoms
11120 * dpyinfo->x_dnd_atoms_size);
11121 dpyinfo->gray
11122 = XCreatePixmapFromBitmapData (dpyinfo->display, dpyinfo->root_window,
11123 gray_bits, gray_width, gray_height,
11124 1, 0, 1);
11125
11126 x_setup_pointer_blanking (dpyinfo);
11127
11128 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
11129 xim_initialize (dpyinfo, resource_name);
11130 #endif
11131
11132 xsettings_initialize (dpyinfo);
11133
11134 /* This is only needed for distinguishing keyboard and process input. */
11135 if (dpyinfo->connection != 0)
11136 add_keyboard_wait_descriptor (dpyinfo->connection);
11137
11138 #ifdef F_SETOWN
11139 fcntl (dpyinfo->connection, F_SETOWN, getpid ());
11140 #endif /* ! defined (F_SETOWN) */
11141
11142 if (interrupt_input)
11143 init_sigio (dpyinfo->connection);
11144
11145 #ifdef USE_LUCID
11146 {
11147 XrmValue d, fr, to;
11148 Font font;
11149
11150 dpy = dpyinfo->display;
11151 d.addr = (XPointer)&dpy;
11152 d.size = sizeof (Display *);
11153 fr.addr = XtDefaultFont;
11154 fr.size = sizeof (XtDefaultFont);
11155 to.size = sizeof (Font *);
11156 to.addr = (XPointer)&font;
11157 x_catch_errors (dpy);
11158 if (!XtCallConverter (dpy, XtCvtStringToFont, &d, 1, &fr, &to, NULL))
11159 emacs_abort ();
11160 if (x_had_errors_p (dpy) || !XQueryFont (dpy, font))
11161 XrmPutLineResource (&xrdb, "Emacs.dialog.*.font: 9x15");
11162 /* Do not free XFontStruct returned by the above call to XQueryFont.
11163 This leads to X protocol errors at XtCloseDisplay (Bug#18403). */
11164 x_uncatch_errors ();
11165 }
11166 #endif
11167
11168 /* See if we should run in synchronous mode. This is useful
11169 for debugging X code. */
11170 {
11171 Lisp_Object value = display_x_get_resource
11172 (dpyinfo, build_local_string ("synchronous"),
11173 build_local_string ("Synchronous"), Qnil, Qnil);
11174 if (STRINGP (value)
11175 && (!strcmp (SSDATA (value), "true")
11176 || !strcmp (SSDATA (value), "on")))
11177 XSynchronize (dpyinfo->display, True);
11178 }
11179
11180 {
11181 Lisp_Object value = display_x_get_resource
11182 (dpyinfo, build_local_string ("useXIM"),
11183 build_local_string ("UseXIM"), Qnil, Qnil);
11184 #ifdef USE_XIM
11185 if (STRINGP (value)
11186 && (!strcmp (SSDATA (value), "false")
11187 || !strcmp (SSDATA (value), "off")))
11188 use_xim = false;
11189 #else
11190 if (STRINGP (value)
11191 && (!strcmp (SSDATA (value), "true")
11192 || !strcmp (SSDATA (value), "on")))
11193 use_xim = true;
11194 #endif
11195 }
11196
11197 #ifdef HAVE_X_SM
11198 /* Only do this for the very first display in the Emacs session.
11199 Ignore X session management when Emacs was first started on a
11200 tty or started as a daemon. */
11201 if (terminal->id == 1 && ! IS_DAEMON)
11202 x_session_initialize (dpyinfo);
11203 #endif
11204
11205 unblock_input ();
11206
11207 return dpyinfo;
11208 }
11209 \f
11210 /* Get rid of display DPYINFO, deleting all frames on it,
11211 and without sending any more commands to the X server. */
11212
11213 static void
11214 x_delete_display (struct x_display_info *dpyinfo)
11215 {
11216 struct terminal *t;
11217
11218 /* Close all frames and delete the generic struct terminal for this
11219 X display. */
11220 for (t = terminal_list; t; t = t->next_terminal)
11221 if (t->type == output_x_window && t->display_info.x == dpyinfo)
11222 {
11223 #ifdef HAVE_X_SM
11224 /* Close X session management when we close its display. */
11225 if (t->id == 1 && x_session_have_connection ())
11226 x_session_close ();
11227 #endif
11228 delete_terminal (t);
11229 break;
11230 }
11231
11232 if (next_noop_dpyinfo == dpyinfo)
11233 next_noop_dpyinfo = dpyinfo->next;
11234
11235 if (x_display_list == dpyinfo)
11236 x_display_list = dpyinfo->next;
11237 else
11238 {
11239 struct x_display_info *tail;
11240
11241 for (tail = x_display_list; tail; tail = tail->next)
11242 if (tail->next == dpyinfo)
11243 tail->next = tail->next->next;
11244 }
11245
11246 xfree (dpyinfo->x_id_name);
11247 xfree (dpyinfo->x_dnd_atoms);
11248 xfree (dpyinfo->color_cells);
11249 xfree (dpyinfo);
11250 }
11251
11252 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
11253
11254 /* Atimer callback function for TIMER. Called every 0.1s to process
11255 Xt timeouts, if needed. We must avoid calling XtAppPending as
11256 much as possible because that function does an implicit XFlush
11257 that slows us down. */
11258
11259 static void
11260 x_process_timeouts (struct atimer *timer)
11261 {
11262 block_input ();
11263 x_timeout_atimer_activated_flag = 0;
11264 if (toolkit_scroll_bar_interaction || popup_activated ())
11265 {
11266 while (XtAppPending (Xt_app_con) & XtIMTimer)
11267 XtAppProcessEvent (Xt_app_con, XtIMTimer);
11268 /* Reactivate the atimer for next time. */
11269 x_activate_timeout_atimer ();
11270 }
11271 unblock_input ();
11272 }
11273
11274 /* Install an asynchronous timer that processes Xt timeout events
11275 every 0.1s as long as either `toolkit_scroll_bar_interaction' or
11276 `popup_activated_flag' (in xmenu.c) is set. Make sure to call this
11277 function whenever these variables are set. This is necessary
11278 because some widget sets use timeouts internally, for example the
11279 LessTif menu bar, or the Xaw3d scroll bar. When Xt timeouts aren't
11280 processed, these widgets don't behave normally. */
11281
11282 void
11283 x_activate_timeout_atimer (void)
11284 {
11285 block_input ();
11286 if (!x_timeout_atimer_activated_flag)
11287 {
11288 struct timespec interval = make_timespec (0, 100 * 1000 * 1000);
11289 start_atimer (ATIMER_RELATIVE, interval, x_process_timeouts, 0);
11290 x_timeout_atimer_activated_flag = 1;
11291 }
11292 unblock_input ();
11293 }
11294
11295 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
11296
11297 \f
11298 /* Set up use of X before we make the first connection. */
11299
11300 static struct redisplay_interface x_redisplay_interface =
11301 {
11302 x_frame_parm_handlers,
11303 x_produce_glyphs,
11304 x_write_glyphs,
11305 x_insert_glyphs,
11306 x_clear_end_of_line,
11307 x_scroll_run,
11308 x_after_update_window_line,
11309 x_update_window_begin,
11310 x_update_window_end,
11311 x_flush,
11312 x_clear_window_mouse_face,
11313 x_get_glyph_overhangs,
11314 x_fix_overlapping_area,
11315 x_draw_fringe_bitmap,
11316 0, /* define_fringe_bitmap */
11317 0, /* destroy_fringe_bitmap */
11318 x_compute_glyph_string_overhangs,
11319 x_draw_glyph_string,
11320 x_define_frame_cursor,
11321 x_clear_frame_area,
11322 x_draw_window_cursor,
11323 x_draw_vertical_window_border,
11324 x_draw_window_divider,
11325 x_shift_glyphs_for_insert,
11326 x_show_hourglass,
11327 x_hide_hourglass
11328 };
11329
11330
11331 /* This function is called when the last frame on a display is deleted. */
11332 void
11333 x_delete_terminal (struct terminal *terminal)
11334 {
11335 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = terminal->display_info.x;
11336
11337 /* Protect against recursive calls. delete_frame in
11338 delete_terminal calls us back when it deletes our last frame. */
11339 if (!terminal->name)
11340 return;
11341
11342 block_input ();
11343 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
11344 /* We must close our connection to the XIM server before closing the
11345 X display. */
11346 if (dpyinfo->xim)
11347 xim_close_dpy (dpyinfo);
11348 #endif
11349
11350 /* If called from x_connection_closed, the display may already be closed
11351 and dpyinfo->display was set to 0 to indicate that. */
11352 if (dpyinfo->display)
11353 {
11354 x_destroy_all_bitmaps (dpyinfo);
11355 XSetCloseDownMode (dpyinfo->display, DestroyAll);
11356
11357 /* Whether or not XCloseDisplay destroys the associated resource
11358 database depends on the version of libX11. To avoid both
11359 crash and memory leak, we dissociate the database from the
11360 display and then destroy dpyinfo->xrdb ourselves.
11361
11362 Unfortunately, the above strategy does not work in some
11363 situations due to a bug in newer versions of libX11: because
11364 XrmSetDatabase doesn't clear the flag XlibDisplayDfltRMDB if
11365 dpy->db is NULL, XCloseDisplay destroys the associated
11366 database whereas it has not been created by XGetDefault
11367 (Bug#21974 in freedesktop.org Bugzilla). As a workaround, we
11368 don't destroy the database here in order to avoid the crash
11369 in the above situations for now, though that may cause memory
11370 leaks in other situations. */
11371 #if 0
11372 #ifdef HAVE_XRMSETDATABASE
11373 XrmSetDatabase (dpyinfo->display, NULL);
11374 #else
11375 dpyinfo->display->db = NULL;
11376 #endif
11377 /* We used to call XrmDestroyDatabase from x_delete_display, but
11378 some older versions of libX11 crash if we call it after
11379 closing all the displays. */
11380 XrmDestroyDatabase (dpyinfo->xrdb);
11381 #endif
11382
11383 #ifdef USE_GTK
11384 xg_display_close (dpyinfo->display);
11385 #else
11386 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
11387 XtCloseDisplay (dpyinfo->display);
11388 #else
11389 XCloseDisplay (dpyinfo->display);
11390 #endif
11391 #endif /* ! USE_GTK */
11392
11393 /* No more input on this descriptor. Do not close it because
11394 it's already closed by X(t)CloseDisplay (Bug#18403). */
11395 eassert (0 <= dpyinfo->connection);
11396 delete_keyboard_wait_descriptor (dpyinfo->connection);
11397
11398 /* Mark as dead. */
11399 dpyinfo->display = NULL;
11400 dpyinfo->connection = -1;
11401 }
11402
11403 x_delete_display (dpyinfo);
11404 unblock_input ();
11405 }
11406
11407 /* Create a struct terminal, initialize it with the X11 specific
11408 functions and make DISPLAY->TERMINAL point to it. */
11409
11410 static struct terminal *
11411 x_create_terminal (struct x_display_info *dpyinfo)
11412 {
11413 struct terminal *terminal;
11414
11415 terminal = create_terminal (output_x_window, &x_redisplay_interface);
11416
11417 terminal->display_info.x = dpyinfo;
11418 dpyinfo->terminal = terminal;
11419
11420 /* kboard is initialized in x_term_init. */
11421
11422 terminal->clear_frame_hook = x_clear_frame;
11423 terminal->ins_del_lines_hook = x_ins_del_lines;
11424 terminal->delete_glyphs_hook = x_delete_glyphs;
11425 terminal->ring_bell_hook = XTring_bell;
11426 terminal->toggle_invisible_pointer_hook = XTtoggle_invisible_pointer;
11427 terminal->update_begin_hook = x_update_begin;
11428 terminal->update_end_hook = x_update_end;
11429 terminal->read_socket_hook = XTread_socket;
11430 terminal->frame_up_to_date_hook = XTframe_up_to_date;
11431 terminal->mouse_position_hook = XTmouse_position;
11432 terminal->frame_rehighlight_hook = XTframe_rehighlight;
11433 terminal->frame_raise_lower_hook = XTframe_raise_lower;
11434 terminal->fullscreen_hook = XTfullscreen_hook;
11435 terminal->menu_show_hook = x_menu_show;
11436 #if defined (USE_X_TOOLKIT) || defined (USE_GTK)
11437 terminal->popup_dialog_hook = xw_popup_dialog;
11438 #endif
11439 terminal->set_vertical_scroll_bar_hook = XTset_vertical_scroll_bar;
11440 terminal->set_horizontal_scroll_bar_hook = XTset_horizontal_scroll_bar;
11441 terminal->condemn_scroll_bars_hook = XTcondemn_scroll_bars;
11442 terminal->redeem_scroll_bar_hook = XTredeem_scroll_bar;
11443 terminal->judge_scroll_bars_hook = XTjudge_scroll_bars;
11444 terminal->delete_frame_hook = x_destroy_window;
11445 terminal->delete_terminal_hook = x_delete_terminal;
11446 /* Other hooks are NULL by default. */
11447
11448 return terminal;
11449 }
11450
11451 static void
11452 x_initialize (void)
11453 {
11454 baud_rate = 19200;
11455
11456 x_noop_count = 0;
11457 any_help_event_p = 0;
11458 ignore_next_mouse_click_timeout = 0;
11459
11460 #ifdef USE_GTK
11461 current_count = -1;
11462 #endif
11463
11464 /* Try to use interrupt input; if we can't, then start polling. */
11465 Fset_input_interrupt_mode (Qt);
11466
11467 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
11468 XtToolkitInitialize ();
11469
11470 Xt_app_con = XtCreateApplicationContext ();
11471
11472 /* Register a converter from strings to pixels, which uses
11473 Emacs' color allocation infrastructure. */
11474 XtAppSetTypeConverter (Xt_app_con,
11475 XtRString, XtRPixel, cvt_string_to_pixel,
11476 cvt_string_to_pixel_args,
11477 XtNumber (cvt_string_to_pixel_args),
11478 XtCacheByDisplay, cvt_pixel_dtor);
11479
11480 XtAppSetFallbackResources (Xt_app_con, Xt_default_resources);
11481 #endif
11482
11483 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
11484 #ifndef USE_GTK
11485 xaw3d_arrow_scroll = False;
11486 xaw3d_pick_top = True;
11487 #endif
11488 #endif
11489
11490 /* Note that there is no real way portable across R3/R4 to get the
11491 original error handler. */
11492 XSetErrorHandler (x_error_handler);
11493 XSetIOErrorHandler (x_io_error_quitter);
11494 }
11495
11496
11497 void
11498 syms_of_xterm (void)
11499 {
11500 x_error_message = NULL;
11501
11502 DEFSYM (Qvendor_specific_keysyms, "vendor-specific-keysyms");
11503 DEFSYM (Qlatin_1, "latin-1");
11504
11505 #ifdef USE_GTK
11506 xg_default_icon_file = build_pure_c_string ("icons/hicolor/scalable/apps/emacs.svg");
11507 staticpro (&xg_default_icon_file);
11508
11509 DEFSYM (Qx_gtk_map_stock, "x-gtk-map-stock");
11510 #endif
11511
11512 DEFVAR_BOOL ("x-use-underline-position-properties",
11513 x_use_underline_position_properties,
11514 doc: /* Non-nil means make use of UNDERLINE_POSITION font properties.
11515 A value of nil means ignore them. If you encounter fonts with bogus
11516 UNDERLINE_POSITION font properties, for example 7x13 on XFree prior
11517 to 4.1, set this to nil. You can also use `underline-minimum-offset'
11518 to override the font's UNDERLINE_POSITION for small font display
11519 sizes. */);
11520 x_use_underline_position_properties = 1;
11521
11522 DEFVAR_BOOL ("x-underline-at-descent-line",
11523 x_underline_at_descent_line,
11524 doc: /* Non-nil means to draw the underline at the same place as the descent line.
11525 A value of nil means to draw the underline according to the value of the
11526 variable `x-use-underline-position-properties', which is usually at the
11527 baseline level. The default value is nil. */);
11528 x_underline_at_descent_line = 0;
11529
11530 DEFVAR_BOOL ("x-mouse-click-focus-ignore-position",
11531 x_mouse_click_focus_ignore_position,
11532 doc: /* Non-nil means that a mouse click to focus a frame does not move point.
11533 This variable is only used when the window manager requires that you
11534 click on a frame to select it (give it focus). In that case, a value
11535 of nil, means that the selected window and cursor position changes to
11536 reflect the mouse click position, while a non-nil value means that the
11537 selected window or cursor position is preserved. */);
11538 x_mouse_click_focus_ignore_position = 0;
11539
11540 DEFVAR_LISP ("x-toolkit-scroll-bars", Vx_toolkit_scroll_bars,
11541 doc: /* Which toolkit scroll bars Emacs uses, if any.
11542 A value of nil means Emacs doesn't use toolkit scroll bars.
11543 With the X Window system, the value is a symbol describing the
11544 X toolkit. Possible values are: gtk, motif, xaw, or xaw3d.
11545 With MS Windows or Nextstep, the value is t. */);
11546 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
11547 #ifdef USE_MOTIF
11548 Vx_toolkit_scroll_bars = intern_c_string ("motif");
11549 #elif defined HAVE_XAW3D
11550 Vx_toolkit_scroll_bars = intern_c_string ("xaw3d");
11551 #elif USE_GTK
11552 Vx_toolkit_scroll_bars = intern_c_string ("gtk");
11553 #else
11554 Vx_toolkit_scroll_bars = intern_c_string ("xaw");
11555 #endif
11556 #else
11557 Vx_toolkit_scroll_bars = Qnil;
11558 #endif
11559
11560 DEFSYM (Qmodifier_value, "modifier-value");
11561 DEFSYM (Qalt, "alt");
11562 Fput (Qalt, Qmodifier_value, make_number (alt_modifier));
11563 DEFSYM (Qhyper, "hyper");
11564 Fput (Qhyper, Qmodifier_value, make_number (hyper_modifier));
11565 DEFSYM (Qmeta, "meta");
11566 Fput (Qmeta, Qmodifier_value, make_number (meta_modifier));
11567 DEFSYM (Qsuper, "super");
11568 Fput (Qsuper, Qmodifier_value, make_number (super_modifier));
11569
11570 DEFVAR_LISP ("x-alt-keysym", Vx_alt_keysym,
11571 doc: /* Which keys Emacs uses for the alt modifier.
11572 This should be one of the symbols `alt', `hyper', `meta', `super'.
11573 For example, `alt' means use the Alt_L and Alt_R keysyms. The default
11574 is nil, which is the same as `alt'. */);
11575 Vx_alt_keysym = Qnil;
11576
11577 DEFVAR_LISP ("x-hyper-keysym", Vx_hyper_keysym,
11578 doc: /* Which keys Emacs uses for the hyper modifier.
11579 This should be one of the symbols `alt', `hyper', `meta', `super'.
11580 For example, `hyper' means use the Hyper_L and Hyper_R keysyms. The
11581 default is nil, which is the same as `hyper'. */);
11582 Vx_hyper_keysym = Qnil;
11583
11584 DEFVAR_LISP ("x-meta-keysym", Vx_meta_keysym,
11585 doc: /* Which keys Emacs uses for the meta modifier.
11586 This should be one of the symbols `alt', `hyper', `meta', `super'.
11587 For example, `meta' means use the Meta_L and Meta_R keysyms. The
11588 default is nil, which is the same as `meta'. */);
11589 Vx_meta_keysym = Qnil;
11590
11591 DEFVAR_LISP ("x-super-keysym", Vx_super_keysym,
11592 doc: /* Which keys Emacs uses for the super modifier.
11593 This should be one of the symbols `alt', `hyper', `meta', `super'.
11594 For example, `super' means use the Super_L and Super_R keysyms. The
11595 default is nil, which is the same as `super'. */);
11596 Vx_super_keysym = Qnil;
11597
11598 DEFVAR_LISP ("x-keysym-table", Vx_keysym_table,
11599 doc: /* Hash table of character codes indexed by X keysym codes. */);
11600 Vx_keysym_table = make_hash_table (hashtest_eql, make_number (900),
11601 make_float (DEFAULT_REHASH_SIZE),
11602 make_float (DEFAULT_REHASH_THRESHOLD),
11603 Qnil);
11604 }